L 3 COMMUNICATIONS CORP
S-4, 1997-07-21
Previous: NUVEEN UNIT TRUSTS SERIES 5, S-6EL24, 1997-07-21
Next: TRAILER BRIDGE INC, S-1/A, 1997-07-21



      As filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on July 18, 1997
                                                    Registration No. 333- ____



                         SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION
                              Washington, D.C. 20549
                            _________________________

                                     FORM S-4
                              REGISTRATION STATEMENT
                                      UNDER
                            THE SECURITIES ACT OF 1933
                            _________________________

                          L-3 COMMUNICATIONS CORPORATION
              (Exact Name of Registrant as Specified in Its Charter)

          DELAWARE               3812, 3663, 3679            13-3937436
(State or other jurisdiction     (Primary Standard        (I.R.S. Employer
     of incorporation or             Industrial         Identification Number)
       organization)            Classification Code
                                      Number)
                           _________________________


                                 600 Third Avenue
                             New York, New York 10016
                                  (212) 697-1111
     (Address, including zip Code, and telephone number, including area code,
                   of registrant's principal executive offices)
                            _________________________


                           Christopher C. Cambria, Esq.
                          L-3 Communications Corporation
                                 600 Third Avenue
                             New York, New York 10016
                                  (212) 697-1111
     (Name, address, including zip code, and telephone number, including area
                           code, of agent for service)
                            _________________________

                                 With a copy to:
                             David B. Chapnick, Esq.
                            Simpson Thacher & Bartlett
                               425 Lexington Avenue
                             New York, New York 10017
                                  (212) 455-2000
                            _________________________


         Approximate date of commencement of proposed sale to the public: As
    soon as practicable after this Registration Statement becomes effective. 
<PAGE>
         If the securities being registered on this form are being offered in
    connection with the formation of a holding company and there is compliance
    with General Instruction G, check the following box: / /
                            _________________________


                         CALCULATION OF REGISTRATION FEE

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>

                                         Proposed     Proposed
        Title of                         Maximum      Maximum 
      Each Class of                      Offering     Aggregate    Amount of
     Securities to       Amount to be    Price Per    Offering   Registration 
     be Registered        Registered     Note         Price<F1>      Fee
    ------------------  -------------  -----------   ----------  ------------
<S>                     <C>            <C>           <C>         <C>

    10 3/8% Series B
    Senior Subordinated
    Notes due 2007  . .  $225,000,000       100%      $225,000,000     $68,182


<FN>
<F1>  Estimated solely for the purpose of calculating the registration
      fee.

</TABLE>
                            _________________________

    The Registrant hereby amends this Registration Statement on such date or
    dates as may be necessary to delay its effective date until the Registrant
    shall file a further amendment which specifically states that this
    Registration Statement shall thereafter become effective in accordance
    with Section 8(a) of the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, or until this
    Registration Statement shall become effective on such date as the
    Commission, acting pursuant to said Section 8(a), may determine.
<PAGE>
                                 EXPLANATORY NOTE


         THIS REGISTRATION STATEMENT COVERS THE REGISTRATION OF AN AGGREGATE
    PRINCIPAL AMOUNT OF $225,000,000 OF 10 3/8% SERIES B SENIOR SUBORDINATED
    NOTES DUE 2007 (THE "EXCHANGE NOTES") OF L-3 COMMUNICATIONS CORPORATION
    THAT MAY BE EXCHANGED FOR EQUAL PRINCIPAL AMOUNTS OF THE COMPANY'S
    OUTSTANDING 10 3/8% SENIOR SUBORDINATED NOTES DUE 2007 (THE "OLD NOTES")
    (THE "EXCHANGE OFFER"). THIS REGISTRATION STATEMENT ALSO COVERS THE
    REGISTRATION OF THE EXCHANGE NOTES FOR RESALE BY LEHMAN BROTHERS INC. IN
    MARKET-MAKING TRANSACTIONS. THE COMPLETE PROSPECTUS RELATING TO THE
    EXCHANGE OFFER (THE "EXCHANGE OFFER PROSPECTUS") FOLLOWS IMMEDIATELY AFTER
    THIS EXPLANATORY NOTE. FOLLOWING THE EXCHANGE OFFER PROSPECTUS ARE CERTAIN
    PAGES OF THE PROSPECTUS RELATING SOLELY TO SUCH MARKET-MAKING TRANSACTIONS
    (THE "MARKET-MAKING PROSPECTUS"), INCLUDING ALTERNATE FRONT AND BACK COVER
    PAGES, A SECTION ENTITLED "RISK FACTORS--TRADING MARKET FOR THE EXCHANGE
    NOTES" TO BE USED IN LIEU OF THE SECTION ENTITLED "RISK FACTORS--LACK OF
    PUBLIC MARKET FOR THE EXCHANGE NOTES," ALTERNATE SECTIONS ENTITLED "USE OF
    PROCEEDS" AND "PLAN OF DISTRIBUTION". IN ADDITION, THE MARKET-MAKING
    PROSPECTUS WILL NOT INCLUDE THE FOLLOWING CAPTIONS (OR THE INFORMATION SET
    FORTH UNDER SUCH CAPTIONS) IN THE EXCHANGE OFFER PROSPECTUS: "PROSPECTUS
    SUMMARY--THE NOTE OFFERING" AND "--THE EXCHANGE OFFER", "RISK FACTORS--
    CONSEQUENCES OF FAILURE TO EXCHANGE", "THE EXCHANGE OFFER" AND "CERTAIN
    FEDERAL INCOME TAX CONSEQUENCES". ALL OTHER SECTIONS OF THE EXCHANGE OFFER
    PROSPECTUS WILL BE INCLUDED IN THE MARKET-MAKING PROSPECTUS.
<PAGE>
__________________________________________________________________________

Information contained herein is subject to completion or amendment without
notice. A registration statement relating to these securities has been
filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission. These securities may not
be sold nor may offers to buy be accepted prior to the time the
registration statement becomes effective. This prospectus shall not
constitute an offer to sell or the solicitation of an offer to buy nor
shall there be any sale of these securities in any State in which such
offer, solicitation or sale would be unlawful prior to registration or
qualification under the securities laws of any such State.
___________________________________________________________________________


                    SUBJECT TO COMPLETION DATED _________, 1997

PRELIMINARY PROSPECTUS
[LOGO OMITTED] 

                           L-3 Communications Corporation
              Offer to Exchange $225,000,000 of its 10 3/8% Series B 
                        Senior Subordinated Notes due 2007,
                which have been registered under the Securities Act,
                for $225,000,000 of its outstanding 10 3/8% Senior 
                            Subordinated Notes due 2007
                             _________________________

THE EXCHANGE OFFER WILL EXPIRE AT 5:00 P.M., NEW YORK CITY TIME, ON ______,
1997, UNLESS EXTENDED.
                             _________________________


L-3 Communications Corporation (the "Company" or "L-3"), a wholly owned
subsidiary of L-3 Communications Holdings, Inc. ("Holdings"), hereby
offers, upon the terms and subject to the conditions set forth in this
Prospectus and the accompanying Letter of Transmittal (which together
constitute the "Exchange Offer"), to exchange an aggregate of up to
$225,000,000 principal amount of 10 3/8% Series B Senior Subordinated Notes
due 2007 (the "Exchange Notes") of the Company for an identical face amount
of the issued and outstanding 10 3/8% Senior Subordinated Notes due 2007
(the "Old Notes" and together with the Exchange Notes, the "Notes") of the
Company from the Holders (as defined) thereof. As of the date of this
Prospectus, there is $225,000,000 aggregate principal amount of the Old
Notes outstanding. The terms of the Exchange Notes are identical in all
material respects to the Old Notes, except that the Exchange Notes have
been registered under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended (the "Securities 
Act"), and therefore will not bear legends restricting their transfer and will 
not contain certain provisions providing for an increase in the interest rate 
on the Old Notes under certain circumstances described in the Registration 
Rights Agreement (as defined), which provisions will terminate as to all 
of the Notes upon the consummation of the Exchange Offer.

Interest on the Exchange Notes will be payable semi-annually on May 1 and
November 1 of each year, commencing November 1, 1997. The Exchange Notes will 
be redeemable at the option of the Company, in whole or in part, at any time 
on or after May 1, 2002, at the redemption prices set forth herein, plus 
<PAGE>
accrued and unpaid interest to the date of redemption. In addition, prior to 
May 1, 2000, the Company may redeem up to 35% of the aggregate principal 
amount of Exchange Notes at the redemption price set forth herein plus accrued 
and unpaid interest through the redemption date with the net cash proceeds of 
one or more Equity Offerings (as defined).

The Exchange Notes will not be subject to any mandatory sinking fund. In the
event of a Change of Control (as defined), each holder of Exchange Notes will 
have the right, at the holder's option, to require the Company to purchase such 
holder's Exchange Notes at a purchase price equal to 101% of the principal 
amount thereof, plus accrued and unpaid interest to the date of purchase. See 
"Description of the Exchange Notes". The Exchange Notes will be general 
unsecured obligations of the Company, subordinate in right of payment to all 
existing and future Senior Debt (as defined) of the Company. As of March 31, 
1997, after giving pro forma effect to the Offering of the Old Notes, 
application of the net proceeds therefrom and borrowings under the Senior 
Credit Facilities (as defined), the Company would have had approximately 
$400.0 million of indebtedness outstanding, of which $175.0 million would have 
been Senior Debt (excluding letters of credit). See "Capitalization". On the 
date of issuance of the Exchange Notes, the Company will not have any 
subsidiaries; however, the Indenture (as defined) will permit the Company to 
create subsidiaries in the future.

The Old Notes were issued and sold on April 30, 1997 in a transaction not
registered under the Securities Act in reliance upon an exemption from the
registration requirements thereof. In general, the Old Notes may not be offered 
or sold unless registered under the Securities Act, except pursuant to an 
exemption from, or in a transaction not subject to, the Securities Act. The 
Exchange Notes are being offered hereby in order to satisfy certain obligations 
of the Company contained in the Registration Rights Agreement. Based on 
interpretations by the staff of the Securities and Exchange Commission (the 
"Commission") set forth in no-action letters issued to third parties, the 
Company believes that the Exchange Notes issued pursuant to the Exchange 
Offer in exchange for Old Notes may be offered for resale, resold or otherwise 
transferred by any holder thereof (other than any such holder that is an 
"affiliate" of the Company within the meaning of Rule 405 promulgated under the 
Securities Act) without compliance with the registration and prospectus 
delivery provisions of the Securities Act, provided that such Exchange Notes 
are acquired in the ordinary course of such holder's business, such holder has 
no arrangement with any person to participate in the distribution of such 
Exchange Notes    and neither such holder nor any such other person is engaging 
in or intends to engage in a distribution of such Exchange Notes. However, the 
Company has not sought, and does not intend to seek, its own no-action letter, 
and there can be no assurance that the staff of the Commission would make a 
similar determination with respect to the Exchange Offer. Notwithstanding the 
foregoing, each broker-dealer that receives Exchange Notes for its own account 
pursuant to the Exchange Offer must acknowledge that it will deliver a 
prospectus in connection with any resale of such Exchange Notes. The Letter of 
Transmittal states that by so acknowledging and by delivering a prospectus, a 
broker-dealer will not be deemed to admit that it is an "underwriter" within 
the meaning of the Securities Act. See "Plan of Distribution". 

The Old Notes are designated for trading in the Private Offerings, Resales and 
Trading through Automated Linkages ("PORTAL") market. There is no established 
trading market for the Exchange Notes. The Company does not currently intend to 
<PAGE>
list the Exchange Notes on any securities exchange or to seek approval for 
quotation through any automated quotation system. Accordingly, there can be no 
assurance as to the development or liquidity of any market for the Exchange 
Notes. 

The Exchange Offer is not conditioned upon any minimum aggregate principal 
amount of Old Notes being tendered for exchange. The date of acceptance and
exchange of the Old Notes (the "Exchange Date") will be the fourth business
day following the Expiration Date (as defined). Old Notes tendered pursuant
to the Exchange Offer may be withdrawn at any time prior to the Expiration
Date. The Company will not receive any proceeds from the Exchange Offer. 
The Company will pay all of the expenses incident to the Exchange Offer.

For a discussion of certain factors that should be considered in connection    
with an investment in the Exchange Notes, see "Risk Factors" beginning on 
page 26.

THE SECURITIES HAVE NOT BEEN APPROVED OR DISAPPROVED BY THE SECURITIES AND 
EXCHANGE COMMISSION OR ANY STATE SECURITIES COMMISSION NOR HAS THE COMMISSION 
OR ANY STATE SECURITIES COMMISSION PASSED UPON THE ACCURACY OR ADEQUACY OF THIS 
PROSPECTUS. ANY REPRESENTATION TO THE CONTRARY IS A CRIMINAL OFFENSE.

                 The date of this Prospectus is __________, 1997<PAGE>
                              AVAILABLE INFORMATION

         The Company has filed with the Commission a Registration Statement
    on Form S-4 (together with all amendments, exhibits, schedules and
    supplements thereto, the "Registration Statement") under the Securities
    Act with respect to the Exchange Notes being offered hereby. This
    Prospectus, which forms a part of the Registration Statement, does not
    contain all of the information set forth in the Registration Statement.
    For further information with respect to the Company and the Exchange
    Notes, reference is made to the Registration Statement. Statements
    contained in this Prospectus as to the contents of any contract or other
    document are not necessarily complete, and, where such contract or other
    document is an exhibit to the Registration Statement, each such statement
    is qualified in all respects by the provisions in such exhibit, to which
    reference is hereby made. The Company is not currently subject to the
    informational requirements of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as
    amended (the "Exchange Act"). As a result of the offering of the Exchange
    Notes, the Company will become subject to the informational requirements
    of the Exchange Act, and, in accordance therewith, will file reports and
    other information with the Commission. The Registration Statement, such
    reports and other information can be inspected and copied at the Public
    Reference Section of the Commission located at Room 1024, Judiciary Plaza,
    450 Fifth Street, N.W., Washington D.C. 20549 and at regional public
    reference facilities maintained by the Commission located at Citicorp
    Center, 500 West Madison Street, Suite 1400, Chicago, Illinois 60661 and
    Seven World Trade Center, Suite 1300, New York, New York 10048. Copies of
    such material, including copies of all or any portion of the Registration
    Statement, can be obtained from the Public Reference Section of the
    Commission at prescribed rates. Such material may also be accessed
    electronically by means of the Commission's home page on the Internet
    (http://www.sec.gov). 

         So long as the Company is subject to the periodic reporting
    requirements of the Exchange Act, it is required to furnish the
    information required to be filed with the Commission to the Trustee and
    the holders of the Old Notes and the Exchange Notes. The Company has
    agreed that, even if it is not required under the Exchange Act to furnish
    such information to the Commission, it will nonetheless continue to
    furnish information that would be required to be furnished by the Company
    by Section 13 of the Exchange Act to the Trustee and the holders of the
    Old Notes or Exchange Notes as if it were subject to such periodic
    reporting requirements.

         In addition, the Company has agreed that, for so long as any Old
    Notes remain outstanding and are required to bear the transfer restriction
    legend, it will make available to any prospective purchaser of the Old
    Notes or beneficial owner of the Old Notes in connection with any sale
    thereof the information required by Rule 144A(d)(4) under the Securities
    Act, until such time as the Company has either exchanged the Old Notes for
    the Exchange Notes or until such time as the holders thereof have disposed
    of such Old Notes pursuant to an effective registration statement filed by
    the Company.
<PAGE>
                                PROSPECTUS SUMMARY

         The following summary is qualified in its entirety by the more
    detailed information and financial statements appearing elsewhere in this
    Prospectus. As used in this Prospectus, unless the context requires
    otherwise: (i) "Businesses" or the "Predecessor" means the operations of
    Lockheed Martin Corporation and its subsidiaries that were acquired by the
    Company upon consummation of the Acquisition (as defined), (ii) "L-3" or
    the "Company" means L-3 Communications Corporation and the Businesses
    after giving effect to the Acquisition, (iii) "Holdings" means L-3
    Communications Holdings, Inc., the Company's sole shareholder and
    (iv) "Lockheed Martin" means Lockheed Martin Corporation. 

                                   The Company

         L-3 is a leading provider of sophisticated secure communication
    systems and specialized communication products including secure, high data
    rate communication systems, microwave components, avionics, and telemetry
    and instrumentation products. These systems and products are critical
    elements of virtually all major communication, command and control,
    intelligence gathering and space systems. The Company's systems and
    specialized products are used to connect a variety of airborne, space,
    ground and sea-based communication systems and are incorporated into the
    transmission, processing, recording, monitoring and dissemination
    functions of these communication systems. The Company's customers include
    the U.S. Department of Defense (the "DoD"), selected U.S. government (the
    "Government") intelligence agencies, major aerospace/defense prime
    contractors, foreign governments and commercial customers. In 1996, L-3
    had pro forma sales of $675.3 million and pro forma operating income of
    $56.0 million. The Company's funded backlog as of December 31, 1996 was
    approximately $542.5 million.

         All of the Company's business units enjoy proprietary technologies
    and capabilities and are well positioned in their respective markets.
    Management has organized the Company's operations into two business areas:
    Secure Communication Systems and Specialized Communication Products. In
    1996, these areas generated approximately $371.5 million and $303.8
    million of pro forma sales, respectively, and $23.0 million and $33.0
    million of pro forma operating income, respectively.

         Secure Communication Systems. L-3 is the established leader in
    secure, high data rate communications in support of military and other
    national agency reconnaissance and surveillance applications. The
    Company's Secure Communication Systems operations are located in Salt Lake
    City, Utah and Camden, New Jersey. Both operations are predominantly cost
    plus, sole source prime system contractors supporting long-term programs
    for the U.S. Armed Forces and classified customers. The Company's major
    secure communication programs and systems include: strategic and tactical
    signal intelligence systems that detect, collect, identify, analyze and
    disseminate information and related support contracts for military and
    national agency intelligence efforts; secure data links for airborne,
    satellite, ground and sea-based information collection and transmission;
<PAGE>
    as well as secure telephone and network equipment. The Company believes
    that it has developed virtually every high bandwidth data link used by the
    military for surveillance and reconnaissance in operation today. In
    addition to these core Government programs, L-3 is expanding its business
    base into related commercial communication equipment markets, including
    applying its wireless communication expertise to develop local wireless
    loop equipment primarily for emerging market countries and rural areas
    where existing telecommunications infrastructure is inadequate or
    non-existent.

         Specialized Communication Products. This business area comprises the
    Microwave Components, Avionics, and Telemetry and Instrumentation Products
    operations of the Company.

         Microwave Components. L-3 is the preeminent worldwide supplier of
    commercial off-the-shelf, high performance microwave components and
    frequency monitoring equipment. L-3's microwave products are sold under
    the industry-recognized Narda brand name through a standard catalog to
    wireless, industrial and military communication markets. L-3 also provides
    state-of-the-art communication components including channel amplifiers and
    frequency filters for the commercial communications satellite market.

         Avionics. Avionics includes the Company's Aviation Recorders,
    Display Systems and Antenna Systems operations. L-3 is the world's leading
    manufacturer of commercial cockpit voice and flight data recorders ("black
    boxes"). These recorders are sold under the Fairchild brand name both on
    an original equipment manufacturer ("OEM") basis to aircraft manufacturers
    as well as directly to the world's major airlines for their existing
    fleets of aircraft. L-3 also provides military and high-end commercial
    displays for use on a number of DoD programs including the F-14, V-22,
    F-117 and E-2C. Further, L-3 manufactures high performance surveillance
    antennas and related equipment for U.S. Air Force and U.S. Navy aircraft
    including the F-16, AWACS, E-2C and B-2, as well as the U.K.'s Nimrod
    aircraft.

         Telemetry and Instrumentation Products. The Company's Telemetry and
    Instrumentation Products operations develop and manufacture commercial
    off-the-shelf, real-time data collection and transmission products and
    components for missile, aircraft and space-based electronic systems. These
    products are used to gather flight parameter data and other critical
    information and transmit it from air or space to the ground. Telemetry
    products are also used for range safety and training applications to
    simulate battlefield situations. Further, the Company is applying its
    technical capabilities in high data rate transmission to the medical image
    archiving market in partnership with the General Electric Company ("GE")
    through GE's medical systems business area ("GE Medical Systems").

    Industry Overview

         The defense industry has recently undergone significant changes
    precipitated by ongoing federal budget pressures and new roles and
    missions to reflect changing strategic and tactical threats. Since the
    mid-1980's, the overall U.S. defense budget has declined in real dollars.
<PAGE>
    In response, the DoD has focused its resources on enhancing its military
    readiness, joint operations and multiple mission capabilities, and
    incorporating advanced electronics to improve the performance, reduce
    operating cost and extend the life expectancy of its existing and future
    platforms. The emphasis on system interoperability, force multipliers and
    providing battlefield commanders with real-time data is increasing the
    electronics content of nearly all of the major military procurement and
    research programs. As a result, the DoD's budget for communications and
    defense electronics is expected to grow. According to Federal Sources, an
    independent private consulting group, the defense budget for command,
    control, communications and intelligence ("C3I") is expected to increase
    from $30.0 billion in the fiscal year ended September 30, 1996 to $42.0
    billion in the fiscal year ended September 30, 2002, a compound annual
    growth rate of 5.8%.

         The industry has also undergone dramatic consolidation resulting in
    the emergence of four dominant prime system contractors. One outgrowth of
    this consolidation among the remaining major prime contractors is their
    desire to limit purchases of products and sub-systems from one another.
    Despite this desire, there are numerous essential but non-strategic
    products, components and systems that are not economical for the major
    prime contractors to design, develop or manufacture for their own internal
    use. As the prime contractors continue to evaluate their core competencies
    and competitive position, focusing their resources on larger programs and
    platforms, the Company expects the prime contractors will seek to exit
    non-strategic business areas and procure these needed elements on more
    favorable terms from independent, commercially oriented merchant
    suppliers.

         The focus on cost control is also driving increased use of
    commercial off-the-shelf products for both upgrades of existing systems
    and in new systems. The Company believes the prime contractors will
    continue to be under pressure to reduce their costs and will increasingly
    seek to focus their resources and capabilities on major systems, turning
    to commercially oriented merchant suppliers to produce non-core
    sub-systems, components and products. Going forward, the successful
    merchant suppliers will use their resources to complement and support,
    rather than compete with the prime contractors. L-3 anticipates the
    relationship between the major prime contractors and their primary
    suppliers will, as in the automotive industry, develop into critical
    partnerships encompassing increasingly greater outsourcing of non-core
    products and systems by the prime contractors to their key merchant
    suppliers and increasing supplier participation in the development of
    future programs. Early involvement in the upgrading of existing systems
    and the design and engineering of new systems incorporating these
    outsourced products will provide top-tier suppliers, including the
    Company, with a competitive advantage in securing new business and provide
    the prime contractors with significant cost reduction opportunities
    through coordination of the design, development and manufacturing
    processes.
<PAGE>
    Business Strategy

         L-3 intends to leverage its market position, diverse program base
    and favorable mix of cost plus to fixed price contracts to enhance its
    profitability, reduce its indebtedness and to establish itself as the
    premier merchant supplier of communication systems and products to the
    major prime contractors in the aerospace/defense industry as well as the
    Government. The Company's strategy to achieve these objectives includes:

         -- Expand Merchant Supplier Relationships. Senior Management (as
    defined) has developed strong relationships with virtually all of the
    prime contractors, the DoD and other major government agencies, enabling
    L-3 to identify business opportunities and anticipate customer needs. As
    an independent merchant supplier, the Company anticipates its future
    growth will be driven by expanding its share of existing programs and by
    participating in new programs. Management has already identified several
    opportunities where the Company believes it will be able to use its strong
    relationships to increase its business presence and allow its customers to
    reduce their costs. The Company also expects to benefit from increased
    outsourcing by prime contractors who in the past may have limited their
    purchases to captive suppliers and who are now expected to view L-3's
    capabilities on a more favorable basis given its status as an independent
    company.

         -- Support Customer Requirements. A significant portion of L-3's
    sales are derived from high-priority, long-term programs and from programs
    for which the Company has been the incumbent supplier, and in many cases
    acted as the sole provider, over many years. Approximately 67% of the
    Company's total pro forma 1996 sales were generated from sole source
    contracts. L-3's customer satisfaction and excellent performance record
    are evidenced by its performance-based award fees exceeding 90% on average
    over the past two years. Going forward, management believes prime
    contractors will award long-term, sole source, outsourcing contracts to
    the merchant supplier they believe is most capable on the basis of
    quality, responsiveness, design, engineering and program management
    support as well as cost. Reflecting L-3's strong competitive position, the
    Company has experienced a contract award win rate over the past two years
    of approximately 50% on new competitive contracts for which it competes
    and approximately 90% on contracts for which it is the incumbent. The
    Company intends to continue to align its research and development,
    manufacturing and new business efforts to complement its customers'
    requirements.

         -- Leverage Technical and Market Leadership Positions. L-3 has
    developed strong, proprietary technical capabilities that have enabled it
    to capture a number one or two market position in most of its key business
    areas, including secure, high data rate communication systems, solid state
    aviation recorders, advanced antenna systems and high performance
    microwave components. Over the past three years, the Company has invested
    over $100 million in Company-sponsored independent research and
    development, including bid and proposal costs, in addition to making
    substantial investments in its technical and manufacturing resources.
    Further, the Company has a highly skilled workforce including over 1,500
<PAGE>
    engineers. As an independent company, management intends to leverage its
    technical expertise and capabilities into several closely aligned
    commercial business areas and applications, including opportunities in
    wireless telephony and medical imaging archive management.

         -- Maintain Diversified Business Mix. The Company enjoys a diverse
    business mix with a limited program exposure, a favorable balance of cost
    plus to fixed price contracts, a significant sole source business and an
    attractive customer profile. The Company's largest program, representing
    14% of 1996 pro forma sales, is a long-term, sole source, cost plus
    support program for the U-2 program Directorate for the DoD. No other
    program represented more than 7% of pro forma 1996 sales. Further, the
    Company's pro forma sales mix of contracts in 1996 was 42% cost plus and
    58% fixed price, providing the Company with a balanced mix of predictable
    profitability (cost plus) and higher margin (fixed price) business. L-3
    also enjoys an attractive customer mix of defense and commercial business,
    with DoD related sales accounting for 65% and commercial and federal
    (non-DoD) sales accounting for 35% of 1996 pro forma sales. The Company
    intends to leverage this favorable business profile to expand its merchant
    supplier business base.

         -- Enhance Operating Margins. As part of larger corporations (i.e.,
    Lockheed Martin, Loral, GE, Unisys), the Businesses were historically
    required to absorb significant corporate expense allocations. As an
    independent company, L-3 believes that it will be able to leverage its
    discretionary expenditures in a more focused and efficient manner, enhance
    its operating performance and reduce overhead expenses reflecting Senior
    Management's more flexible, entrepreneurial approach. The Company believes
    that significant costs incurred by the Businesses under Lockheed Martin's
    ownership will not be incurred going forward. These cost savings include
    reduced corporate administrative and facilities expenses and certain
    operating performance improvements.

         -- Capitalize on Strategic Acquisition Opportunities. Recent
    industry consolidation has virtually eliminated traditional middle-tier
    aerospace/defense companies. This level of consolidation is now beginning
    to draw the concern of the DoD and federal anti-trust regulators. As a
    result, the Company anticipates the pending major mergers as well as
    continued consolidation of the smaller participants in the defense
    industry will create attractive complementary acquisition candidates for
    L-3 in the future as these companies continue to evaluate their core
    competencies and competitive position.


                                 The Transaction    

    The Acquisition

         Holdings and L-3 were formed by Mr. Frank C. Lanza, the former
    President and Chief Operating Officer of Loral Corporation ("Loral"), Mr.
    Robert V. LaPenta, the former Senior Vice President and Controller of
    Loral (collectively, "Senior Management"), Lehman Brothers Capital
    Partners III, L.P. and its affiliates (the "Lehman Partnership") and
    Lockheed Martin to acquire (the "Acquisition") substantially all of the
    assets and certain liabilities of (i) nine business units previously
    purchased by Lockheed Martin as part of its acquisition of Loral in April
<PAGE>
    1996 (the "Loral Acquired Businesses") and (ii) one business unit,
    Communication Systems -- Camden, purchased by Lockheed Martin as part of
    its acquisition of the aerospace business of GE ("GE Aerospace") in April
    1993 (collectively, the "Businesses"). The total consideration paid to
    Lockheed Martin was $525 million, comprising $480 million of cash before
    an estimated $20 million reduction related to a purchase price adjustment,
    and $45 million of common equity being retained by Lockheed Martin. L-3 is
    a wholly-owned subsidiary of Holdings. Holdings was capitalized with $125
    million of common equity, with Messrs. Lanza and LaPenta collectively
    owning 15.0%, the Lehman Partnership owning 50.1% and Lockheed Martin
    owning 34.9%. L-3 was capitalized with $125 million of common equity
    provided by Holdings.

    Sources and Uses of Funds

         The Acquisition was structured as an asset purchase with customary
    terms and conditions. Financing for the Acquisition was comprised of:
    (i) $275 million of Senior Secured Credit Facilities, consisting of $175
    million of term loan facilities (the "Term Loan Facilities") and a $100
    million revolving credit facility (the "Revolving Credit Facility" and,
    together with the Term Loan Facilities, the "Senior Credit Facilities");
    (ii) $225 million of Senior Subordinated Exchange Notes; and (iii) $125
    million of equity including the equity to be retained by Lockheed Martin
    (collectively, the "Financing"). Approximately $480 million of the
    proceeds from the Financing was used by the Company to (i) pay the
    estimated $460 million cash portion of the purchase price after an
    estimated purchase price adjustment and (ii) pay related fees and
    expenses. The Revolving Credit Facility was not drawn (other than for
    letters of credit) at the closing of the Transaction (the "Closing") and
    is available for ongoing working capital financing needs. The following
    table summarizes the sources and uses of funds in connection with the
    Transaction.

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>

    ($ in millions)
                 Sources of Funds                     Amount                       Uses of Funds                      Amount
    -----------------------------------------  ------------------   -----------------------------------------   ------------------
<S>                                            <C>                  <C>                                         <C>

    Revolving Credit Facility<F1> . . . . . .       $  0.0          Purchase of Assets
    Term Loan Facilities  . . . . . . . . . .        175.0             Cash Portion . . . . . . . . . . . . .         $479.8
    Senior Subordinated Notes . . . . . . . .        225.0             Lockheed Martin Equity in L-3  . . . .           45.2
    Common Equity<F2> . . . . . . . . . . . .        125.0                                                             525.0
                                                    ------                                                            ------
                                                                    Estimated Purchase Price Adjustment . . .          (20.0)
                                                                    Estimated Fees and Expenses . . . . . . .           20.0
                                                                                                                      ------
       Total Sources  . . . . . . . . . . . .       $525.0             Total Uses . . . . . . . . . . . . . .         $525.0
                                                    ======                                                            ======
____________________
<FN>
<F1>   Availability of up to $100 million, none of which was drawn at
       Closing other than letters of credit which were less than $10
       million.
<F2>   Includes $45 million of equity of Holdings retained by Lockheed
       Martin.

</TABLE>
<PAGE>
         The purchase price of $525 million is subject to an adjustment based
    upon the difference between the audited combined net tangible assets (as
    defined in the Transaction Agreement) of the Businesses and a
    contractually agreed-upon amount. It is anticipated that this adjustment,
    currently estimated to be $20 million, will have the effect of reducing
    the purchase price. Prior to Closing, Lockheed Martin estimated the 
    purchase price adjustment and reduced the cash portion of the purchase 
    price by $15.9 million. Any difference between the actual purchase price 
    adjustment calculated post-closing and the amount withheld at Closing will 
    be paid, with interest, to the appropriate party.

         The Acquisition and the Financing are referred to herein as the
    "Transaction".
<PAGE>
                                The Exchange Offer

    The Exchange Offer  . . . . . . .   The Company is offering to exchange
                                        pursuant to the Exchange Offer up to
                                        $225,000,000 aggregate principal
                                        amount of its new 10 3/8% Series B
                                        Senior Subordinated Notes due 2007
                                        (the "Exchange Notes") for a like
                                        aggregate principal amount of its
                                        outstanding 10 3/8% Senior
                                        Subordinated Notes due 2007 (the "Old
                                        Notes" and together with the Exchange
                                        Notes, the "Notes"). The terms of the
                                        Exchange Notes are identical in all
                                        material respects (including principal
                                        amount, interest rate and maturity) to
                                        the terms of the Old Notes for which
                                        they may be exchanged pursuant to the
                                        Exchange Offer, except that the
                                        Exchange Notes are freely
                                        transferrable by Holders (as defined)
                                        thereof (other than as provided
                                        herein), and are not subject to any
                                        covenant regarding registration under
                                        the Securities Act. See "The Exchange
                                        Offer".

    Interest Payments . . . . . . . .   Interest on the Exchange Notes shall
                                        accrue from the last interest payment
                                        date (May 1 or November 1) on which
                                        interest was paid on the Notes so
                                        surrendered or, if no interest has
                                        been paid on such Notes, from April
                                        30, 1997 (the "Interest Payment
                                        Date").

    Minimum Condition . . . . . . . .   The Exchange Offer is not conditioned
                                        upon any minimum aggregate principal
                                        amount of Old Notes being tendered for
                                        exchange.

    Expiration Date; Withdrawal
      of Tender   . . . . . . . . . .   The Exchange Offer will expire at 5:00
                                        p.m., New York City time, on          
                                        , 1997, unless the Exchange Offer is
                                        extended, in which case the term
                                        "Expiration Date" means the latest
                                        date and time to which the Exchange
                                        Offer is extended. Tenders may be
                                        withdrawn at any time prior to 5:00
                                        p.m., New York City time, on the
                                        Expiration Date. See "The Exchange
                                        Offer--Withdrawal Rights".

    Exchange Date . . . . . . . . . .   The date of acceptance for exchange of
                                        the Old Notes will be the fourth
                                        business day following the Expiration
                                        Date.<PAGE>
    Conditions to the 
      Exchange Offer  . . . . . . . .   The Exchange Offer is subject to
                                        certain customary conditions, which
                                        may be waived by the Company. The
                                        Company currently expects that each of
                                        the conditions will be satisfied and
                                        that no waivers will be necessary. See
                                        "The Exchange Offer--Certain
                                        Conditions to the Exchange Offer". The
                                        Company reserves the right to
                                        terminate or amend the Exchange Offer
                                        at any time prior to the Expiration
                                        Date upon the occurrence of any such
                                        condition.

    Procedures for Tendering 
      Old Notes   . . . . . . . . . .   Each holder of Old Notes wishing to
                                        accept the Exchange Offer must
                                        complete, sign and date the Letter of
                                        Transmittal, or a facsimile thereof,
                                        in accordance with the instructions
                                        contained herein and therein, and mail
                                        or otherwise deliver such Letter of
                                        Transmittal, or such facsimile,
                                        together with the Old Notes and any
                                        other required documentation to the
                                        Exchange Agent (as defined) at the
                                        address set forth therein. See "The
                                        Exchange Offer--Procedures for
                                        Tendering Old Notes" and "Plan of
                                        Distribution".

    Use of Proceeds . . . . . . . . .   There will be no proceeds to the
                                        Company from the exchange of Notes
                                        pursuant to the Exchange Offer.

    Federal Income Tax 
      Consequences  . . . . . . . . .   The exchange of Notes pursuant to the
                                        Exchange Offer should not be a taxable
                                        event for federal income tax purposes.
                                        See "Certain U.S. Federal Income Tax
                                        Consequences".
    Special Procedures for 
      Beneficial Owners   . . . . . .   Any beneficial owner whose Old Notes
                                        are registered in the name of a
                                        broker, dealer, commercial bank, trust
                                        company or other nominee and who
                                        wishes to tender should contact such
                                        registered holder promptly and
                                        instruct such registered holder to
                                        tender on such beneficial owner's
                                        behalf. If such beneficial owner
                                        wishes to tender on such beneficial
                                        owner's own behalf, such beneficial
                                        owner must, prior to completing and
                                        executing the Letter of Transmittal
                                        and delivering the Old Notes, either
<PAGE>
                                        make appropriate arrangements to
                                        register ownership of the Old Notes in
                                        such beneficial owner's name or obtain
                                        a properly completed bond power from
                                        the registered holder. The transfer of
                                        registered ownership may take
                                        considerable time. See "The Exchange
                                        Offer--Procedures for Tendering Old
                                        Notes".

    Guaranteed Delivery
      Procedures  . . . . . . . . . .   Holders of Old Notes who wish to
                                        tender their Old Notes and whose Old
                                        Notes are not immediately available or
                                        who cannot deliver their Old Notes,
                                        the Letter of Transmittal or any other
                                        documents required by the Letter of
                                        Transmittal to the Exchange Agent
                                        prior to the Expiration Date must
                                        tender their Old Notes according to
                                        the guaranteed delivery procedures set
                                        forth in "The Exchange Offer--
                                        Procedures for Tendering Old Notes".
    Acceptance of Old Notes and
      Delivery of Exchange Notes  . .   The Company will accept for exchange
                                        any and all Old Notes which are
                                        properly tendered in the Exchange
                                        Offer prior to 5:00 p.m., New York
                                        City time, on the Expiration Date. The
                                        Exchange Notes issued pursuant to the
                                        Exchange Offer will be delivered
                                        promptly following the Expiration
                                        Date. See "The Exchange Offer--
                                        Acceptance of Old Notes for Exchange;
                                        Delivery of Exchange Notes".

    Effect on Holders of Old Notes  .   As a result of the making of, and upon
                                        acceptance for exchange of all validly
                                        tendered Old Notes pursuant to the
                                        terms of this Exchange Offer, the
                                        Company will have fulfilled a covenant
                                        contained in the Registration Rights
                                        Agreement (the "Registration Rights
                                        Agreement") dated April 30, 1997 among
                                        the Company and Lehman Brothers Inc.
                                        and BancAmerica Securities, Inc. (the
                                        "Initial Purchasers") and,
                                        accordingly, there will be no increase
                                        in the interest rate on the Old Notes
                                        pursuant to the terms of the
                                        Registration Rights Agreement, and the
                                        holders of the Old Notes will have no
                                        further registration or other rights
                                        under the Registration Rights
                                        Agreement. Holders of the Old Notes
                                        who do not tender their Old Notes in
                                        the Exchange Offer will continue to
<PAGE>
                                        hold such Old Notes and will be
                                        entitled to all the rights and
                                        limitations applicable thereto under
                                        the Indenture between the Company and
                                        The Bank of New York relating to the
                                        Old Notes and the Exchange Notes (the
                                        "Indenture"), except for any such
                                        rights under the Registration Rights
                                        Agreement that by their terms
                                        terminate or cease to have further
                                        effectiveness as a result of the
                                        making of, and the acceptance for
                                        exchange of all validly tendered Old
                                        Notes pursuant to, the Exchange Offer.
                                        All untendered Old Notes will continue
                                        to be subject to the restrictions on
                                        transfer provided for in the Old Notes
                                        and in the Indenture. To the extent
                                        that Old Notes are tendered and
                                        accepted in the Exchange Offer, the
                                        trading market for untendered Old
                                        Notes could be adversely affected.

    Consequence of Failure
      to Exchange   . . . . . . . . .   Holders of Old Notes who do not
                                        exchange their Old Notes for Exchange
                                        Notes pursuant to the Exchange Offer
                                        will continue to be subject to the
                                        restrictions on transfer of such Old
                                        Notes as set forth in the legend
                                        thereon as a consequence of the offer
                                        or sale of the Old Notes pursuant to
                                        an exemption from, or in a transaction
                                        not subject to, the registration
                                        requirements of the Securities Act and
                                        applicable state securities laws. In
                                        general, the Old Notes may not be
                                        offered or sold, unless registered
                                        under the Securities Act, except
                                        pursuant to an exemption from, or in a
                                        transaction not subject to, the
                                        Securities Act and applicable state
                                        securities laws. The Company does not
                                        currently anticipate that it will
                                        register the Old Notes under the
                                        Securities Act.

    Exchange Agent  . . . . . . . . .   The Bank of New York is serving as
                                        exchange agent (the "Exchange Agent")
                                        in connection with the Exchange Offer.
                                        See "The Exchange Offer--Exchange
                                        Agent".<PAGE>
                           Terms of the Exchange Notes

    Securities Offered  . . . . . . .   $225,000,000 aggregate principal
                                        amount of 10 3/8% Senior Subordinated
                                        Exchange Notes due 2007 (the "Exchange
                                        Notes").

    Maturity  . . . . . . . . . . . .   May 1, 2007.

    Interest Payment Dates  . . . . .   May 1 and November 1, commencing
                                        November 1, 1997.

    Optional Redemption . . . . . . .   The Exchange Notes may be redeemed at
                                        the option of the Company, in whole or
                                        in part, on or after May 1, 2002, at
                                        the redemption prices set forth
                                        herein, plus accrued and unpaid
                                        interest to the date of redemption.

                                        In addition, prior to May 1, 2000, the
                                        Company may redeem up to an aggregate
                                        of 35% of the Exchange Notes
                                        originally issued at a redemption
                                        price of 109.375% of the principal
                                        amount thereof, plus accrued and
                                        unpaid interest to the date of
                                        redemption, with the net cash proceeds
                                        of one or more Equity Offerings;
                                        provided, however, that at least 65%
                                        in aggregate principal amount of the
                                        Exchange Notes originally issued
                                        remain outstanding following such
                                        redemption.

    Change of Control . . . . . . . .   In the event of a Change of Control
                                        (as defined), the holders of the
                                        Exchange Notes will have the right to
                                        require the Company to purchase their
                                        Exchange Notes at a price equal to
                                        101% of the aggregate principal amount
                                        thereof, plus accrued and unpaid
                                        interest to the date of purchase.

    Ranking . . . . . . . . . . . . .   The Exchange Notes will be general
                                        unsecured obligations of the Company,
                                        subordinate in right of payment to all
                                        current and future Senior Debt
                                        including all obligations of the
                                        Company and its Subsidiaries under the
                                        Senior Credit Facilities. The Company
                                        currently has no subsidiaries. At
                                        March 31, 1997, on a pro forma basis
                                        after giving effect to the
                                        Transaction, the Company would have
                                        had $400.0 million of indebtedness
                                        outstanding, of which $175.0 million
                                        would have been Senior Debt (excluding
<PAGE>
                                        letters of credit). Borrowings under
                                        the Senior Credit Facilities are
                                        secured by substantially all of the
                                        assets of the Company as well as the
                                        capital stock of the Company and its
                                        Subsidiaries. See "Risk Factors--
                                        Substantial Leverage" and "--
                                        Subordination".

    Covenants . . . . . . . . . . . .   The Indenture pursuant to which the
                                        Exchange Notes will be issued (the
                                        "Indenture") contains certain
                                        covenants that, among other things,
                                        limit the ability of the Company and
                                        its Restricted Subsidiaries to incur
                                        additional Indebtedness and issue
                                        preferred stock, pay dividends or make
                                        other distributions, repurchase Equity
                                        Interests (as defined) or subordinated
                                        Indebtedness, create certain liens,
                                        enter into certain transactions with
                                        affiliates, sell assets of the Company
                                        or its Restricted Subsidiaries, issue
                                        or sell Equity Interests of the
                                        Company's Restricted Subsidiaries or
                                        enter into certain mergers and
                                        consolidations. In addition, under
                                        certain circumstances, the Company is
                                        required to offer to purchase Exchange
                                        Notes at a price equal to 100% of the
                                        principal amount thereof, plus accrued
                                        and unpaid interest to the date of
                                        purchase, with the proceeds of certain
                                        Asset Sales (as defined). See
                                        "Description of the Exchange Notes".

         For a discussion of certain risk factors that should be considered
    in connection with an investment in the Exchange Notes, see "Risk
    Factors".
<PAGE>
                        Summary Unaudited Pro Forma Financial Data

         The summary unaudited pro forma data as of March 31, 1997 and for
    the three months then ended and as of December 31, 1996 and for the year
    then ended have been derived from, and should be read in conjunction with,
    the unaudited pro forma combined financial statements included elsewhere
    herein. The unaudited pro forma data reflect the Acquisition and the
    Financing as if these transactions had occurred on March 31, 1997 for the
    balance sheet data and January 1, 1996 for the statement of operations and
    other data.

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                 Three Months
                                                                                    Ended             Year Ended
                                                                                March 31, 1997     December 31, 1996
                                                                               ----------------   -------------------
                                                                                           ($ in millions)
<S>                                                                            <C>                <C>

    Statement of Operations Data:
    Sales:
      Secure Communication Systems   . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .     $ 84.9               $371.5
      Specialized Communication Products   . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .       74.0                303.8
                                                                                   ------               ------
        Total sales  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .     $158.9               $675.3
                                                                                   ======               ======

    Other Data:
    EBITDA<F1>:
      Secure Communication Systems   . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .     $  4.9               $ 41.6
      Specialized Communication Products   . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .       10.8                 42.4
                                                                                   ------               ------
        Total EBITDA   . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .     $ 15.7               $ 84.0
                                                                                   ======               ======

    EBITDA as a percentage of sales:
      Secure Communication Systems   . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .        5.8%                11.2%
      Specialized Communication Products   . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .       14.6                 14.0
                                                                                   ------               ------
        Total EBITDA as a percentage of sales  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .        9.9%                12.4%
                                                                                   ======               ======

    Depreciation expense  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .      $  4.5               $ 18.0
    Amortization expense  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .         1.9                 10.0
    Capital expenditures  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .         4.3                 17.2
    Ratio of earnings to fixed charges<F2>  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .         <F4>                1.35x
    Ratio of total EBITDA to cash interest expense<F3>  . . . . . . . . . . .        1.54x                2.18x
    Ratio of total debt to total EBITDA . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .         N/A                 4.76x

    Balance Sheet Data:
    Working capital . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .      $117.5                  N/A
    Total assets  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .       659.5                  N/A
    Total debt  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .       400.0                  N/A
    Shareholders' equity  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .       115.8                  N/A

</TABLE>
<PAGE>
____________________
[FN]
<F1>   EBITDA is defined as income before deducting interest expense,
       income taxes, depreciation and amortization. EBITDA is not a
       substitute for operating income, net income and cash flow from
       operating activities as determined in accordance with generally
       accepted accounting principles as a measure of profitability or
       liquidity. EBITDA is presented as additional information because
       management believes it to be a useful indicator of the Company's
       ability to meet debt service and capital expenditure requirements
       and because certain debt covenants of L-3 utilize EBITDA to measure
       compliance with such covenants.
<F2>   For purposes of this computation, earnings consist of income before
       income taxes plus fixed charges. Fixed charges consist of interest
       on indebtedness plus that portion of lease rental expense
       representative of the interest factor.
<F3>   For purposes of this computation, cash interest expense consists of
       pro forma interest expense before amortization of deferred
       financing costs.
<F4>   For three months ended March 31, 1997, pro forma earnings were
       insufficient to cover fixed charges by $.9 million.
<PAGE>
                        Summary Historical Financial Data

         The following summary combined financial data as of March 31, 1997
    and 1996 and for the three month periods ended March 31, 1997 and as of
    December 31, 1996 and 1995 and for the years ended December 31, 1996, 1995
    and 1994 have been derived from, and should be read in conjunction with,
    the audited Combined Financial Statements of the Businesses and footnotes
    thereto included elsewhere herein. The summary combined financial data for
    the three months ended March 31, 1996 have been derived from, and should
    be read in conjunction with, the unaudited Combined Financial Statements
    of the Businesses and footnotes thereto included elsewhere herein. In the
    opinion of the management, the unaudited combined financial statements
    include all adjustments (consisting of normal recurring accruals)
    considered necessary for the fair presentation of the information
    contained therein. Results for the interim periods are not necessarily
    indicative of the results to be expected for the entire year.

         The unaudited summary combined financial data as of December 31,
    1994 and 1993, March 31, 1993 and December 31, 1992 for balance sheet data
    and the nine months ended December 31, 1993, the three months ended March
    31, 1993 and the year ended December 31, 1992 for statement of operations
    data have been derived from the unaudited financial statements of
    Communication Systems -- Camden. In the opinion of the Businesses'
    management, such unaudited financial statements reflect all adjustments
    (consisting of normal recurring adjustments) necessary to present fairly
    the financial position and results of operations of Communication Systems
    -- Camden, also referred to as Lockheed Martin Communication Systems
    Division in the Lockheed Martin Predecessor Financial Statements, as of
    the dates and periods indicated. These selected financial data should be
    read in conjunction with "Management's Discussion and Analysis of
    Financial Condition and Results of Operations" and the Combined Financial
    Statements of the Lockheed Martin Predecessor Businesses and the Loral
    Acquired Businesses included elsewhere herein.
<PAGE>
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                          
                                                                                     Years Ended December 31,
                                                                 ------------------------------------------------------------------
                                             For the Three                                               1993
                                                 Months                                       --------------------------
                                            Ended March 31,                                    Nine Months  Three Months
                                          ------------------                                      Ended         Ended
                                             1997    1996<F2>   1996<F1>  1995<F2>   1994<F2>  Dec. 31<F2>  March 31<F3>  1992<F3>
                                           --------  --------   --------  --------   --------  -----------  -----------   ---------
                                                                               ($ in millions)
<S>                                        <C>       <C>        <C>       <C>        <C>       <C>          <C>           <C>

    Statement of Operations Data:
    Sales . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .    $158.9      $41.2     $543.1    $166.8     $218.9      $200.0    |    $67.8       $368.5
    Operating income  . . . . . . . . .       7.9        1.7       43.7       4.7        8.4        12.4    |      5.1         49.3
    Allocated interest expense  . . . .       8.4        2.0       24.2       4.5        5.5         4.1    |      --           --
    Allocated (benefit) provision for                                                                       |
      income taxes  . . . . . . . . . .       (.2)        .2        7.8       1.2        2.3         3.8    |     2.0         19.8
    Net earnings (loss) . . . . . . . .       (.3)       (.5)      11.7      (1.0)       0.6         4.5    |     3.1         29.5
                                                                                                            |
                                                                                                            |
    Other Data:                                                                                             |
    EBITDA<F4>  . . . . . . . . . . . .    $ 15.1       $4.8     $ 68.7    $ 16.2     $19.9       $ 23.4    |    $ 7.0       $ 58.5
    Depreciation expense  . . . . . . .       4.5        1.2       14.9       5.5       5.4          6.1    |      1.8          8.9
    Amortization expense  . . . . . . .       2.7        1.9       10.1       6.1       6.1          4.9    |      0.1          0.3
    Capital expenditures  . . . . . . .       4.3         .4       13.5       5.5       3.7          2.6    |      0.8          3.9
    Ratio of earnings to fixed charges.       <F5>       <F5>      1.72x     1.03x     1.40x         N/A    |      N/A          N/A
    Cash from (used in) operating                                                                           |
      activities  . . . . . . . . . . . .   (16.3)      10.2       40.0       9.4       21.8         N/A    |     N/A          N/A
    Cash from (used in) investing                                                                           |
      activities  . . . . . . . . . . . .    (4.3)       (.4)    (298.2)     (5.5)      (3.7)        N/A    |     N/A          N/A
    Cash from (used in) financing                                                                           |
      activities  . . . . . . . . . . . .    20.6       (9.8)     267.3      (3.8)     (18.1)        N/A    |     N/A          N/A
                                                                                                            |
    Balance Sheet Data:                                                                                     |
    Working capital . . . . . . . . . .   $ 121.4        N/A    $  98.8      21.1     $ 19.3      $ 24.7    |    $ 22.8      $ 35.8
    Total assets  . . . . . . . . . . .     608.5        N/A      593.3     228.5      233.3       214.7    |      93.5       105.1
    Invested equity . . . . . . . . . .     493.9        N/A      473.6     194.7      199.5       202.0    |      59.9        72.8

</TABLE>
<PAGE>
____________________
[FN]
<F1>   Reflects ownership of Loral's Communication Systems -- Salt Lake
       and Specialized Communication Products businesses commencing
       April 1, 1996.
<F2>   Reflects ownership of Communication Systems -- Camden by Lockheed
       Martin commencing April 1, 1993.
<F3>   Reflects ownership of Communication Systems -- Camden by GE
       Aerospace for the periods indicated. The amounts shown herein
       include only those amounts as reflected in the financial records of
       Communication Systems -- Camden.
<F4>   EBITDA is defined as income before deducting interest expense,
       income taxes, depreciation and amortization. EBITDA is not a
       substitute for operating income, net earnings and cash flow from
       operating activities as determined in accordance with generally
       accepted accounting principles as a measure of profitability or
       liquidity. EBITDA is presented as additional information because
       management believes it to be a useful indicator of the Company's
       ability to meet debt service and capital expenditure requirements
       and because certain debt covenants of L-3 utilize EBITDA to measure
       compliance with such covenants.
<F5>   For the three months ended March 31, 1997 and 1996, earnings were
       insufficient to cover fixed charges by $.5 million and $.4 million,
       respectively.
<PAGE>
                                   RISK FACTORS

         Holders of Old Notes should consider carefully, in addition to the
    other information contained in this Prospectus, the following factors
    before deciding to tender Old Notes in the Exchange Offer. The risk
    factors set forth below are generally applicable to the Old Notes as well
    as the Exchange Notes. 

    Consequences of Failure to Exchange

         Holders of Old Notes who do not exchange their Old Notes for
    Exchange Notes pursuant to the Exchange Offer will continue to be subject
    to the restrictions on transfer of such Old Notes as set forth in the
    legend thereon. In general, Old Notes may not be offered or sold unless
    registered under the Securities Act, except pursuant to an exemption from,
    or in a transaction not subject to, the registration requirements of the
    Securities Act and applicable state securities laws. The Company does not
    currently intend to register the Old Notes under the Securities Act. Based
    on interpretations by the staff of the Commission, the Company believes
    that Exchange Notes issued pursuant to the Exchange Offer in exchange for
    Old Notes may be offered for resale, resold or otherwise transferred by
    Holders thereof (other than any such Holder which is an "affiliate" of the
    Company within the meaning of Rule 405 under the Securities Act) without
    compliance with the registration and prospectus delivery provisions of the
    Securities Act, provided that such Old Notes were acquired in the ordinary
    course of such Holders' business and such Holders have no arrangement with
    any person to participate in the distribution of such Exchange Notes. Each
    broker-dealer that receives Exchange Notes for its own account in exchange
    for Old Notes, where such Old Notes were acquired by such broker-dealer as
    a result of market-making activities or other trading activities, must
    acknowledge that it will deliver a prospectus in connection with any
    resale of such Exchange Notes. See "Plan of Distribution." To the extent
    that Old Notes are tendered and accepted in the Exchange Offer, the
    trading market for untendered and tendered but unaccepted Old Notes will
    be adversely affected. 

    Lack of Prior Market for the Exchange Notes

         The Exchange Notes are being offered to the holders of the Old
    Notes. The Old Notes were offered and sold in April 1997 to a small number
    of institutional investors and are eligible for trading in the Private
    Offerings, Resale and Trading through Automatic Linkages (PORTAL) Market. 

         The Company does not intend to apply for a listing of the Exchange
    Notes on a securities exchange. There is currently no established market
    for the Exchange Notes and there can be no assurance as to the liquidity
    of markets that may develop for the Exchange Notes, the ability of the
    holders of the Exchange Notes to sell their Exchange Notes or the price at
    which such holders would be able to sell their Exchange Notes. If such
    markets were to exist, the Exchange Notes could trade at prices that may
    be lower than the initial market values thereof depending on many factors,
    including prevailing interest rates and the markets for similar
    securities. Although there is currently no market for the Exchange Notes,
    the Initial Purchasers have advised the Company that they currently intend
    to make a market in the Exchange Notes. However, the Initial Purchasers
    are not obligated to do so, and any market making with respect to the
    Exchange Notes may be discontinued at any time without notice. 
<PAGE>
         The liquidity of, and trading market for, the Exchange Notes also
    may be adversely affected by general declines in the market for similar
    securities.

    Substantial Leverage

         The Company incurred substantial indebtedness in connection with the
    Transaction and the Company is highly leveraged. On a pro forma basis
    after giving effect to the Transaction, as of March 31, 1997, the Company
    would have had approximately $400 million of indebtedness outstanding
    (excluding letters of credit) and shareholders' equity of approximately
    $116 million (after giving effect to EITF 88-16 (as defined) accounting
    treatment relating to basis in leveraged buyout transactions by Holdings).
    Of the total $525 million used to consummate the Acquisition, $175 million
    (33.3%) was supplied by the Senior Credit Facilities, $225 million (42.9%)
    was supplied by the Old Exchange Notes, and, through Holdings, $80 million
    (15.2%) was supplied by equity purchases by the Lehman Partnership and
    Senior Management and $45 million (8.6%) contributed through equity
    retention in L-3 by Lockheed Martin. After giving pro forma effect to the
    Transaction, the Company's ratio of earnings to fixed charges would have
    been 1.35:1 for the year ended December 31, 1996, and for the three months
    ended March 31, 1997, pro forma earnings would have been insufficient to
    cover fixed charges by $.9 million. The Company may incur additional
    indebtedness in the future, subject to limitations imposed by the Senior
    Credit Facilities and the Indenture.

         Based upon the current level of operations and anticipated
    improvements, management believes that the Company's cash flow from
    operations, together with available borrowings under the Revolving Credit
    Facility, will be adequate to meet its anticipated requirements for
    working capital, capital expenditures, research and development
    expenditures, program and other discretionary investments, interest
    payments and scheduled principal payments. There can be no assurance,
    however, that the Company's business will continue to generate cash flow
    at or above current levels or that currently anticipated improvements will
    be achieved. If the Company is unable to generate sufficient cash flow
    from operations in the future to service its debt, it may be required to
    sell assets, reduce capital expenditures, refinance all or a portion of
    its existing debt (including the Notes) or obtain additional financing.
    The Company's ability to make scheduled principal payments of, to pay
    interest on or to refinance its indebtedness (including the Notes) depends
    on its future performance and financial results, which, to a certain
    extent, are subject to general economic, financial, competitive,
    legislative, regulatory and other factors beyond its control. There can be
    no assurance that sufficient funds will be available to enable the Company
    to service its indebtedness, including the Notes, or make necessary
    capital expenditures and program and other discretionary investments. See
    "Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results
    of Operations".

         The degree to which the Company is leveraged could have important
    consequences to Holders of the Notes, including, but not limited to, the
    following: (i) a substantial portion of the Company's cash flow from
    operations will be required to be dedicated to debt service and will not
    be available for other purposes including capital expenditures, research
    and development expenditures, and program and other discretionary
    investments; (ii) the Company's ability to obtain additional financing in
<PAGE>
    the future could be limited; (iii) certain of the Company's borrowings are
    at variable rates of interest, which could result in higher interest
    expense in the event of increases in interest rates; (iv) the Company may
    be more vulnerable to downturns in its business or in the general economy
    and may be restricted from making acquisitions, introducing new
    technologies and products or exploiting business opportunities; and
    (v) the Senior Credit Facilities and the Indenture contain financial and
    restrictive covenants that limit, among other things, the ability of the
    Company to borrow additional funds, dispose of assets or pay cash
    dividends. Failure by the Company to comply with such covenants could
    result in an event of default which, if not cured or waived, could have a
    material adverse effect on the Company. In addition, the degree to which
    the Company is leveraged could prevent it from repurchasing all Notes
    tendered to it upon the occurrence of a Change in Control, which would
    constitute an Event of Default under the Indenture. See "Description of
    the Exchange Notes" and "Description of Senior Credit Facilities".

    Lack of Independent Operating History

         Prior to the consummation of the Transaction, the Company's
    operations were conducted as divisions of Lockheed Martin, Loral, Unisys
    and GE Aerospace. Following consummation of the Transaction the Company
    operates independently of Lockheed Martin and is required to provide many
    corporate services on a stand-alone basis that were previously provided by
    Lockheed Martin, including corporate research and development, marketing,
    and general and administrative services including tax, treasury,
    management information systems, human resources and legal services.
    Lockheed Martin and the Company have agreed to enter into a Transition
    Services Agreement pursuant to which Lockheed Martin will provide certain
    of these services at costs consistent with past practices to the Company
    until December 31, 1997 (or in the case of Communication Systems -- Camden
    for a period of up to 18 months after the Closing). There can be no
    assurance that the actual corporate services costs incurred in operating
    the Company will not exceed historical charges or that upon termination of
    the Transition Services Agreement the Company will be able to obtain
    similar services on comparable terms.

    Future Acquisition Strategy

         The Company's strategy includes pursuing additional acquisitions
    that will complement its business. There can be no assurance, however,
    that the Company will be able to identify additional acquisition
    candidates on commercially reasonable terms or at all or that, if
    consummated, any anticipated benefits will be realized from such future
    acquisitions. In addition, the availability of additional acquisition
    financing cannot be assured and, depending on the terms of such additional
    acquisitions, could be restricted by the terms of the Senior Credit
    Facilities and/or the Indenture. The process of integrating acquired
    operations into the Company's existing operations may result in unforeseen
    operating difficulties and may require significant financial and
    managerial resources that would otherwise be available for the ongoing
    development or expansion of the Company's existing operations. Possible
    future acquisitions by the Company could result in the incurrence of
    additional debt, contingent liabilities and amortization expenses related
    to goodwill and other intangible assets, all of which could materially
    adversely affect the Company's financial condition and operating results.

<PAGE>
    Technological Change; New Product Development

         The communication equipment industry for defense applications and in
    general is characterized by rapidly changing technology. The Company's
    ability to compete successfully in this market will depend on its ability
    to design, develop, manufacture, assemble, test, market and support new
    products and enhancements on a timely and cost-effective basis. The
    Company has historically obtained technology from substantial
    customer-sponsored research and development as well as from internally
    funded research and development; however, there can be no assurance that
    the Company will continue to maintain comparable levels of
    customer-sponsored research and development in the future. See "Business--
    Research and Development". Substantial funds have been allocated to
    capital expenditures and program and other discretionary investments in
    the past and will continue to be required in the future. See "Management's
    Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations".
    There can be no assurance that the Company will successfully identify new
    opportunities and continue to have financial resources to develop new
    products in a timely or cost-effective manner, or that products and
    technologies developed by others will not render the Company's products
    and systems obsolete or non-competitive.

    Entry into Commercial Business

         The Company's revenues historically have been derived principally
    from business with the DoD and other government agencies. In addition to
    continuing to pursue this major market area, the Company intends to pursue
    a strategy that leverages the technical capabilities and expertise derived
    from its defense business to expand further into related commercial
    markets. Certain of the Company's commercial products, such as fixed
    wireless loop communication equipment and medical image archiving
    equipment, have only been recently introduced. As such, these new products
    are subject to certain risks, including the need to develop and maintain
    marketing, sales and customer support capabilities, to secure third-party
    manufacturing and distribution arrangements, to respond to rapid
    technological advances and, ultimately, to customer acceptance of these
    products. The Company's efforts to expand its presence in the commercial
    market will require significant resources including capital and management
    time. There can be no assurance that the Company will be successful in
    addressing these risks or in developing these commercial business
    opportunities.

    Pension Plan Liabilities

         The Transaction Agreement (as defined) provides that Lockheed Martin
    transfer certain assets to Holdings and L-3 and that Holdings and L-3
    assume certain liabilities relating to defined benefit pension plans for
    present and former employees and retirees of certain businesses being
    transferred to Holdings and L-3. Lockheed Martin received a letter from
    the Pension Benefit Guaranty Corporation (the "PBGC") which requested
    information regarding the transfer of such pension plans. The PBGC's
    letter indicated that it believed certain of the employee pension plans
    are underfunded using the PBGC's actuarial assumptions (which assumptions
    result in a larger liability for accrued benefits than the assumptions
    used for financial reporting under Statement of Financial Accounting
    Standards No. 87, "Accounting for Pension Costs" ("FASB 87")). The Company
    has calculated the net funding position of the pension plans to be
<PAGE>
    transferred and believes the plans to be overfunded by approximately $1
    million under ERISA (as defined) assumptions, underfunded by approximately
    $9 million under FASB 87 assumptions and, on a termination basis,
    underfunded by as much as $51 million under PBGC assumptions.
    Substantially all of the PBGC underfunding is related to two pension plans
    covering employees at L-3's Communication Systems -- Salt Lake and
    Aviation Recorders businesses.

         The Company, Lockheed Martin and the PBGC entered into certain
    agreements that include Lockheed Martin providing a commitment to the PBGC
    with regard to the Subject Plans (as defined) and the Company providing
    certain assurances to Lockheed Martin regarding such plans. See
    "Business--Pension Plans". The Company expects, based in part upon
    discussions with its consulting actuaries, that any increase in pension
    expenses or future funding requirements from those previously anticipated
    for the Subject Plans would not be material. However, there can be no
    assurance that the impact of any increased pension expenses or funding
    requirements under this arrangement would not be material to the Company. 

    Significant Customers

         The Company's sales are predominantly derived from contracts with
    agencies of, and prime contractors to, the Government. Although the
    various branches of the Government are subject to the same budgetary
    pressures and other factors, the various Government customers exercise
    independent purchasing decisions. The U.S. defense budget has declined in
    real terms since the mid-1980s, resulting in delays for some new program
    starts, program stretch-outs and program cancellations. The U.S. defense
    budget has begun to stabilize and increased modestly in fiscal 1996. In
    1996, the Company performed under approximately 180 contracts with value
    exceeding $1 million for the Government. Pro forma sales in 1996 to the
    Government, including pro forma sales to the Government through prime
    contractors, were $529 million, representing approximately 78.4% of the
    Company's corresponding sales. The Company's largest Government program, a
    cost plus, sole source contract for support of the U-2 Directorate of the
    DoD, contributed 14% of pro forma sales for 1996. No other program
    represented more than 7% of the Company's pro forma sales in 1996. The
    loss of all or a substantial portion of sales to the Government would have
    a material adverse effect on the Company's income and cash flow. See
    "Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results
    of Operations" and "Business--Government Contracts".

         Historical sales by the Company to Lockheed Martin were $70.7
    million in 1996 or 13.0% of the Company's total reported historical sales.
    As a part of the Acquisition, the Company and Lockheed Martin intend to
    enter into certain purchase agreements for the sale of products and
    systems to Lockheed Martin by the Company. The loss of all or a
    substantial portion of such sales to Lockheed Martin would have a material
    adverse effect on the Company's income and cash flow.

    Dependence on Lockheed Martin

         In addition to the above-mentioned sales to Lockheed Martin, the
    Company continues to be dependent on Lockheed Martin for certain services
    and continuing agreements. Lockheed Martin has agreed to indemnify the
    Company, subject to certain limitations, for its breach of representations
<PAGE>
    and warranties contained in the Transaction Agreement. Lockheed Martin
    also has agreed to provide to the Company certain corporate services of a
    type currently provided to the Businesses at costs consistent with past
    practices. The Company and Lockheed Martin have entered into (i) supply
    agreements which reflect existing intercompany work transfer agreements or
    similar support arrangements with prices and other terms consistent with
    the present intercompany arrangements, (ii) certain subleases of real
    property and (iii) cross-licenses of intellectual property. There can be
    no assurance that, after the termination of these arrangements, the
    Company will be able to obtain these services or arrangements at
    comparable costs. Further, Lockheed Martin has entered into a
    non-competition agreement which, for up to three years after the Closing,
    offers a measure of protection to the Company's material core business
    while permitting Lockheed Martin to, among other things, continue its
    existing and currently planned businesses. The Company has also entered
    into agreements with Lockheed Martin relating to the PBGC matter discussed
    above.

    Dependence on Key Personnel

         The Company's success depends to a significant degree upon the
    continued contributions of the Company's management, including Messrs.
    Lanza and LaPenta, and its ability to attract and retain other highly
    qualified management and technical personnel. As part of the Transaction,
    Messrs. Lanza and LaPenta invested $15 million to purchase 15% of the
    initial capital stock of the Company. The Company has entered into
    employment agreements with Messrs. Lanza and LaPenta. The Company
    maintains key man life insurance to cover Senior Management. The Company
    also faces competition for management and technical personnel from other
    companies and organizations. There can be no assurance that the Company
    will be successful in hiring and retaining key personnel. See
    "Management--Directors and Executive Officers".

    Environmental Liabilities

         The Company's operations are subject to various federal, state and
    local environmental laws and regulations relating to the discharge,
    storage, treatment, handling, disposal and remediation of certain
    materials, substances and wastes used in or resulting from its operations.
    The Company continually assesses its obligations and compliance with
    respect to these requirements. Based on a review by an independent
    environmental consulting firm and its own internal assessments, management
    believes that the Company's current operations are in substantial
    compliance with all existing applicable environmental laws and
    regulations. New environmental protection laws that will be effective in
    1997 and thereafter may require the installation of environmental
    protection equipment at the Company's manufacturing facilities. However,
    the Company does not believe that its environmental expenditures, if any,
    will have a material adverse effect on its financial condition or results
    of operations.

         Pursuant to the Transaction Agreement, the Company has agreed to
    assume certain on-site and off-site environmental liabilities related to
    events or activities occurring prior to the consummation of the
    Transaction. Lockheed Martin has agreed to retain all environmental
    liabilities for all facilities no longer used by the Businesses and to
<PAGE>
    indemnify fully the Company for such prior site environmental liabilities.
    Lockheed Martin has also agreed, for the first eight years following the
    Closing, to pay 50% of all costs incurred by the Company above those
    reserved for on the Company's balance sheet at closing relating to certain
    Company-assumed environmental liabilities and, for the seven years
    thereafter, to pay 40% of certain reasonable operation and maintenance
    costs relating to any environmental remediation projects undertaken in the
    first eight years. The Company is aware of environmental contamination at
    two of its facilities that will require ongoing remediation. Management
    believes that the Company has established adequate reserves for the
    potential costs associated with the assumed environmental liabilities.
    However, there can be no assurance that any costs incurred will be
    reimbursable from the Government or covered by Lockheed Martin under the
    terms of the Transaction Agreement or that the Company's environmental
    reserves will be sufficient.

    Litigation

         From time to time the Company is involved in legal proceedings
    arising in the ordinary course of its business. As part of the
    Acquisition, the Company has agreed to assume certain litigation relating
    to the Businesses and Lockheed Martin has agreed to indemnify the Company,
    up to certain limits, for a breach of its representations and warranties.
    Management believes it is adequately reserved for these liabilities and
    that there is no litigation pending that could have a material adverse
    effect on the Company or its operations, except as discussed below.

         As of June 30, 1997, the Company and Universal Avionics Systems
    Corporation ("Universal") has reached a settlement with respect to a
    lawsuit brought by Universal against the Company's Aviation Recorders
    operation ("Aviation Recorders"). The terms of this settlement will not
    have a material adverse effect on the Company's financial condition or
    results of operations.

    Risks Inherent in Government Contracts

         The reduction in the U.S. defense budget has caused most
    defense-related government contractors to experience declining revenues,
    increased pressure on operating margins and, in few cases, net losses. The
    Company has experienced declining sales in each of its last five fiscal
    years. Specifically, adjusted sales of the Company and its predecessors
    have decreased from $925.5 million for the fiscal year ended December 31,
    1992 to $664.7 million for the fiscal year ended December 31, 1996. A
    significant further decline in U.S. military expenditures could materially
    adversely affect the Company's sales and earnings. The loss or significant
    curtailment of a material program in which the Company participates could
    also materially adversely affect the Company's future sales and earnings
    and thus the Company's ability to meet its financial obligations.

         Companies engaged primarily in supplying defense-related equipment
    and services to government agencies are subject to certain business risks
    peculiar to the defense industry. These risks include, among other things,
    the ability of the Government to: (i) suspend unilaterally the Company
    from receiving new contracts pending resolution of alleged violations of
    procurement laws or regulations, (ii) terminate existing contracts,
    (iii) audit the Company's contract related costs and fees, including
<PAGE>
    allocated indirect costs, and (iv) control and potentially prohibit the
    export of the Company's products.

         All of the Company's Government contracts are, by their terms,
    subject to termination by the Government either for its convenience or for
    default of the contractor. Termination for convenience provisions provide
    only for the recovery by the Company of costs incurred or committed,
    settlement expenses and profit on work completed prior to termination.
    Termination for default provisions provide for the contractor to be liable
    for excess costs incurred by the Government in procuring undelivered items
    from another source. In addition to the right of the Government to
    terminate, Government contracts are conditioned upon the continuing
    availability of Congressional appropriations. Congress usually
    appropriates funds for a given program on a fiscal-year basis even though
    contract performance may take more than one year. Consequently, at the
    outset of a major program, the contract is usually partially funded, and
    additional monies are normally committed to the contract by the procuring
    agency only if, as and when appropriations are made by Congress for future
    fiscal years. Foreign defense contracts generally contain comparable
    provisions relating to termination at the convenience of the government.

         The Company is subject to audit and review by the Government of its
    costs and performance on, and accounting and general business practices
    relating to, Government contracts. The Company's contract related costs
    and fees, including allocated indirect costs, are subject to adjustment
    based on the results of such audits. In addition, under Government
    purchasing regulations, certain of the Company's costs, including certain
    financing costs, goodwill, portions of research and development costs, and
    certain marketing expenses may not be reimbursable under Government
    contracts. Further, as a government contractor, the Company is also
    subject to investigation, legal action and/or liability that would not
    apply to a commercial company.

         The Company, like all defense businesses, is subject to risks
    associated with the frequent need to bid on programs in advance of design
    completion (which may result in unforeseen technological difficulties
    and/or cost overruns), the substantial time and effort required for
    relatively unproductive design and development, design complexity and
    rapid obsolescence, and the constant necessity for design improvement. The
    Company obtains many of its Government contracts through a process of
    competitive bidding. There can be no assurance that the Company will
    continue to be successful in winning competitively awarded contracts or
    that awarded contracts will generate sufficient sales to result in
    profitability for the Company. See "Business--Major Customers" and "--
    Government Contracts".

         In addition to these Government contract risks, many of the
    Company's products and systems require licenses from Government agencies
    for export from the United States, and certain of the Company's products
    currently are not permitted to be exported. There can be no assurance that
    the Company will be able to gain any and all licenses required to export
    its products, and failure to receive the required licenses could
    materially reduce the Company's ability to sell its products outside the
    United States.
<PAGE>
         The Company's services are provided primarily through fixed price or
    cost plus contracts. Approximately 58% of the Company's pro forma sales in
    1996 were attributable to fixed price contracts. The financial results of
    long-term fixed price contracts are recognized using the cost-to-cost
    percentage-of-completion method. As a result, revisions in revenues and
    profit estimates are reflected in the period in which the conditions that
    require such revisions become known and are estimable. The risks inherent
    in long-term fixed price contracts include the difficulty of forecasting
    costs and schedules, contract revenues that are related to performance in
    accordance with contract specifications and potential for component
    obsolescence in connection with long-term procurements. Failure to
    anticipate technical problems, estimate costs accurately or control costs
    during performance of a fixed price contract may reduce the Company's
    profitability or cause a loss. Although the Company believes that adequate
    provision for its fixed price contracts is reflected in its financial
    statements, no assurance can be given that this provision is adequate or
    that losses on fixed price and time-and-material contracts will not occur
    in the future.

    Backlog

         The Company's backlog represents orders under contracts which are
    primarily with the Government. The Government enjoys broad rights to
    unilaterally modify or terminate such contracts. Accordingly, most of the
    Company's backlog is subject to modification and termination at the
    Government's will. There can be no assurance that the Company's backlog
    will become revenues in any particular period or at all. Further, there
    can be no assurance that the margins on any contract included in backlog
    that does become revenue will be profitable.

    Competition

         The communications equipment industry for defense applications and
    as a whole is highly competitive. Declining defense budgets and increasing
    pressures for cost reductions have precipitated a major consolidation in
    the defense industry. The DoD's increased use of commercial off-the-shelf
    products and components in military equipment is expected to increase the
    entrance of new competitors. In addition, consolidation has resulted in
    delays in contract funding or awards and significant predatory pricing
    pressures associated with increased competition and reduced funding. The
    Company expects that the emergence of merchant suppliers will increase
    competition for OEM business. The Company's ability to compete for defense
    contracts depends to a large extent on the effectiveness and
    innovativeness of its research and development programs, its ability to
    offer better program performance than its competitors at a lower cost to
    the Government customer and its readiness in facilities, equipment and
    personnel to undertake the programs for which it competes. In some
    instances, programs are sole source or work directed by the Government to
    a single supplier. In such cases, there may be other suppliers who have
    the capability to compete for the programs involved, but they can only
    enter or reenter the market if the Government should choose to reopen the
    particular program to competition. Many of the Company's competitors are
    larger and have substantially greater financial and other resources than
    the Company. See "Business--Competition".
<PAGE>
    Ownership of Holdings and the Company

         The Lehman Partnership owns a majority of the outstanding voting
    stock of Holdings, which owns all of the outstanding common stock of the
    Company. By virtue of such ownership, the Lehman Partnership has the power
    to direct the affairs of the Company and is able to determine the outcome
    of substantially all matters required to be submitted to stockholders for 
    approval, including the election of a majority of the Company's directors 
    and, except to the extent otherwise required by law, amendment of the 
    Company's Certificate of Incorporation. See "The Transaction" and 
    "Ownership of Capital Stock".

    Subordination

         The Company's obligations under the Notes are subordinate and junior
    in right of payment to all existing and future Senior Debt of the Company.
    As of March 31, 1997, on a pro forma basis after giving effect to the
    Transaction, the Company would have had approximately $400 million of
    indebtedness outstanding, of which $175 million would have been Senior
    Debt (excluding letters of credit). Additional Senior Debt may be incurred
    by the Company from time to time, subject to certain restrictions. By
    reason of such subordination, in the event of an insolvency, liquidation,
    or other reorganization of the Company, the lenders under the Senior
    Credit Facilities and other creditors who are holders of Senior Debt must
    be paid in full before the holders of the Notes may be paid; accordingly,
    there may be insufficient assets remaining after payment of prior claims
    to pay amounts due on the Notes. In addition, under certain circumstances,
    no payments may be made with respect to the Notes if a default exists with
    respect to certain Senior Debt. See "Description of the Exchange Notes--
    Subordination".

    Restrictions Imposed by the Senior Credit Facilities and the Indenture

         The Senior Credit Facilities and the Indenture contain a number of
    significant covenants that, among other things, restrict the ability of
    the Company to dispose of assets, incur additional indebtedness, repay
    other indebtedness, pay dividends, make certain investments or
    acquisitions, repurchase or redeem capital stock, engage in mergers or
    consolidations, or engage in certain transactions with subsidiaries and
    affiliates and otherwise restrict corporate activities. There can be no
    assurance that such restrictions will not adversely affect the Company's
    ability to finance its future operations or capital needs or engage in
    other business activities that may be in the interest of the Company. In
    addition, the Senior Credit Facilities also require the Company to
    maintain compliance with certain financial ratios, including total EBITDA
    to total interest expense and total debt to total EBITDA, and limit
    capital expenditures by the Company. The ability of the Company to comply
    with such ratios and limits may be affected by events beyond the Company's
    control. A breach of any of these covenants or the inability of the
    Company to comply with the required financial ratios or limits could
    result in a default under the Senior Credit Facilities. In the event of
    any such default, the lenders under the Senior Credit Facilities could
    elect to declare all borrowings outstanding under the Senior Credit
    Facilities, together with accrued interest and other fees, to be due and
    payable, to require the Company to apply all of its available cash to
    repay such borrowings or to prevent the Company from making debt service
<PAGE>
    payments on the Notes, any of which would be an Event of Default under the
    Notes. If the Company were unable to repay any such borrowings when due,
    the lenders could proceed against their collateral. In connection with the
    Senior Credit Facilities, the Company has granted the lenders thereunder a
    first priority lien on substantially all of its assets. The lenders under
    the Senior Credit Facilities will also have a first priority security
    interest in all of the capital stock of the Company and its subsidiaries.
    If the indebtedness under the Senior Credit Facilities or the Notes were
    to be accelerated, there can be no assurance that the assets of the
    Company would be sufficient to repay such indebtedness in full. See
    "Description of the Exchange Notes" and "Description of Senior Credit
    Facilities".

    Fraudulent Conveyance

         The Old Notes were incurred to finance the acquisition of the
    Businesses from Lockheed Martin. Management believes that the indebtedness
    of the Company represented by the Senior Credit Facilities and the Notes
    were incurred for proper purposes and in good faith, and that, based on
    present forecasts and other financial information, after the consummation
    of the Transaction and the issuance of the Notes, the Company will be
    solvent, will have sufficient capital for carrying on its business and
    will be able to pay its debts as they mature. Notwithstanding management's
    belief, however, under federal and state fraudulent transfer laws, if a
    court of competent jurisdiction in a suit by an unpaid creditor or a
    representative of creditors (such as a trustee in bankruptcy or a
    debtor-in-possession) were to find that, at the time of the incurrence of
    such indebtedness, the Company was insolvent, was rendered insolvent by
    reason of such incurrence, was engaged in a business or transaction for
    which its remaining assets constituted unreasonable small capital,
    intended to incur, or believed that it would incur, debts beyond its
    ability to pay such debts as they matured, or intended to hinder, delay or
    defraud its creditors, and that the indebtedness was incurred for less
    than reasonably equivalent value, then such court could, among other
    things, (i) void all or a portion of the Company's obligations to the
    Holders of the Exchange Notes, the effect of which would be that the
    Holders of the Exchange Notes might not be repaid in full and/or (ii)
    subordinate the Company's obligations to the Holders of the Exchange Notes
    to other existing and future indebtedness of the Company to a greater
    extent than would otherwise be the case, the effect of which would be to
    entitle such other creditors to which the Exchange Notes were not
    previously subordinated to be paid in full before any payment could be
    made on the Exchange Notes. See "--Substantial Leverage" above.

    Limitation on Change of Control

         The Indenture provides that, upon the occurrence of a Change of
    Control of the Company or Holdings, the Company will make an offer to
    purchase all of the Exchange Notes at a price in cash equal to 101% of the
    aggregate principal amount thereof together with accrued and unpaid
    interest to the date of purchase. The Senior Credit Facilities currently
    prohibit the Company from repurchasing any Exchange Notes except with the
    proceeds of one or more Equity Offerings. The Senior Credit Facilities
    also provide that certain change of control events with respect to the
    Company would constitute a default thereunder. Any future credit
<PAGE>
    agreements or other agreements relating to Senior Debt to which the
    Company becomes a party may contain similar restrictions and provisions.
    In the event a Change of Control event occurs at a time when the Company
    is prohibited from purchasing the Exchange Notes, or if the Company is
    required to make a Net Proceeds Offer (as defined) pursuant to the terms
    of the Exchange Notes, the Company could seek the consent of its lenders
    to the purchase of the Exchange Notes or could attempt to refinance the
    borrowings that contain such prohibition. If the Company does not obtain
    such a consent or repay such borrowings, the Company will remain
    prohibited from purchasing the Exchange Notes. In such case, the Company's
    failure to make such an offer or to purchase tendered Exchange Notes would
    constitute an Event of Default under the Indenture. If, as a result
    thereof, a default occurs with respect to any Senior Debt, the
    subordination provisions in the Indenture would likely restrict payments
    to the holders of the Exchange Notes. The provisions relating to a Change
    of Control included in the Indenture may increase the difficulty of a
    potential acquiror obtaining control of the Company. See "Description of
    the Exchange Notes--Repurchase at the Option of Holders--Change of
    Control".

    Lack of Public Market for the Exchange Notes

         The Company does not intend to apply for a listing of the Exchange
    Notes on a securities exchange or on any automated dealer quotation
    system. There is currently no established market for the Exchange Notes
    and there can be no assurance as to the liquidity of markets that may
    develop for the Exchange Notes, the ability of the holders of the Exchange
    Notes to sell their Exchange Notes or the price at which such holders
    would be able to sell their Exchange Notes. If such markets were to exist,
    the Exchange Notes could trade at prices that may be lower than the
    initial market value thereof depending on many factors, including
    prevailing interest rates and the markets for similar securities. The
    Exchange Notes are expected to be designated for trading in the PORTAL
    market. The Initial Purchasers have advised the Company that they
    currently intend to make a market with respect to the Exchange Notes.
    However, the Initial Purchasers are not obligated to do so, and any market
    making with respect to the Exchange Notes may be discontinued at any time
    without notice. In addition, such market making activity may be limited
    during the pendency of the Exchange Offer or the effectiveness of a shelf
    registration statement in lieu thereof. Because Lehman Brothers Inc. is an
    affiliate of the Company, following consummation of the Exchange Offer
    Lehman Brothers Inc. will be required to deliver a current "market-maker"
    prospectus and otherwise comply with the registration requirements of the
    Securities Act in connection with any secondary market sale of the New
    Exchange Notes, which may affect its ability to continue market-making
    activities. See "Notice to Investors" and "Plan of Distribution".

         The liquidity of, and trading market for, the Notes also may be
    adversely affected by general declines in the market for similar
    securities. Such a decline may adversely affect such liquidity and trading
    markets independent of the financial performance of, and prospects for,
    the Company.
<PAGE>
    Forward Looking Statements

         This Prospectus contains forward looking statements concerning the
    Company's operations, economic performance and financial condition,
    including in particular, the likelihood of the Company's success in
    operating as an independent company and developing and expanding its
    business and the realization of sales from backlog. These statements are
    based upon a number of assumptions and estimates which are inherently
    subject to significant uncertainties and contingencies, many of which are
    beyond the control of the Company, and reflect future business decisions
    which are subject to change. Some of these assumptions inevitably will not
    materialize, and unanticipated events will occur which will affect the
    Company's future results. All such forward looking statements are
    qualified by reference to matters discussed under this section entitled
    "Risk Factors".
<PAGE>
                                 USE OF PROCEEDS

         There will be no proceeds to the Company from the exchange of Notes
    pursuant to the Exchange Offer. 

         The net proceeds received by the Company from the Offering of the
    Old Notes, approximately $217.3 million after deducting discounts and
    estimated fees and expenses, together with the borrowings under the Senior
    Credit Facilities, were used to pay, in part, the cash portion of the
    purchase price of the Acquisition and pay related fees and expenses.


                                  CAPITALIZATION

         The following table sets forth the pro forma capitalization of L-3
    at March 31, 1997 after giving effect to the Transaction.


<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                        March 31, 1997
                                                     ---------------------
                                                       ($ in millions)
<S>                                                  <C>

    Revolving Credit Facility<F1> . . . . . .                 --
    Term Loan Facilities  . . . . . . . . . .             $175.0
    10 3/8% Senior Subordinated Notes
      due 2007  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .              225.0
                                                           -----
       Total Debt   . . . . . . . . . . . . .              400.0
    Shareholders' Equity
     Paid in Capital<F2>  . . . . . . . . . .              115.8
                                                           -----
          Total Capitalization  . . . . . . .             $515.8
                                                          ======
__________________________
<FN>
<F1> Availability of up to $100 million, none of which was drawn at
     Closing other than letters of credit, which were less than $10
     million.
<F2> Reflects the "Push Down" of Holdings' basis of its investment in the
     Company. The Acquisition was accounted for by Holdings as a purchase
     transaction in accordance with Accounting Principles Board Opinion
     No. 16. However, as a result of the 34.9% ownership retained by
     Lockheed Martin, the provisions of the Financial Accounting
     Standards Board's Emerging Issues Task Force Issue No. 88-16, "Basis
     in Leveraged Buyout Transactions" ("EITF 88-16"), is applied in
     connection with the allocation of purchase price to the acquired net
     assets. The application of the provisions of EITF 88-16 results in
     recording net assets acquired at approximately 34.9% of Lockheed
     Martin's carrying values plus 65.1% of fair value and the recording
     of a deemed distribution, estimated to be approximately $9.2
     million.

</TABLE>
<PAGE>
         UNAUDITED PRO FORMA CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

         The following unaudited pro forma financial information gives effect
    to (i) the purchase of the Businesses by Holdings and the Company, (ii) 
    the transfer of certain other assets and liabilities to the Company by 
    Lockheed Martin, (iii) the Financing, (iv) the initial capitalization of
    the Company and (v) the "push down" of Holdings' basis of its investment 
    in the Company. The unaudited pro forma condensed consolidated statement 
    of operations assumes the transactions occurred as of January 1, 1996. 
    The unaudited pro forma condensed consolidated balance sheet assumes the 
    transactions occurred as of March 31, 1997. The pro forma financial 
    information is based on the historical combined financial statements of 
    the Lockheed Martin Predecessor Businesses for the three months ended 
    March 31, 1997 and the year ended December 31, 1996 (which include the 
    results of the Loral Acquired Businesses for the nine months ended 
    December 31, 1996) and the Loral Acquired Businesses for the three months 
    ended March 31, 1996 using the purchase method of accounting and the 
    assumptions and adjustments in the accompanying notes to the unaudited 
    pro forma condensed consolidated financial statements.

         The pro forma adjustments are based upon preliminary estimates.
    Actual adjustments will be based on appraisals and other analyses of fair
    values and adjustment of the final purchase price. The pro forma statement
    of operations does not reflect any costs savings that management believes
    would have resulted had the transactions occurred on January 1, 1996. The
    pro forma financial information should be read in conjunction with the
    audited combined financial statements and notes of the respective
    entities. The pro forma data may not be indicative of the results that
    actually would have occurred had the transactions been in effect on the
    dates indicated or results that may be obtained in the future.

     Unaudited Pro Forma Condensed Consolidated Statement of Operations Data
<PAGE>
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                        
                                   Three Months Ended March 31, 1997                   Year Ended December 31, 1996
                               ----------------------------------------   --------------------------------------------------------
                                   Lockheed                                Lockheed       
                                    Martin                                  Martin         Loral
                                 Predecessor    Pro forma   Pro forma     Predecessor     Acquired        Pro forma    Pro forma
                                Businesses<F1> Adjustments Consolidated  Businesses<F1> Businesses<F1>   Adjustments  Consolidated
                               --------------  ----------- ------------  -------------  --------------   -----------  ------------
                                                                          ($ in millions)
<S>                            <C>             <C>         <C>           <C>            <C>              <C>          <C>

    Statement of Operations
    Data:
    Sales . . . . . . . . . .    $158.9       $ --           $158.9        $543.1         $132.2         $  __           $675.3
    Cost of sales . . . . . .     151.0       (1.4)<F4><F6>   149.6         499.4          124.4           (4.5)<F4><F6>  619.3
                                 ------       ----           ------        ------         ------          -----          ------

     Operating income   . . .       7.9        1.4              9.3          43.7            7.8            4.5            56.0
    Interest expense  . . . .       8.4        1.8<F3>         10.2          24.2            4.4           12.0<F3>        40.6
                                 ------       ----           ------        ------         ------          -----          ------
     Earnings (loss) before
       income taxes   . . . .       (.5)       (.4)             (.9)         19.5            3.4           (7.5)           15.4
    Income tax expense              (.2)       (.2)<F5>         (.4)          7.8            1.3           (3.0)<F5>        6.1
      (benefit) . . . . . . . .  ------       ----           ------        ------         ------          -----          ------
     Net earnings (loss)  . .    $  (.3)       (.2)             (.5)       $ 11.7         $  2.1          $(4.5)         $  9.3
                                 ======       ====           ======        ======         ======          =====          ======

____________________
<FN>
<F1>   The statement of operations data include the results of the
       Lockheed Martin Predecessor Businesses for the year ended December
       31, 1996 (which include the results of the Loral Acquired
       Businesses for the nine months ended December 31, 1996) and the
       results of the Loral Acquired Businesses for the three months ended
       March 31, 1996.

</TABLE>



                  See notes to Unaudited Pro Forma Condensed
                       Consolidated Financial Statements.
<PAGE>
            Unaudited Pro Forma Condensed Consolidated Balance Sheet


<TABLE>
<CAPTION>

                                                                                    At March 31, 1997
                                                     -----------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                                         Lockheed
                                                          Martin          Assets and
                                                        Predecessor      Liabilities        Pro forma            Pro forma
                                                        Businesses       Assumed<F6>        Adjustments         Consolidated
                                                     ---------------   ---------------  -------------------   -----------------
                                                                                     ($ in millions)
<S>                                                  <C>               <C>              <C>                   <C>

    ASSETS
    Current assets
     Contracts in process   . . . . . . . . . . . .     $215.6            $  3.0             ($1.4)<F4>              $217.2
     Other current assets   . . . . . . . . . . . .        4.1                .1                --                      4.2
                                                         -----             -----              ----                    -----
       Total current assets   . . . . . . . . . . .      219.7               3.1              (1.4)                   221.4
    Property, plant and equipment, net  . . . . . .       91.4               9.2               5.0                    105.6
    Intangibles, primarily cost in excess of net
     assets acquired  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .      280.1               1.1               16.7<F4>               297.9
    Other assets  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .       17.3                .3               17.0<F1><F4><F6>        34.6
                                                         -----             -----               -----                  -----
                                                        $608.5            $ 13.7             $ 37.3                  $659.5
                                                        ======            ======             ======                  ======

    LIABILITIES AND SHAREHOLDERS' EQUITY
    Current liabilities
     Accounts payable trade   . . . . . . . . . . .     $ 34.0            $   .2                 --                  $ 34.2
     Accrued employment costs   . . . . . . . . . .       26.7                --                 --                    26.7
     Billings and estimated earnings in excess of
       cost   . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .       12.4                --                 --                    12.4
     Current portion of long-term debt  . . . . . .         --                --                5.0<F3>                 5.0     
     Other current liabilities  . . . . . . . . . .       25.2                .4                 --                    25.6
                                                         -----             -----               ----                   -----
       Total current liabilities  . . . . . . . . .       98.3                .6                5.0                   103.9

    Long-term debt  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .         --                --              395.0<F3>               395.0

    Other liabilities . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .       16.3              28.5                 --                    44.8

    Shareholders' equity
     Common stock   . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .         --                --                 --                      --
     Capital surplus  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .         --                --              125.0<F3>               125.0
     Invested equity  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .      493.9             (15.4)            (478.5)                     --
     Deemed distribution  . . . . . . . . . . . . .         --                --               (9.2)<F2>               (9.2)
                                                         -----             -----             ------                   -----
       Total shareholders' equity   . . . . . . . .      493.9             (15.4)            (362.7)                  115.8
                                                         -----             -----             ------                   -----
                                                        $608.5            $ 13.7             $ 37.3                  $659.5
                                                        ======            ======             ======                  ======

</TABLE>
              See notes to Unaudited Pro Forma Condensed Consolidated
                                Financial Statements.
<PAGE>
     Notes to Unaudited Pro Forma Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements

         The following facts and assumptions were used in determining the pro
    forma effect of the Transaction.

<F1> Holdings and Lockheed Martin entered into a Transaction Agreement
     dated as of March 28, 1997 ("Transaction Agreement") whereby
     Holdings acquired effective April 1, 1997 substantially all of the
     assets and certain liabilities of ten business units of Lockheed
     Martin that comprise the Company's Secured Communication Systems and
     Specialized Communication Products businesses. As a result of the
     Acquisition, Lockheed Martin, the Lehman Partnership and Senior
     Management own 34.9%, 50.1% and 15.0% of common equity,
     respectively, of Holdings, the sole stockholder of the Company. The
     purchase price of $525.0 million comprised $479.8 million of cash
     and $45.2 million of Holdings' common equity retained by Lockheed
     Martin. The cash portion of the purchase price is subject to certain
     agreed upon adjustments and other adjustments based upon the closing
     tangible net asset value as defined in the Transaction Agreement.
     For purposes of the pro forma financial information, a reduction
     in the purchase price of $20.0 million has been assumed pursuant to
     the Transaction Agreement. Costs related to the Transaction are
     estimated to approximate $20.0 million of which $14.0 million is
     related to the Financing and is included in other assets. Holdings
     and the Company had no operations until the consummation of the
     acquisition; accordingly, the pro forma financial statements
     reflect the combined balance sheet of the Lockheed Martin
     Predecessor Businesses at March 31, 1997 and for the year ended
     December 31, 1996 the combined statement of operations of the
     Lockheed Martin Predecessor Businesses and Loral Acquires
     Businesses for the year ended December 31, 1996 and the three
     months ended March 31, 1996, respectively.

<F2> The Pro Forma Financial Statements reflect the "Push Down" of
     Holdings' basis of its investment in the Company. The Acquisition
     has been accounted for by Holdings as a purchase transaction in
     accordance with Accounting Principles Board Opinion No. 16. However,
     as a result of the 34.9% ownership interest retained by Lockheed
     Martin, the provisions of EITF 88-16 is applied in connection with
     the allocation of purchase price to the acquired net assets. The
     application of the provisions of EITF 88-16 results in recording net
     assets acquired at approximately 34.9% of Lockheed Martin's carrying
     values plus 65.1% of fair value and the recording of a deemed
     distribution, estimated to be approximately $9.2 million.

<F3> The Acquisition was financed with the proceeds of $175 million of
     Term Loan Facilities, $225 million of Exchange Notes and capital
     contributions of $125 million, including the $45.2 million retained
     by Lockheed Martin. The pro forma statement of operations reflects
     the elimination of $8.4 million for the three months ended March 31,
     1997 and $28.6 million for 1996 of allocated interest expense and
     the following additional adjustments:
<PAGE>
                                                                Year Ended
                                       March 31, 1997        December 31, 1996
                                       --------------        -----------------
                                                    ($ in millions)


    Interest on Notes (10.375% on $225  
      million)  . . . . . . . . . . . . .    $ 5.8                $23.3
    Interest on borrowings under the
      Senior Credit Facilities (8.40% on
      $175 million) . . . . . . . . . . .      3.7                 14.7
    Commitment fee of 0.50% on unused
      Revolving Credit Facility . . . . .       .1                   .5
    Amortization of deferred financing
      costs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .       .6                  2.1
                                             -----                -----
                                             $10.2                $40.6
                                             =====                =====

<F4>  The estimated excess of purchase price over net assets acquired of
      $297.9 million is being amortized over 40 years resulting in a
      pro forma charge of $7.7 million for 1996 and $1.9 million for the
      three months ended March 31, 1997. Further, the pro forma balance
      sheet includes the elimination of $280.1 million of intangibles,
      primarily cost in excess of net assets acquired, included in the
      Lockheed Martin Predecessor historical balance sheet, and the pro
      forma statement of operations includes the elimination of $10.1
      million and $2.7 million for 1996 and the three months ended March
      31, 1997, respectively, of related amortization expense. The
      preliminary purchase price allocation includes an estimated $4.4
      million adjustment relating to a reduction of contracts in process
      resulting from valuing acquired contracts in process at contract
      price, less the estimated cost to complete and an allowance for
      normal profit margin on the Company's effort to complete such
      contracts. In addition, contracts in process include an estimated
      increase of $3.0 million related to valuing certain commercial
      finished goods inventory at their fair values. The non-recurring
      charges to income in 1996 resulting from the above-mentioned
      adjustments are not material to the pro forma statement of
      operations. The pro forma balance sheet includes an adjustment of
      $5.0 million to reflect the estimated excess of fair value of land
      over the historical book value. The fair value of other fixed
      assets is being evaluated and is not expected to differ materially
      from their carrying amounts. The pro forma balance sheet includes
      an adjustment of $3.0 million to other assets to reflect the
      estimated value of acquired identifiable intangibles and the pro
      forma statement of operations includes a charge of $.2 million for 
      1996 for related amortization over an estimated 15-year period.

<F5>  A combined statutory (federal and state) tax rate of 41% was
      assumed on the pro forma adjustments and the pro forma balance
      sheet includes an estimated $35 million of deferred tax assets,
      fully offset by a valuation allowance, related principally to
      differences between book and tax bases of assumed liabilities.
<PAGE>
<F6>  In connection with the Acquisition, Lockheed Martin also
      transferred the assets and liabilities of a microwave semiconductor
      product line, a building to be used by one of the acquired
      divisions, and certain leasehold improvements. No adjustment has
      been made to the pro forma statement of operations for the effect
      of these transfers because they are not material. In addition, L-3
      has agreed to assume the assets and liabilities of certain defined
      benefit pension plans and a liability for retiree medical and life
      insurance for certain employees. The pro forma balance sheet
      includes an adjustment to other liabilities to reflect the
      estimated excess of the projected benefit obligation over estimated
      pension plan assets of $9.0 million relating to qualified defined
      benefit plans, $2.5 million relating to supplemental executive
      retirement plans and $17.0 million for estimated post-retirement
      benefit obligations. The pro forma statement of operations for the
      three months ended March 31, 1997 and the year ended December
      31,1996 includes a net reduction to costs and expenses of $.6
      million and $2.5 million, respectively, to record estimated pension
      cost on a separate company basis net of the reversal of the
      allocated pension cost included in the historical financial
      statements. No such adjustment has been made to the pro forma
      statement of operations for retiree medical and life insurance
      benefits because the estimated expense of those benefits on a
      separate company basis approximates the cost included in the
      historical financial statements.
<PAGE>
                          SELECTED FINANCIAL INFORMATION

          The following selected combined financial data as of March 31, 1997
    and 1996 and for the three months ended March 31, 1997 and as of December
    31, 1996 and 1995 and for the years ended December 31, 1996, 1995 and 1994
    have been derived from, and should be read in conjunction with, the audited
    Combined Financial Statements of the Businesses and footnotes thereto
    included elsewhere herein. The combined selected financial data for the
    three month periods ended March 31, 1996 have been derived from, and should
    be read in conjunction with, the unaudited Combined Financial Statements
    of the Businesses and footnotes thereto included elsewhere herein. In
    the opinion of the management, the unaudited combined financial
    statements include all adjustments (consisting of normal recurring
    accruals) considered necessary for the fair presentation of the
    information contained therein. Results for the interim periods are not
    necessarily indicative of the results to be expected for the entire year.

          The unaudited selected combined financial data as of December 31,
    1994 and 1993, March 31, 1993 and December 31, 1992 for balance sheet
    data and the nine months ended December 31, 1993, the three months ended
    March 31, 1993 and the year ended December 31, 1992 for statement of
    operations data have been derived from the unaudited financial statements
    of Communication Systems -- Camden. In the opinion of the Businesses'
    management, such unaudited financial statements reflect all adjustments
    (consisting of normal recurring adjustments) necessary to present fairly
    the financial position and results of operations of Communication Systems
    -- Camden, also referred to as Lockheed Martin Communication Systems
    Division in the Lockheed Martin Predecessor Financial Statements, as of
    the dates and periods indicated. These selected financial data should be
    read in conjunction with "Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial
    Condition and Results of Operations" and the Combined Financial
    Statements of the Lockheed Martin Predecessor Businesses and the Loral
    Acquired Businesses included elsewhere herein.
<PAGE>
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>

                                                                                  Years Ended December 31,
                                                               --------------------------------------------------------------
                                              For the Three                                              1993
                                                 Months                                       --------------------------
                                            Ended March 31,                                    Nine Months  Three Months
                                          -------------------                                     Ended         Ended
                                            1997     1996<F2>   1996<F1>  1995<F2>   1994<F2>  Dec. 31<F2>  March 31<F3>  1992<F3>
                                         ---------   -------    --------  --------   --------  -----------  -----------   ---------
                                                                               ($ in millions)
<S>                                      <C>         <C>        <C>       <C>        <C>       <C>          <C>           <C>

    Statement of Operations Data:
    Sales . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .    $158.9      $41.2     $543.1    $166.8     $218.9      $200.0     |  $67.8       $368.5
    Operating income  . . . . . . . . .       7.9        1.7       43.7       4.7        8.4        12.4     |    5.1         49.3
    Allocated interest expense  . . . .       8.4        2.0       24.2       4.5        5.5         4.1     |     --           --
    Allocated (benefit) provision for                                                                        |
     income taxes   . . . . . . . . . .       (.2)        .2        7.8       1.2        2.3         3.8     |    2.0         19.8
    Net earnings (loss) . . . . . . . .       (.3)       (.5)      11.7      (1.0)       0.6         4.5     |    3.1         29.5
                                                                                                             |
                                                                                                             |
    Other Data:                                                                                              |
    EBITDA<F4>  . . . . . . . . . . . .    $ 15.1       $4.8     $ 68.7    $ 16.2     $19.9       $ 23.4     |  $ 7.0       $ 58.5
    Depreciation expense  . . . . . . .       4.5        1.2       14.9       5.5       5.4          6.1     |    1.8          8.9
    Amortization expense  . . . . . . .       2.7        1.9       10.1       6.1       6.1          4.9     |    0.1          0.3
    Capital expenditures  . . . . . . .       4.3         .4       13.5       5.5       3.7          2.6     |    0.8          3.9
    Ratio of earnings to fixed charges.       <F5>       <F5>      1.72x     1.03x     1.40x         N/A     |    N/A          N/A
    Cash from (used in) operating                                                                            |
      activities  . . . . . . . . . . . .   (16.3)      10.2       40.0       9.4       21.8         N/A     |    N/A          N/A
    Cash from (used in) investing                                                                            |
      activities  . . . . . . . . . . . .    (4.3)       (.4)    (298.2)     (5.5)      (3.7)        N/A     |    N/A          N/A
    Cash from (used in) financing                                                                            |
      activities  . . . . . . . . . . . .    20.6       (9.8)     267.3      (3.8)     (18.1)        N/A     |    N/A          N/A
                                                                                                             |
    Balance Sheet Data:                                                                                      |
    Working capital . . . . . . . . . .   $ 121.4        N/A    $  98.8      21.1     $ 19.3      $ 24.7     |  $ 22.8      $ 35.8
    Total assets  . . . . . . . . . . .     608.5        N/A      593.3     228.5      233.3       214.7     |    93.5       105.1
    Invested equity . . . . . . . . . .     493.9        N/A      473.6     194.7      199.5       202.0     |    59.9        72.8

</TABLE>
____________________
[FN]
<F1>   Reflects ownership of Loral's Communication Systems -- Salt Lake
       and Specialized Communication Products businesses commencing
       April 1, 1996.
<F2>   Reflects ownership of Communication Systems -- Camden by Lockheed
       Martin commencing April 1, 1993.
<F3>   Reflects ownership of Communication Systems -- Camden by GE
       Aerospace for the periods indicated. The amounts shown herein
       include only those amounts as reflected in the financial records of
       Communication Systems -- Camden.
<PAGE>
<F4>   EBITDA is defined as income before deducting interest expense,
       income taxes, depreciation and amortization. EBITDA is not a
       substitute for operating income, net earnings and cash flow from
       operating activities as determined in accordance with generally
       accepted accounting principles as a measure of profitability or
       liquidity. EBITDA is presented as additional information because
       management believes it to be a useful indicator of the Company's
       ability to meet debt service and capital expenditure requirements
       and because certain debt covenants of L-3 utilize EBITDA to measure
       compliance with such covenants.
<F5>   For the three months ended March 31, 1997 and 1996, earnings were
        insufficient to cover fixed charges by $.5 million and $.4 million,
       respectively.
<PAGE>
                     MANAGEMENT'S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF
                  FINANCIAL CONDITION AND RESULTS OF OPERATIONS

    General

          Approximately 78% of the Company's sales in 1996 was to the
    Government, primarily to agencies of the DoD, or through subcontracts with
    other Government contractors. Beginning in the mid-1980s, the defense
    industry in general was negatively impacted by the reduction of threats
    from the former Soviet Union and eastern European countries and, more
    recently, by competing demands upon the federal budget. The decline in the
    U.S. defense budget since the mid-1980s has resulted in program delays,
    cancellations and scope reduction for defense contracts in general.
    Continuation of these events may or may not have an effect on the
    Businesses' programs; however, in the event that Government expenditures
    for products of the type manufactured by the Businesses are reduced, and
    not offset by greater commercial sales or other new programs or products,
    or acquisitions, there may be a reduction in the volume of contracts or
    subcontracts awarded to the Businesses.

          In response to the decline in the defense budget, the DoD has
    focused its resources on enhancing its military readiness, joint
    operations and multiple mission capabilities and on incorporating advance
    electronics to improve performance, reduce operating costs and extend life
    expectancy of its existing and future platforms. The emphasis on system
    interoperability, force multipliers and providing battlefield commanders
    with real-time data is increasing the electronics content of nearly all of
    the major military procurement and research programs. As a result, the
    DoD's budget for communications and defense electronics is expected to
    grow. According to Federal Sources, an independent private consulting
    group, the U.S. defense budget for C3I is projected to increase at a
    compound annual growth rate of 5.8% through 2002. L-3's ability to benefit
    from this growth is enhanced by its substantial position in the markets
    for secure communication systems, antenna systems, display systems,
    microwave components and other related areas.

          In April, 1996, Lockheed Martin acquired substantially all the
    assets and liabilities of the defense businesses of Loral, including
    the Wideband Systems Division and the Products Group. The acquisition of
    the Loral Acquired Businesses has been accounted for as a purchase by
    Communication Systems -- Camden. The acquisition has been reflected in the
    financial statements based on the purchase price allocated to the Loral
    Acquired Businesses by Lockheed Martin. As such, the combined financial
    statements reflect the results of operations of Communication Systems --
    Camden and the Loral Acquired Businesses from the effective date of
    acquisition including the effects of an allocated portion of costs in
    excess of net assets acquired resulting from the acquisition. See Note 1
    to the Combined Financial Statements.

          The results of operations include certain allocated costs and
    expenses representing an allocation of Lockheed Martin corporate office
    expenses based primarily on the allocation methodology prescribed by
<PAGE>
    government regulations pertaining to government contractors. Interest
    expense has been allocated based on Lockheed Martin's actual weighted
    average consolidated interest rate applied to the portion of the beginning
    of the year invested equity deemed to be financed by consolidated debt
    based on Lockheed Martin's debt to equity ratio on such date. The
    provision for income taxes has been allocated to the Businesses as if they
    were separate taxpayers, calculated by applying statutory rates to
    reported pre-tax income after considering items that do not enter into the
    determination of taxable income and tax credits related to the Businesses.
    Also pension and post employment benefit costs have been allocated based
    on employee headcount. Accordingly, the results operations and financial
    position hereinafter discussed may not be the same as would have occurred
    had the Businesses been an independent entity.

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>

                                                                 Three Months Ended
                                                                      March 31,                    Years Ended December 31,
                                                             --------------------------   -----------------------------------------
                                                                 1997           1996          1996          1995           1994
                                                             -----------   ------------   -----------   -----------   -------------
                                                                                         ($ in millions)
<S>                                                          <C>           <C>            <C>           <C>           <C>

    Statement of Operations Data:
    Sales . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .     $158.9       $ 41.2         $543.1         $166.8        $218.9
    Cost of sales . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .      151.0         39.5          499.4          162.1         210.5
                                                                 -----        -----          -----          -----         -----
     Operating income   . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .        7.9          1.7           43.7            4.7           8.4
    Allocated interest expense  . . . . . . . . . . . . . .        8.4          2.0           24.2            4.5           5.5
                                                                 -----        -----          -----          -----         -----
     Income (loss) before income taxes  . . . . . . . . . .        (.5)         (.3)          19.5            0.2           2.9
    Income taxes (benefit)  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .        (.2)          .2            7.8            1.2           2.3
                                                                 -----        -----          -----          -----         -----
     Net earnings (loss)  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .     $  (.3)      $  (.5)        $ 11.7         $ (1.0)       $  0.6
                                                                ======       ======         ======         ======        ======

</TABLE>


    Results of Operations

          Three Months Ended March 31, 1997 Compared With Three Months Ended
    March 31, 1996

          Sales for the three months ended March 31, 1997 (the "1997 period")
    increased to $158.9 million from $41.2 million for the three months ended
    March 31, 1996 (the "1996 period"). Operating income in the 1997 period
    increased to $7.9 million compared with $1.7 million in the 1996 period.
    Net loss decreased to $.3 million from $.5 million. The Loral Acquired
    Business contributed $3.3 million in net earnings for the 1997 period,
    offset by net loss of $3.6 million in Communications Systems -- Camden.
<PAGE>
          The sales increases was attributable to the Loral Acquired
    Businesses which contributed $119.8 million of the increase. Sales of
    Communications Systems -- Camden decreased by $2.1 million compared to the
    1996 period primarily due to lower volume on the SIGINT production and
    Secure Terminal Equipment (STE) development programs.

          The increase in operating income also was largely attributable to
    the Loral Acquired Business, which contributed $10.7 million of the
    increase. Communication Systems - Camden's 1996 operating income for the 
    1997 period decreased by $4.4 million to a $2.8 million operating loss 
    for the 1997 period, primarily due to increased costs on the Space Station, 
    Baseband and AMODSM programs.

          Operating income as a percentage of sales increased to 5.0% in the
    1997 period compared to 4.1% in the 1996 period. The increase is
    attributable to higher margins and operating improvements in the Loral
    Acquired Businesses with operating income as a percentage of sales of
    8.9%, offset by negative margins in Communications Systems -- Camden.

          Allocated interest expense increased to $8.4 million from $2.0
    million due primarily to the acquisition of the Loral Acquired Businesses,
    which was assumed to be fully financed by debt, coupled with a higher
    debt-to-equity ratio used in the allocation for Communications Systems --
    Camden.

          Year Ended December 31, 1996 Compared with Year Ended December 31,
    1995

          During 1996, sales increased to $543.1 million from $166.8 million
    in the prior year. Operating income increased to $43.7 million compared
    with $4.7 million in the prior year. Net earnings increased to $11.7
    million compared to a loss of $1.0 million in the prior year. The Loral
    Acquired Businesses contributed $13.6 million to 1996 net earnings.

          The sales increase was attributed to the sales of the Loral
    Acquired Businesses which contributed $381.1 million of the increase.
    Sales of Communication Systems -- Camden decreased by $4.8 million
    compared to 1995 primarily due to lower volume on Aegis power supplies and
    SIGINT system production, partially offset by Local Management Device/Key
    Processor ("LMD/KP") production startup.

          The increase in operating income also was largely attributable to
    the Loral Acquired Businesses, which contributed $36.9 million of the
    increase. Communication Systems -- Camden operating income increased $2.2
    million primarily due to improved operating performance on the Shipboard
    Telephone Communications ("STC-2") program partially offset by increased
    costs on the Space Station contract. As a percentage of sales, operating
    income increased to 8.0% from 2.8%. This increase is attributable to the
    improvement in Communication Systems -- Camden noted above, higher margins
    and operating improvements in the Loral Acquired Businesses.

          Allocated interest expense increased to $24.2 million from $4.5
    million in the prior year due primarily to the acquisition of the Loral
    Acquired Businesses, which was assumed to be fully financed by debt,
    coupled with a higher debt-to-equity ratio used in the allocation for
    Communication Systems -- Camden.
<PAGE>
          The effective income tax rate declined to 40% as compared to 681%
    in the prior year. The 1995 effective rate was significantly impacted by
    amortization of costs in excess of net assets acquired, which is not
    deductible for income tax purposes. As a percentage of income subject to
    tax, such amortization declined significantly in 1996.

          Year Ended December 31, 1995 Compared with Year Ended December 31,
    1994

          Results for 1995 and 1994 reflect only the results of Communication
    Systems -- Camden. During 1995, sales decreased to $166.8 million from
    $218.9 million in the prior year. Operating income decreased to $4.7
    million from $8.4 million and the net loss for 1995 was $1.0 million
    compared to net earnings of $0.6 million in 1994.

          The decrease in sales was primarily due to the completion of the
    IREMBASS and termination of the SCAMP program and lower volume on the
    STC-2 program.

          The decline in operating income was partially due to the sales
    decrease described above. In addition, as a percentage of sales, operating
    income decreased to 2.8% in 1995 from 3.8% in 1994. The decrease in 1995
    margins is primarily due to a cost overrun on the STE program.

          Allocated interest expense decreased to $4.5 million in 1995 from
    $5.5 million in 1994 due to the lower invested equity balance at January
    1, 1995 compared to January 1, 1994, offset by a slightly higher weighted
    average consolidated interest rate.

          The effective income tax rates in 1995 and 1994 were significantly
    impacted by amortization of costs in excess of net assets acquired, which
    is not deductible for income tax purposes. The effective income tax rate
    in 1995 increased to 681% compared to 78% in 1994. The increase is
    primarily the result of the above described amortization increasing as a
    percent of pre-tax income in 1995 compared to the respective percent
    relationship in 1994.

    Liquidity and Capital Resources

          The Businesses participate in the Lockheed Martin cash management
    system, under which all cash is received and all payments are made by
    Lockheed Martin. All transactions between the Businesses and Lockheed
    Martin have been accounted as settled in cash at the time such
    transactions were recorded by the Businesses. In 1996, cash flows reflect
    the purchase of the Loral Acquired Businesses.

          Three Months Ended March 31, 1997 Compared with Three Months Ended
          March 31, 1996

          Net Cash Provided by Operating Activities:  Cash used in operating
    activities for the three months ended March 31, 1997 (the "1997 period")
    was $16.3 million compared to cash provided by operating activities of
    $10.2 million for the three months ended March 31, 1996 (the "1996 
    period"). The decrease for the 1997 period is due primarily to the 
    reduction in contracts in process and increase in current liabilities, 
    offset by
<PAGE>
    increased profit and non-cash items provided by the Loral Acquired
    Businesses. Without the Loral Acquired Businesses, cash used in operating
    activities for Communication Systems -- Camden amounted to $6.1 million.

          Contracts in process, before reduction for unliquidated progress
    payments, increased $8.9 million to $242.8 million at March 31, 1997
    compared to December 31, 1996. See Notes 2 and 4 to the Combined
    Financial Statements. As is customary in the defense industry, unbilled
    contract receivables and inventoried costs are partially financed by
    progress payments. The unliquidated balance of such progress amounted to
    $27.2 million at March 31, 1997, compared with $35.8 million at December
    31, 1996. Net contracts in process amounted to $215.6 million at March
    31, 1997 from $198.1 million at December 31, 1996.

          The Company's current ratio improved slightly to 2.2:1 at March 31,
    1997 from 2.0:1 at December 31,1996.

          Net Cash Used in Investing Activities: Cash used in investing
    activities, primarily for capital expenditures, increased to $4.3 million
    for the 1997 period compared to $.4 million in the 1996 period.

          Year Ended December 31, 1996 Compared to Year Ended December 31, 1995 
    and to Year Ended December 31, 1994

          Net Cash Provided by Operating Activities: Cash provided by
    operating activities was $31.0 million in 1996, $9.4 million in 1995 and
    $21.8 million in 1994. The increase of $21.6 million or 230% in 1996 is
    due primarily to the impact of the Loral Acquired Businesses. Earnings
    after adjustment for non-cash items provided $37.0 million, offset by
    changes in other operating assets and liabilities. The decrease in 1995
    of $12.4 million is attributable to an increase in contracts in process
    compared to 1994, a net loss in 1995 and gain on sales of assets in 1994.
    Without the Loral Acquired Businesses, cash provided by operating
    activities for Communication Systems -- Camden increased to $13.7 million
    in 1996, or 46% over the prior year.

          Contracts in process, before reduction for unliquidated progress
    payments, increased by $189.2 million to $233.9 million at December 31,
    1996, primarily due to the addition of the Loral Acquired Businesses.
    See Notes 2 and 4 to the Combined Financial Statements. As is customary
    in the defense industry, unbilled contract receivables and inventoried
    costs are partially financed by progress payments. The unliquidated
    balance of such progress payments increased by $33.5 million to $35.8
    million at December 31, 1996, compared with $2.3 million at December
    31, 1995. As a result, net contracts in process increased to $198.1
    million in 1996 from $42.5 million in the prior year.

          The Businesses' current ratio improved slightly to 2.0:1 at
    December 31, 1996, from 1.9:1 at December 31, 1995, as a result of
    the acquisition of the Loral Acquired Businesses.

          Net Cash Used in Investing Activities: Cash used in investing
    activities increased to $298.2 million in 1996 from $5.5 million in
    1995 and $3.7 million in 1994. The purchase price allocated by
    Lockheed Martin to the Loral Acquired Businesses was $287.8 million.
    Capital expenditures during the year amounted to $13.5 million,
<PAGE>
    offset by cash provided by sales of fixed assets amounting to $3.1
    million. The Company expects that capital expenditures will be
    approximately $25.0 million in 1997.

    Financing

          Concurrently with the Acquisition, the Company entered into $275.0
    million of Senior Secured Credit Facilities consisting of $175.0 million
    of term loans and a $100.0 million Revolving Credit Facility. See
    "Description of Senior Credit Facilities" for a description of the
    amortization schedule of the term loans and other terms and provisions of
    the Senior Credit Facilities.

          As reflected in "Capitalization," the Company commenced business
    operations with approximately $400.0 million of total debt and $125.0
    million of paid-in capital. The Businesses also have available up to
    $100.0 million for working capital, letters of credit and capital
    expenditure requirements under the Revolving Credit Facility. Based upon
    the current level of operations and anticipated improvements, management
    believes that the Company's cash flow from operations, together with
    available borrowings under the Revolving Credit Facility, will be adequate
    to meet its anticipated requirements for working capital, capital
    expenditures, research and development expenditures, program and other
    discretionary investments, interest payments and scheduled principal
    payments. There can be no assurance, however, that the Company's business
    will continue to generate cash flow at or above current levels or that
    currently anticipated improvements will be achieved. If the Company is
    unable to generate sufficient cash flow from operations in the future to
    service its debt, it may be required to sell assets, reduce capital
    expenditures, refinance all or a portion of its existing debt (including
    the Exchange Notes) or obtain additional financing. The Company's ability
    to make scheduled principal payments of, to pay interest on or to
    refinance its indebtedness (including the Exchange Notes) depends on its
    future performance and financial results, which, to a certain extent, are
    subject to general economic, financial, competitive, legislative,
    regulatory and other factors beyond its control. There can be no assurance
    that sufficient funds will be available to enable the Company to service
    its indebtedness, including the Exchange Notes, or make necessary capital
    expenditures and program and other discretionary investments.

    Backlog

          The Company's funded backlog at December 31, 1996, was $542.5
    million, compared with $96.3 million at December 31, 1995 and $120.4
    million at December 31, 1994. New orders in 1996 totaled $619.5 million,
    compared with $142.6 million in 1995 and $194.6 million in 1994. It is
    expected that approximately 77% of the December 31, 1996 backlog will be
    shipped in 1997. However, there can be no assurance that the Company's
    backlog will become revenues in any particular period, if at all. See
    "Risk Factors--Backlog". Approximately 81% of the total backlog was
    directly or indirectly for defense contracts for end use by the
    Government.
<PAGE>
    Research and Development

          Company-sponsored research and development, including bid and
    proposal costs, increased to $36.5 million in 1996 from $9.8 million in
    1995. In addition, customer-funded research and development was $153.5
    million in 1996, compared with $74.9 million for 1995. The increase in
    research and development in 1996 was due primarily to the Loral Acquired
    Businesses.

    Contingencies

          Management does not believe there are any contingencies that, after
    taking into account its existing reserves, would have a material adverse
    effect on the Company's operations or financial condition. See Note 8 to
    the Combined Financial Statements and "Risk Factors--Pension Plan
    Liabilities".

    New Accounting Pronouncements

          Effective January 1, 1996, the Businesses adopted Statement of
    Financial Accounting Standards No. 121, "Accounting for the Impairment of
    Long-Lived Assets and Long-Lived Assets to Be Disposed Of" ("SFAS 121").
    SFAS 121 establishes the accounting standards for the impairment of
    long-lived assets, certain intangible assets and cost in excess of net
    assets acquired to be held and used for long-lived assets and certain
    intangible assets to be disposed of. The impact of adopting SFAS 121 was
    not material.

          Effective January 1, 1994, the Businesses adopted Statement of
    Financial Accounting Standards No. 112, "Employers' Accounting for
    Postretirement Benefits" ("SFAS 112"). SFAS 112 requires that the costs of
    benefits provided to employees after employment but before retirement be
    recognized on an accrual basis. The adoption of SFAS 112 did not have a
    material impact on the combined results of operations of the Businesses.

    Inflation

          The effect of inflation on the Company's sales and earnings is
    minimal. Although a majority of the Company's sales are made under
    long-term contracts, the selling prices of such contracts, established for
    deliveries in the future, generally reflect estimated costs to be incurred
    in these future periods. In addition, some contracts provide for price
    adjustments through escalation clauses.

    Supplemental Discussion of Results of Operations

          The Company was formed to acquire substantially all of the assets
    of (i) nine business units previously purchased by Lockheed Martin as part
    of its acquisition of Loral in April 1996, which includes one business
    unit, Communication Systems -- Salt Lake, purchased by Loral as part of
    its acquisition of the Defense Systems business of Unisys Corporation in
    May 1995, and (ii) one business unit, Communication Systems -- Camden,
    purchased by Lockheed Martin as part of its acquisition of GE Aerospace in
    April 1993. The historical ownership of the Businesses is summarized in
    the following table.
<PAGE>
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>

                              March 31,                           Historical Ownership as of December 31,
                           --------------   --------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
       Business Unit            1997             1996              1995              1994            1993                1992
    -------------------    --------------   ---------------   ---------------   -------------   ---------------     --------------
<S>                        <C>              <C>               <C>               <C>             <C>                 <C>

    Communication          
     Systems -- Camden.   Lockheed Martin  Lockheed Martin  Lockheed Martin   Lockheed Martin  Lockheed Martin<F3> General Electric
    Communication          
     Systems -- 
     Salt Lake. . . . .   Lockheed Martin  Lockheed Martin<F1>  Loral<F2>     Unisys           Unisys               Unisys
    Specialized
     Communication                    
     Products   . . . .  Lockheed Martin  Lockheed Martin<F1>   Loral         Loral            Loral                Loral

____________________
<FN>
<F1>   From April 1, 1996.
<F2>   From May 1, 1995.
<F3>   From April 1, 1993.

</TABLE>


          The historical financial statements, included elsewhere herein,
    have been prepared pursuant to the rules and regulations of the
    Commission, and do not reflect the results of operations of the Businesses
    acquired by L-3 on a combined basis for all of the periods presented. As a
    result, management believes that the historical financial statements do
    not, by themselves, provide investors with sufficient information to
    adequately assess the trends of the Businesses acquired by L-3 over the
    periods indicated.

          L-3 is providing additional information, therefore, to supplement
    the historical financial information included elsewhere herein to assist
    prospective investors in evaluating the Businesses' historical results of
    operations. The Unaudited Supplemental Adjusted Historical Financial Data
    have been derived from the historical financial information of the
    Businesses and adjusted by aggregating the reported historical results of
    operations for the respective periods. In addition, the Unaudited
    Supplemental Adjusted Historical Financial Data have been adjusted to
    reflect the elimination of certain product lines of the Company's Aviation
    Recorders business area that were exited during 1996 and 1995. The effects
    of this adjustment were reductions in adjusted sales of $2.7 million for
    the three months ended March 31, 1996 and reductions in adjusted sales of
    $10.6 million, $21.5 million, $23.0 million, $30.0 million and $37.0
    million for the years ended December 31, 1996, 1995, 1994, 1993 and 1992,
    respectively, and an increase in adjusted EBITDA of $.4 million for the
    three months ended March 31, 1996 and increases (decreases) in adjusted
    EBITDA of $1.4 million, ($1.0) million, ($4.8) million, ($2.0) million and
    ($6.7) million for the years ended December 31, 1996, 1995, 1994, 1993 and
    1992, respectively. The Unaudited Supplemental Adjusted Historical
<PAGE>
    Financial Data do not purport to present the combined results of
    operations that the Businesses would have achieved had they been under
    common ownership and control during such periods, nor are they indicative
    of the results of operations that may be achieved in the future. The
    acquisition by Lockheed Martin of the Loral Acquired Businesses on April
    1, 1996, the acquisition by Loral of Communication Systems -- Salt Lake on
    May 1, 1995 and the acquisition by Lockheed Martin of Communication
    Systems -- Camden on April 1, 1993 resulted in new bases of accounting
    whereunder the assets and liabilities of the acquired businesses were
    adjusted to their fair value on such dates pursuant to Accounting
    Principles Board Opinion No. 16. To the extent such adjustments resulted
    in changes to depreciation and amortization expense, such changes do not
    enter into the determination of EBITDA. All of the following information
    is qualified in its entirety by, and should be read in conjunction with,
    "Selected Financial Information", "Management's Discussion and Analysis of
    Adjusted Historical Financial Data", the Combined Financial Statements of
    the Lockheed Martin Predecessor Businesses and the Combined Financial
    Statements of the Loral Acquired Businesses included elsewhere herein.
<PAGE>
                                                      SUPPLEMENTAL DATA

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>

                                           Three Months Ended
                                               March 31,                               Years Ended December 31,
                                       ------------------------   ----------------------------------------------------------------
                                                                                         Adjusted<F1>
                                                     -----------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                           1997          1996         1996         1995         1994          1993         1992
                                       ----------    ----------   ----------   ----------    ----------   ----------   -----------
                                                                              ($ in millions)
<S>                                    <C>           <C>          <C>          <C>           <C>          <C>          <C>

    Statement of Operations Data:
    Sales:
     Secure Communication Systems   .    $84.9          90.3       $371.5        $379.2       $418.6        $469.7        $569.9
     Specialized Communication
       Products   . . . . . . . . . .     74.0          77.3        293.2         290.4        282.0         321.1         355.6
                                         -----         -----        -----         -----        -----         -----         -----
                                         158.9         167.6       $664.7        $669.6       $700.6        $790.8        $925.5
       Total sales  . . . . . . . . .    =====         =====       ======        ======       ======        ======        ======

    Other Data:
    EBITDA<F2>:
     Secure Communication Systems. . .   $ 4.6        $ 7.8        $ 40.3        $ 38.0       $ 39.5        $ 51.7        $ 80.5
     Specialized Communication
       Products   . . . . . . . . . .     10.5         10.2          42.6          28.0         22.8          34.9          47.7
                                          ----         ----         -----         -----        -----         -----         ------
       Total EBITDA                       15.1         18.0         $ 82.9        $ 66.0       $ 62.3        $86.6         $128.2
                                          ====        =====         ======        ======       ======        =====         ====== 

    EBITDA as a percentage of
     sales:
     Secure Communication Systems . .      5.4%         8.6%          10.8%         10.0%         9.4%        11.0%          14.1%
     Specialized Communication
       Products   . . . . . . . . . .     14.2%        13.2%          14.5           9.6          8.1         10.9           13.4
                                          ----         ----          -----         -----        -----         -----         ----- 
                                                                         
       Total EBITDA as a percentage
          of sales  . . . . . . . . .     9.5%         10.7%          12.5%          9.9%         8.9%         11.0%         13.9%
                                         =====         =====         =====         =====         =====        =====         =====

    Depreciation expense  . . . . . .     4.5           4.1         $ 17.8        $ 18.7       $ 18.4        $ 23.5        $ 25.2
    Amortization expense  . . . . . .     2.7           3.4           12.0          12.3          9.4           8.1           3.3
    Capital expenditures  . . . . . .     4.3           4.5           17.2          17.9         13.7          14.7          24.2

</TABLE>

____________________
[FN]
<F1>   Represents the historical aggregated financial data of
       Communication Systems -- Camden, Communication Systems -- Salt Lake
       and each of the other Loral Acquired Businesses for each of the
       periods presented. See "Management's Discussion and Analysis of
       Adjusted Historical Financial Data". The Unaudited Supplemental
       Adjusted Historical Financial Data have been adjusted to reflect
       the elimination of certain product lines of the Company's Aviation
<PAGE>
       Recorders business area that were exited during 1996 and 1995. The
       effects of this adjustment were reductions in adjusted sales of
       $10.6 million, $21.5 million, $23.0 million, $30.0 million and
       $37.0 million for the years ended December 31, 1996, 1995, 1994,
       1993 and 1992, respectively, and increases (decreases) in adjusted
       EBITDA of $1.4 million, ($1.0) million, ($4.8) million, ($2.0)
       million and ($6.7) million for the years ended December 31, 1996,
       1995, 1994, 1993 and 1992, respectively.

<F2>   EBITDA is defined as income before deducting interest expense,
       income taxes, depreciation and amortization. EBITDA is not a
       substitute for operating income, net earnings and cash flow from
       operating activities as determined in accordance with generally
       accepted accounting principles as a measure of profitability or
       liquidity. EBITDA is presented as additional information because
       management believes it to be a useful indicator of the Company's
       ability to meet debt service and capital expenditure requirements
       and because certain debt covenants of L-3 utilize EBITDA to measure
       compliance with such covenants.


   Three Months Ended March 31, 1997 Compared with Three Months Ended March
   31, 1996

          Adjusted sales for the three months ended March 31, 1997 (the "1997
    period") were $158.9 million compared to $167.6 million in the three
    months ended March 31, 1996 (the "1996 period"). The 5.2% decrease in
    adjusted sales represents (i) a 6.0% sales decline in Secure
    Communications Systems to $84.9 million in the 1997 period from $90.3
    million in the 1996 period primarily due to lower sales volume on the
    Signal Intelligence ("SIGINT") systems and (ii) a 4.3% sales decline in
    Specialized Communication Products to $74.0 million in the 1997 period
    from $77.3 million in the 1996 period due to (A) a $6.4 million or 18.4%
    decrease in adjusted sales of Telemetry and Instrumation due to lower
    volume on international programs related to transportable microwave
    radio and expendable counter measures, partially offset by (B) a $1.9
    million or 11.1% increase in adjusted sales of Microwave Components
    attributable to the increased volume of satellite channel amplifiers
    and (C) a $1.2 million or 4.3% increase in adjusted sales of Avionics
    resulting from increased deliveries of TRAC-A Antennas and Advanced
    Data Recorders which were partially offset by lower shipments of E-2C
    and F-14 displays.

          Adjusted Earnings before Interest, Taxes, Depreciation and
    Amortization ("EBITDA") for the 1997 period was $15.1 million, compared to
    $18.0 million in the 1996 period.

          Adjusted EBITDA as a percentage of sales ("EBITDA margin") was 9.5%
    in the 1997 period compared to 10.7% in the 1996 period. EBITDA margin in
    Secure Communication Systems decreased to 5.5% in the 1997 period from
    8.6% in the 1996 period primarily due to $4.0 million of program related
    charges for the AMODSM, Baseband and Space Station programs. EBITDA margin
    in Specialized Communication Products increased to 14.1% in the 1997
    period from 13.2% in the 1996 period due to (i) an increase in Avionics to
    12.4% in the 1997 period compared to 7.5% in the 1996 period due to the
    transition of the Company's F-14 and V-22 display programs from
<PAGE>
    development to production, (ii) an increase in Microwave to 24.2% in the
    1997 period compared to 18.7% in the 1996 period due to increased volume
    of higher margin satellite channel amplifiers and (iii) a decrease in
    Telemetry & Instrumentation to 8.8% in the 1997 period compared to 14.9%
    in the 1996 period due to lower volume of higher margin international
    transportable microwave radios.

          Adjusted depreciation expense increased by 9.8% to $4.5 million in
    the 1997 period compared to $4.1 million in the 1996 period. Adjusted
    amortization expense decreased by 20.6% to $2.7 million compared to $3.4
    million in the 1996 period. Adjusted capital expenditures decreased 4.4%
    to $4.3 million in the 1997 period compared to $4.5 million in the 1996
    period due primarily to lower overall capital needs for both of the
    Company's business areas.

    Year Ended December 31, 1996 Compared with Year Ended December 31, 1995

    Adjusted sales for the year ended December 31, 1996 were $664.7
    million, compared to $669.6 million in 1995. The decrease in adjusted
    sales is approximately 1% and represents sales decline in the Secure
    Communication Systems business area. Sales of Secure Communication Systems
    were $371.5 million in 1996, as compared to $379.2 million in 1995, a
    decrease of 2.0%. The decrease was primarily due to lower sales volume on
    Signal Intelligence ("SIGINT") systems and Aegis power supplies, partially
    offset by increased sales volume on the Company's U-2 support program.
    Adjusted sales in Specialized Communication Products were $293.2 million
    in 1996, as compared to $290.4 million in 1995, an increase of 1.0%. The
    $2.8 million increase in adjusted sales of Specialized Communication
    Products was composed of an increase in adjusted sales of Microwave
    Components of $13.9 million or 23.7%, and an increase in adjusted sales of
    Avionics of $6.6 million or 7.4%, partially offset by a decrease in
    adjusted sales of Telemetry and Instrumentation of $17.7 million or 12.5%.

          The increase in Microwave Components adjusted sales was
    attributable to higher volume sales of cellular products and satellite
    channel amplifiers primarily due to the growth in the wireless
    communications and satellite industries. Avionics adjusted sales increased
    primarily because of increased volume on advanced antenna sales. The
    decline in Telemetry and Instrumentation adjusted sales was primarily
    attributable to lower sales volume in expendable countermeasures and on
    the ALR-56M radar warning receivers program, both related to the overall
    decline in the defense procurement budget.

          Adjusted EBITDA for the year ended December 31, 1996 was $82.9
    million, compared to $66.0 million in 1995. EBITDA as a percentage of
    sales increased to 12.5% in 1996 from 9.9% in 1995.

          Adjusted EBITDA margin in Secure Communication Systems increased to
    10.8% in 1996 from 10.0% in 1995. The increase in margin is primarily due
    to improved operating performance on the Shipboard Telephone
    Communications ("STC-2") program and a cost overrun in the Secure Terminal
    Equipment ("STE") program in 1995 which was not present in 1996. EBITDA
    margin in Specialized Communication Products increased to 14.5% in 1996
    compared to 9.6% in 1995. This increase in EBITDA margin is composed of an
    increase in Microwave Components to 19.3% in 1996 compared to 14.3% in
<PAGE>
    1995, an increase in Avionics to 11.0% in 1996 compared to 7.9% in 1995
    and an increase in Telemetry and Instrumentation to 14.5% in 1996 compared
    to 8.8% in 1995.

          The increase in the Microwave Components EBITDA margin is due to
    sales mix related to increased volume of higher margin satellite channel
    amplifiers. The increase in the Avionics EBITDA margin is primarily due to
    the transition of the Company's F-14 display program from development to
    production. The increase in the Telemetry and Instrumentation EBITDA
    margin is due to improved operating performance on F-16 advanced antennas,
    ALR-56M radar warning receivers, airborne telemetry systems and favorable
    sales mix related to higher margin international transportable microwave
    radios.

          Adjusted depreciation expense decreased by 4.8% to $17.8 million
    for the year ended December 31, 1996, compared to $18.7 million in 1995.
    The decrease is primarily due to lower adjusted capital expenditures
    during 1996. Adjusted amortization expense decreased by 2.4% to $12.0
    million for the year ended December 31, 1996, compared to $12.3 million in
    1995.

          Adjusted capital expenditures decreased 3.9% to $17.2 million in
    1996 compared to $17.9 million in 1995. The decrease is due primarily to
    lower overall capital needs for both of the Company's business areas.

    Year Ended December 31, 1995 Compared with Year Ended December 31, 1994

          Adjusted sales for the year ended December 31, 1995 were $669.6
    million, compared to $700.6 million for the year ended 1994, a decrease of
    4.4%. Adjusted sales in Secure Communication Systems were $379.2 million
    in 1995, compared to $418.6 million in 1994, a decrease of 9.4%. The
    decrease was primarily due to the completion of the Improved Remotely
    Monitored Battlefield Sensor System ("IREMBASS") and termination of the
    Single Channel Anti-Jam Man Portable ("SCAMP") program, tactical security
    system production programs partially offset by increased volume on a
    reconnaissance surveillance data link program Direct Air-Satellite Relay
    ("DASR"). Adjusted sales in Specialized Communication Products were $290.4
    million in 1995, compared to $282.0 million in 1994, an increase of 3.0%.
    The increase was comprised of increased adjusted sales of Microwave
    Components of $10.0 million, or 20%, partially offset by a decrease in
    Telemetry and Instrumentation adjusted sales of $1.8 million, or 1.3%.
    Avionics adjusted sales were essentially flat compared to 1994.

          The increase in the adjusted sales of Microwave Components was
    primarily due to increased sales volume in cellular products and satellite
    channel amplifiers primarily due to growth in the wireless communications
    and satellite industries. The decline in Telemetry and Instrumentation
    adjusted sales is related to lower adjusted sales volume in expendable
    countermeasures related to the overall decline in the defense budget.

          Adjusted EBITDA for the year ended December 31, 1995 increased to
    $66.0 million, as compared to $62.3 million in 1994, or 5.9%. Adjusted
    EBITDA margin increased to 9.9% in 1995 from 8.9% in 1994.
<PAGE>
          Adjusted EBITDA margin in Secure Communication Systems increased to
    10.0% in 1995 from 9.4% in 1994. The increase in margin is primarily due
    to improved operating performance in 1995 on SIGINT system production and
    a 1994 cost overrun on the LAMPS data link program, partially offset by
    the 1995 cost overrun on the STE program.

          Adjusted EBITDA margin in Specialized Communication Products
    increased to 9.6% in 1995 from 8.1% in 1994. For Microwave Components,
    EBITDA margin increased to 14.3% in 1995 compared to 11.8% in 1994. For
    Avionics, EBITDA margin increased to 7.9% in 1995 compared to 5.2% in
    1994. For Telemetry and Instrumentation, EBITDA margin was essentially
    flat.

          The adjusted EBITDA margin increase for Microwave Components was
    due primarily to increased volume on high margin satellite channel
    amplifiers. The margin increase for Avionics was due primarily to the
    transition of the E-2C display program from development to production,
    partially offset by cost overruns on the APR-39 advanced antenna program.

          Adjusted depreciation expense increased by 1.6% to $18.7 million
    for the year ended December 31, 1995, compared to $18.4 million in 1994.
    Adjusted amortization expense increased by 30.9% to $12.3 million for the
    year ended December 31, 1995, compared to $9.4 million in 1994. The
    increase is primarily due to initial amortization of costs in excess of
    net assets acquired relating to the acquisition by Loral of Communication
    Systems -- Salt Lake effective May 1, 1995.

          Adjusted capital expenditures increased by 30.7% to $17.9 million
    in 1995 compared to $13.7 million in the prior year. Communication Systems
    -- Camden, Avionics and Microwave accounted for most of the increase in
    the capital expenditures for 1995.
<PAGE>
                                     BUSINESS

    Company Overview

          L-3 is a leading provider of sophisticated secure communication
    systems and specialized communication products including secure, high data
    rate communication systems, microwave components, avionics, and telemetry
    and instrumentation products. These systems and products are critical
    elements of virtually all major communication, command and control,
    intelligence gathering and space systems. The Company's systems and
    specialized products are used to connect a variety of airborne, space,
    ground and sea-based communication systems and are incorporated into the
    transmission, processing, recording, monitoring and dissemination
    functions of these communication systems. The Company's customers include
    the DoD, selected Government intelligence agencies, major
    aerospace/defense prime contractors, foreign governments and commercial
    customers. In 1996, L-3 had pro forma sales of $675.3 million and pro
    forma operating income of $56.0 million. The Company's funded backlog as
    of December 31, 1996 was approximately $542.5 million.

          All of the Company's business units enjoy proprietary technologies
    and capabilities and are well positioned in their respective markets.
    Management has organized the Company's operations into two business areas:
    Secure Communication Systems and Specialized Communication Products. In
    1996, these areas generated approximately $371.5 million and $303.8
    million of pro forma sales, respectively, and $23.0 million and $33.0
    million of pro forma operating income, respectively.

          Secure Communication Systems. L-3 is the established leader in
    secure, high data rate communications in support of military and other
    national agency reconnaissance and surveillance applications. The
    Company's Secure Communication Systems operations are located in Salt Lake
    City, Utah and Camden, New Jersey. Both operations are predominantly cost
    plus, sole source prime system contractors supporting long-term programs
    for the U.S. Armed Forces and classified customers. The Company's major
    secure communication programs and systems include: strategic and tactical
    signal intelligence systems that detect, collect, identify, analyze and
    disseminate information and related support contracts for military and
    national agency intelligence efforts; secure data links for airborne,
    satellite, ground and sea-based information collection and transmission;
    as well as secure telephone and network equipment. The Company believes
    that it has developed virtually every high bandwidth data link used by the
    military for surveillance and reconnaissance in operation today. In
    addition to these core Government programs, L-3 is expanding its business
    base into related commercial communication equipment markets, including
    applying its wireless communication expertise to develop local wireless
    loop equipment primarily for emerging market countries and rural areas
    where existing telecommunications infrastructure is inadequate or
    non-existent.

          Specialized Communication Products. This business area comprises
    the Microwave Components, Avionics, and Telemetry and Instrumentation
    Products operations of the Company.
<PAGE>
          Microwave Components. L-3 is the preeminent worldwide supplier of
    commercial off-the-shelf, high performance microwave components and
    frequency monitoring equipment. L-3's microwave products are sold under
    the industry-recognized Narda brand name through a standard catalog to
    wireless, industrial and military communication markets. L-3 also provides
    state-of-the-art communication components including channel amplifiers and
    frequency filters for the commercial communications satellite market.

          Avionics. Avionics includes the Company's Aviation Recorders,
    Display Systems and Antenna Systems operations. L-3 is the world's leading
    manufacturer of commercial cockpit voice and flight data recorders. These
    recorders are sold under the Fairchild brand name both on an OEM basis to
    aircraft manufacturers as well as directly to the world's major airlines
    for their existing fleets of aircraft. L-3 also provides military and
    high-end commercial displays for use on a number of DoD programs including
    the F-14, V-22, F-117 and E-2C. Further, L-3 manufactures high performance
    surveillance antennas and related equipment for U.S. Air Force and U.S.
    Navy aircraft including the F-16, AWACS, E-2C and B-2, as well as the
    U.K.'s Nimrod aircraft.

          Telemetry and Instrumentation Products. The Company's Telemetry and
    Instrumentation Products operations develop and manufacture commercial
    off-the-shelf, real-time data collection and transmission products and
    components for missile, aircraft and space-based electronic systems. These
    products are used to gather flight parameter data and other critical
    information and transmit it from air or space to the ground. Telemetry
    products are also used for range safety and training applications to
    simulate battlefield situations. Further, the Company is applying its
    technical capabilities in high data rate transmission to the medical image
    archiving market in partnership with GE Medical Systems.

          The Company's systems and products are summarized in the following
    tables:

<PAGE>
        Secure Communication Systems (1996 Pro Forma Sales: $372 million)

                                                      Selected Platforms/End
            Systems           Selected Applications            Uses
    ----------------------   ----------------------  ----------------------

    Secure High Data Rate
    Communications
    -- Broad-band data links  High performance,          Used on aircraft and
                              secure communication       naval ships,
                              links for                  unmanned aerial
                              interoperable tactical     vehicles with
                              communication and          military and
                              reconnaissance             commercial
                                                         satellites 

    Satellite Communication
    Terminals
    -- Ground-based   
       satellite 
       communication
       terminals            Interoperable,              Provide remote
                            transportable               communication links
                            ground terminals            to distant forces
                               for remote data 
                               links to distant
                               segments via commercial
                               or military satellites

    Satellite Communication 
    and Satellite Control
    -- Satellite communication On-board satellite         International Space
       and tracking systems    external                   Station; Earth
                               communications, video      Observing Satellite;
                               systems, solid state       Landsat-7; National
                               recorders and ground       Oceanic and
                               support equipment          Atmospheric
                                                          Administration
                                                          weather satellites

    -- Satellite       
       command and             Software integration,      Air Force satellite
       control                 test and maintenance       network; Titan IV
       sustainment             support for Air Force      launch system
       and support             satellite control
                               network; engineering
                               support for satellite
                               launch systems

    Military
    Communications
    -- Shipboard       
       communication           Shipboard and              Shipboard voice
       systems                 ship-to-ship               communications
                               communications             systems for Aegis
                                                          cruisers and
                                                          destroyers; fully
<PAGE>
     Specialized Communication Products (1996 Pro Forma Sales: $304 million)

                                                     Selected Platforms/End
          Productions        Selected Applications            Uses
    ----------------------  ----------------------   ----------------------

                                                          automated Integrated
                                                          Radio Room (IRR) for
                                                          ship-to-ship
                                                          communications on
                                                          Trident submarines

    Information Security
    Systems
    -- Secure          
       Telephone Unit          Secure and non-secure      Office and
       (STU III)/Secure        voice, data and video      battlefield secure
       Terminal Equipment      communication              and non-secure
       (STE)                   utilizing ISDN and ATM     communication for
                               commercial network         armed services,
                               technologies               intelligence and
                                                          security agencies

    -- Local
       management              Provides electronic        User authorization
       device/key              key material               and recognition and
       processor               accounting, system         message encryption
       (LMD/KP)                management and audit       for secure
                               support functions for      communication
                               secure data
                               communication

    -- Information     
       processing              Custom designed            Classified military
       systems                 strategic and tactical     and national agency
                               signal intelligence        intelligence efforts
                               systems that detect,
                               collect, identify,
                               analyze and
                               disseminate
                               information and
                               related support
                               contracts                               

    Microwave Components
    -- Passive         
       components,             Radio transmission,        Broad-band and
       mechanical              switching and              narrow-band
       switches and            conditioning; antennae     commercial
       wireless                and base station           applications (PCS,
       assemblies              testing and monitoring     cellular, SMR,
                                                          and paging
                                                          infrastructure)
                                                          sold under the
                                                          Narda brand name;
                                                          broad-band military
                                                          applications
<PAGE>
     Specialized Communication Products (1996 Pro Forma Sales: $304 million)

                                                     Selected Platforms/End
          Productions        Selected Applications            Uses
    ----------------------  ----------------------   ----------------------

    -- Safety          
       products                Radio frequency (RF)       Monitor cellular
                               monitoring and             base station and
                               measurement                industrial RF
                                                          emissions frequency
                                                          monitoring

    -- Semiconductors  
       (diodes,                Radio frequency            Various industrial
       capacitors)             switches, limiters,        and military end
                               voltage control,           uses, including
                               oscillators, harmonic      commercial
                               generators                 satellites, avionics
                                                          and specialty
                                                          communication
                                                          products

    -- Satellite and   
       wireless                Satellite transponder      F-16, E-2C, China
       components              control, channel and       Sat 
       (channel                frequency separation
       amplifiers,
       transceivers,
       converters,
       filters and
       multiplexers)

    Avionics
    Aviation Recorders
    -- Solid state
       cockpit voice           Voice recorders            Installed on all
       and flight              continuously record        business and
       data recorders          most recent 30-120         commercial aircraft
                               minutes of voice and       and certain military
                               sounds from cockpit        transport aircraft;
                               and aircraft               sold to both
                               inter-communications.      aircraft OEMs and
                               Flight data recorders      airlines under the
                               record the last 25         Fairchild brand name
                               hours of flight
                               parameters

    Display Systems
    -- Cockpit and     
       mission                 High performance,          E-2C, V-22, F-14,
       display                 ruggedized flat panel      F-117, E-6B, C-130,
       systems                 and cathode ray tube       AWACS and JSTARS
                               displays
<PAGE>
     Specialized Communication Products (1996 Pro Forma Sales: $304 million)

                                                     Selected Platforms/End
          Productions        Selected Applications            Uses
    ----------------------  ----------------------   ----------------------

    Antenna Systems
    -- Ultra-wide      
       frequency               Surveillance; radar        F-15, F-16, F-18,
       antennae                detection                  E-2C, A-7, EF-111,
       systems and                                        P-3, C-130, B-2,
       rotary joints                                      AWACS, Apache,
                                                          Cobra, Mirage
                                                          (France), Nimrod
                                                          (U.K.) and Tornado
                                                          (U.K.) 

    Telemetry and Instrumentation
    Telemetry
    -- Aircraft,      
       missile and             Real time data             F-15, F-18, F-22,
       satellite               acquisition,               Comanche, Nimrod
       telemetry               measurement,               (U.K.), Tactical
       systems                 processing,                Hellfire Titan,
                               simulation,                EELV, and A2100
                               distribution, display
                               and storage for flight
                               testing

    -- Training range 
       telemetry               Battlefield simulation     Combat simulation
       systems

    Instrumentation and
    Other
    -- Medical         
       imaging and             X-Ray cardiology, echo     Filmless, high speed
       archiving               cardiology and             image management and
                               radiology image            archiving for
                               management, review and     cardiology and
                               archiving                  radiology


    Industry Overview

         The defense industry has recently undergone significant change
    precipitated by ongoing federal budget pressures and new roles and
    missions to reflect changing strategic and tactical threats. Since the
    mid-1980's, the overall U.S. defense budget has declined in real dollars.
    In response, the DoD has focused its resources on enhancing its military
    readiness, joint operations and multiple mission capabilities, and
    incorporating advanced electronics to improve the performance, reduce
    operating cost and extend the life expectancy of its existing and future
    platforms. The emphasis on system interoperability, force multipliers and
    providing battlefield commanders with real-time data is increasing the
<PAGE>
    electronics content of nearly all of the major military procurement and
    research programs. As a result, the DoD's budget for communications and
    defense electronics is expected to grow. According to Federal Sources, an
    independent private consulting group, the defense budget for C3I is
    expected to increase from $30.0 billion in the fiscal year ended September
    30, 1996 to $42.0 billion in the fiscal year ended September 30, 2002, a
    compound annual growth rate of 5.8%.

         The industry has also undergone dramatic consolidation resulting in
    the emergence of four dominant prime system contractors. One outgrowth of
    this consolidation among the remaining major prime contractors is their
    desire to limit purchases of products and sub-systems from one another.
    Despite this desire, there are numerous essential but non-strategic
    products, components and systems that are not economical for the major
    prime contractors to design, develop or manufacture for their own internal
    use. As the prime contractors continue to evaluate their core competencies
    and competitive position, focusing their resources on larger programs and
    platforms, the Company expects the prime contractors will seek to exit
    non-strategic business areas and procure these needed elements on more
    favorable terms from independent, commercially oriented merchant
    suppliers.

         The focus on cost control is also driving increased use of
    commercial off-the-shelf products for both upgrades of existing systems
    and in new systems. The Company believes the prime contractors will
    continue to be under pressure to reduce their costs and will increasingly
    seek to focus their resources and capabilities on major systems, turning
    to commercially oriented merchant suppliers to produce non-core
    sub-systems, components and products. Going forward, the successful
    merchant suppliers will use their resources to complement and support,
    rather than compete with the prime contractors. L-3 anticipates the
    relationship between the major prime contractors and their primary
    suppliers will, as in the automotive industry, develop into critical
    partnerships encompassing increasingly greater outsourcing of non-core
    products and systems by the prime contractors to their key merchant
    suppliers and increasing supplier participation in the development of
    future programs. Early involvement in the upgrading of existing systems
    and the design and engineering of new systems incorporating these
    outsourced products will provide top-tier suppliers, including the
    Company, with a competitive advantage in securing new business and provide
    the prime contractors with significant cost reduction opportunities
    through coordination of the design, development and manufacturing
    processes.

    Business Strategy

         L-3 intends to leverage its market position, diverse program base
    and favorable mix of cost plus to fixed price contracts to enhance its
    profitability, reduce its indebtedness and to establish itself as the
    premier merchant supplier of communication systems and products to the
    major prime contractors in the aerospace/defense industry as well as the
    Government. The Company's strategy to achieve these objectives includes:

         -- Expand Merchant Supplier Relationships. Senior Management has
    developed strong relationships with virtually all of the prime
    contractors, the DoD and other major government agencies, enabling L-3 to
<PAGE>
    identify business opportunities and anticipate customer needs. As an
    independent merchant supplier, the Company anticipates its future growth
    will be driven by expanding its share of existing programs and by
    participating in new programs. Management has already identified several
    opportunities where the Company believes it will be able to use its strong
    relationships to increase its business presence and allow its customers to
    reduce their costs. The Company also expects to benefit from increased
    outsourcing by prime contractors who in the past may have limited their
    purchases to captive suppliers and who are now expected to view L-3's
    capabilities on a more favorable basis given its status as an independent
    company.

         -- Support Customer Requirements. A significant portion of L-3's
    sales are derived from high-priority, long-term programs and from programs
    for which the Company has been the incumbent supplier, and in many cases
    acted as the sole provider, over many years. Approximately 67% of the
    Company's total pro forma 1996 sales were generated from sole source
    contracts. L-3's customer satisfaction and excellent performance record
    are evidenced by its performance-based award fees exceeding 90% on average
    over the past two years. Going forward, management believes prime
    contractors will award long-term, sole source, outsourcing contracts to
    the merchant supplier they believe is most capable on the basis of
    quality, responsiveness, design, engineering and program management
    support as well as cost. Reflecting L-3's strong competitive position, the
    Company has experienced a contract award win rate over the past two years
    of approximately 50% on new competitive contracts for which it competes
    and approximately 90% on contracts for which it is the incumbent. The
    Company intends to continue to align its research and development,
    manufacturing and new business efforts to complement its customers'
    requirements.

         -- Leverage Technical and Market Leadership Positions. L-3 has
    developed strong, proprietary technical capabilities that have enabled it
    to capture a number one or two market position in most of its key business
    areas, including secure, high data rate communication systems, solid state
    aviation recorders, advanced antenna systems and high performance
    microwave components. Over the past three years, the Company and its
    Predecessors have invested over $100 million in Company-sponsored
    independent research and development, including bid and proposal costs, in
    addition to making substantial investments in its technical and
    manufacturing resources. Further, the Company has a highly skilled
    workforce including over 1,500 engineers. As an independent company,
    management intends to leverage its technical expertise and capabilities
    into several closely aligned commercial business areas and applications,
    including opportunities in wireless telephony and medical imaging archive
    management.

         -- Maintain Diversified Business Mix. The Company enjoys a diverse
    business mix with a limited program exposure, a favorable balance of cost
    plus to fixed price contracts, a significant sole source business and an
    attractive customer profile. The Company's largest program, representing
    14% of 1996 pro forma sales, is a long-term, sole source, cost plus
    support program for the U-2 program Directorate for the DoD. No other
    program represented more than 7% of pro forma 1996 sales. Further, the
    Company's pro forma sales mix of contracts in 1996 was 42% cost plus and
    58% fixed price, providing the Company with a balanced mix of predictable
<PAGE>
    profitability (cost plus) and higher margin (fixed price) business. L-3
    also enjoys an attractive customer mix of defense and commercial business,
    with DoD related sales accounting for 65% and commercial and federal
    (non-DoD) sales accounting for 35% of 1996 pro forma sales. The Company
    intends to leverage this favorable business profile to expand its merchant
    supplier business base.

         -- Enhance Operating Margins. As part of larger corporations (i.e.,
    Lockheed Martin, Loral, GE, Unisys), the Businesses were historically
    required to absorb significant corporate expense allocations. As an
    independent company, L-3 believes that it will be able to leverage its
    discretionary expenditures in a more focused and efficient manner, enhance
    its operating performance and reduce overhead expenses reflecting Senior
    Management's more flexible, entrepreneurial approach. The Company believes
    that significant costs incurred by the Businesses under Lockheed Martin's
    ownership will not be incurred going forward. These cost savings include
    reduced corporate administrative and facilities expenses and certain
    operating performance improvements.

         -- Capitalize on Strategic Acquisition Opportunities. Recent
    industry consolidation has virtually eliminated traditional middle-tier
    aerospace/defense companies. This level of consolidation is now beginning
    to draw the concern of the DoD and federal anti-trust regulators. As a
    result, the Company anticipates the pending major mergers as well as
    continued consolidation of the smaller participants in the defense
    industry will create attractive complementary acquisition candidates for
    L-3 in the future as these companies continue to evaluate their core
    competencies and competitive position. 

    Products and Services

    Secure Communication Systems

         L-3 is a leader in communication systems for high performance
    intelligence collection, imagery processing and ground, air, sea and
    satellite communications for the DoD and other government agencies. The
    Company's Secure Communication Systems operations are located in Salt Lake
    City, Utah and Camden, New Jersey, and together had pro forma sales of
    $371.5 million and EBITDA of $41.6 million in 1996. The Salt Lake City
    operation provides secure, high data rate, real-time communication systems
    for surveillance, reconnaissance and other intelligence collection
    systems. The Camden operation designs, develops, produces and integrates
    communication systems and support equipment for space, ground and naval
    applications. Product lines of the Secure Communication Systems business
    include high data rate communication links, satellite communication
    ("SATCOM") terminals, Navy vessel communication systems, space
    communications and satellite control systems, signal intelligence
    information processing systems, information security systems, tactical
    battlefield sensor systems and commercial communication systems.

    -- High Data Rate Communications

         The Company is a technology leader in high data rate, covert,
    jam-resistant microwave communications in support of military and other
    national agency reconnaissance and surveillance applications. L-3's
    product line covers a full range of tactical and strategic secure
<PAGE>
    point-to-point and relay data transmission systems, products and support
    services that conform to military and intelligence specifications. The
    Company's systems and products are capable of providing battlefield
    commanders with real time, secure surveillance and targeting information
    and were used extensively by U.S. armed forces in the Persian Gulf war.

         During the 1980s, largely based on its prior experience with command
    and control guidance systems for remotely-piloted vehicles, L-3 developed
    its current family of strategic and tactical data links, including its
    Modular Interoperable Data Link ("MIDL") systems and Modular Interoperable
    Surface Terminals ("MIST"). MIDL and MIST technologies are considered
    virtual DoD standards in terms of data link hardware. The Company's
    primary focus is spread spectrum communication (based on CDMA technology),
    which involves transmitting a signal as noise so as to make it difficult
    to detect to others, and then re-capturing the signal and removing the
    noise. The Company's data links are capable of providing information at
    over 200 Mb/s.

         L-3 provides these secure high band width services to the U.S. Air
    Force, Navy, Army and various Government agencies, many through long-term
    sole source programs. The scope of these programs include air-to-ground,
    air-to-air, ground-to-air and satellite communications. Government
    programs include: U-2 Support, Common High-Band Width Data Link Surface
    Terminal ("CHBDL-ST"), Battle Group Passive Horizon Extension System
    ("BGPHES"), Light Airborne Multi-Purpose System (LAMPS), TriBand SATCOM
    Subsystem ("TSS"), all unmanned aerial vehicle ("UAV") programs and Direct
    Air-Satellite Relay ("DASR").

    -- Satellite Communication Terminals

         L-3 provides ground-to-satellite, high availability, real-time
    global communications capability through a family of transportable field
    terminals to communicate with commercial, military and international
    satellites. These terminals provide remote personnel with anywhere,
    anytime effective communication capability and provide communications
    links to distant forces. The Company's TriBand SATCOM Subsystem ("TSS")
    employs a 6.25 meter tactical dish with a single point feed that provides
    C, Ku and X band communication to support the U.S. Army. The Company also
    offers an 11.3 meter dish which is transportable on two C-130 aircraft.
    The SHF Portable Terminal System ("PTS") is a lightweight (28 lbs.),
    manportable terminal, which communicates through DSCS, NATO or SKYNET
    satellites and brings unprecedented connectivity to small military
    tactical units and mobile command posts. L-3 recently delivered 14 of
    these terminals for use by NATO forces in Bosnia.

    -- Space Communications and Satellite Control

         Continuing L-3's tradition of providing communications for every
    manned U.S. space flight since Mercury, the Company is currently designing
    and testing three communication subsystems for the International Space
    Station ("ISS"). These systems will control all ISS radio frequency ("RF")
    communications and external video activities. The Company also provides
    solid-state recorders and memory units for data capture, storage, transfer
    and retrieval for space applications. The standard NASA tape recorder,
    which was developed and produced by the Company, has completed over three
    million hours of service without a mission failure. Current programs
<PAGE>
    include recorders for the National Oceanic & Atmospheric Administration
    ("NOAA") weather satellites, the Earth Observing Satellite ("EOS") AM
    spacecraft and Landsat-7 Earth-monitoring spacecraft. The Company also
    provides space and satellite system simulation, satellite operations and
    computer system training, depot support, network engineering, resource
    scheduling, launch system engineering, support, software integration and
    test through cost-plus contracts with the U.S. Air Force.

    -- Military Communications

         The Company provides integrated, computer controlled switching
    systems for the interior and exterior voice and data needs of today's Navy
    military vessels. The Company's products include Integrated Voice
    Communication Systems ("IVCS") for Aegis cruisers and destroyers and the
    Integrated Radio Room ("IRR") for Trident class submarines, the first
    computer controlled communications center in a submarine. These products
    integrate the intercom, tactical and administrative communications network
    into one system accessing various types of communication terminals
    throughout the ship. The Company's MarCom 2000 secure digital switching
    system is in development for the Los Angeles class attack submarine and
    provides an integrated approach to the specialized voice and data
    communications needs of a shipboard environment for internal and external
    communications, command and control and air traffic control. The Company
    also offers on-board, high data rate communications systems which provide
    a data link for carrier battle groups which are interoperable with the
    U.S. Air Force's surveillance/ reconnaissance terminal platforms.

    -- Information Security Systems

         The Company has produced more than 100,000 secure telephone units
    ("STU III") which are in use today by the U.S. Armed Forces to provide
    secure telephone capabilities for classified confidential communication
    over public commercial telephone networks. The Company has begun producing
    the next-generation digital, ISDN-compatible STE. STE provides clearer
    voice and seven-times faster data/fax transmission capability than the STU
    III. STE also supports secure conference calls and secure video
    teleconferencing. STE uses a CryptoCard security system which consists of
    a small, portable, cryptographic module mounted on a PCMCIA card holding
    the algorithms, keys and personalized credentials to identify its user for
    secure communications access. The Company also provides LMD/KP which is
    the workstation component of the Government's Electronic Key Management
    System ("EKMS"), the next generation of information security systems. EKMS
    is the Government system to replace current "paper" secret keys used to
    secure government communications with "electronic" secret keys. LMD/KP is
    the component of the EKMS which produces and distributes the electronic
    keys. L-3 also develops specialized strategic and tactical SIGINT to
    detect, acquire, collect, and process information derived from electronic
    sources. These systems are used by classified customers for intelligence
    gathering and require high speed digital signal processing and high
    density custom hardware designs.

    -- Tactical Security Systems

         The Company manufactures the IREMBASS, an unattended ground sensor
    system which uses sensors placed along likely avenues of enemy approach or
    intrusion in a battlefield environment. The sensors respond to seismic and
<PAGE>
    acoustic disturbances, infrared energy and magnetic field changes and thus
    detect enemy activities. IREMBASS is currently in use by U.S. Special
    Operations Forces, the U.S. Army's Light Divisions and several foreign
    governments. The Company also provides the Intrusion Detection Early
    Warning System ("IDEWS"), a sensor system designed for platoon-level
    physical security applications. Weighing less than two pounds, this sensor
    system is ideal for covert perimeter intrusion detection, border
    protection and airfield or military installation security.

    -- Commercial Communications

         The Company is applying its wireless communication expertise to
    introduce local wireless loop equipment using a synchronous Code Division
    Multiple Access technology protocol ("CDMA") supporting terrestrial and
    space based, fixed and mobile communication services. The system's
    principal targeted customer base is emerging market countries and rural
    areas where existing telecommunications infrastructure is inadequate or
    non-existent. The Company's system will have the potential to interface
    with low earth orbit ("LEO") PCS systems such as Globalstar, Iridium and
    or any local public telephone network. The Company expects to manufacture
    for sale certain of the infrastructure equipment and to license its
    technology to third-party providers. The Company expects to partner with
    third parties for service and distribution capabilities. The Company has
    entered into product distribution agreements with Granger Telecom for
    distribution in parts of Africa, the Middle East and the United Kingdom,
    and with Unisys for distribution in parts of Mexico and South America.

    Specialized Communication Products

    Microwave Components

         L-3 is the pre-eminent worldwide supplier of commercial
    off-the-shelf, high performance radio frequency ("RF") microwave
    components, assemblies and instruments supplying the wireless
    communication, industrial and military markets. The Company is also a
    leading provider of state-of-the-art space-qualified commercial satellite
    and strategic military RF products. L-3 sells many of these components
    under the well-recognized Narda brand name and through the world's most
    comprehensive catalogue of standard, stocked hardware. L-3 also sells its
    products through a direct sales force and an extensive network of premier
    market representatives. Specific catalog offerings include wireless
    products, electro-mechanical switches, power dividers and hybrids,
    couplers/detectors, attenuators, terminations and phase shifters,
    isolators and circulators, adapters, control products, sources, mixers,
    waveguide components, RF safety products, power meters/monitors and custom
    passive products. The Company operates from two sites, Hauppauge, New York
    ("Narda East"), and Sacramento, California ("Narda West").

         Narda East represents approximately 62% of L-3's microwave sales
    volume, offering high performance microwave components, networks and
    instruments to the wireless, industrial and military communications
    markets. Narda East's products can be divided into three major categories:
    passive components, higher level wireless assemblies/monitoring systems
    and safety instruments.
<PAGE>
         Passive components are generally purchased in narrow frequency
    configurations by wireless OEM equipment manufacturers and service
    providers. Similar components are purchased in wide frequency
    configurations by first tier military equipment suppliers. Commercial
    applications for Narda components are primarily in cellular or PCS base
    stations. Narda also manufactures higher level assemblies for wireless
    base stations and the paging industry. These products include
    communication antenna test sets, devices that monitor reflected power to
    determine if a cellular base station is working. Military applications
    include general procurement for test equipment or electronic surveillance
    and countermeasure systems. RF safety products are instruments which are
    used to measure the level of non-ionizing radiation in a given area, i.e.,
    from an antenna, test set or other emitting source.

         Narda West designs and manufactures state-of-the-art space-qualified
    and wireless components. Space qualified components include channel
    amplifiers for satellite transponder control and diplexers/ multiplexers,
    which are used to separate various signals and direct them to the
    appropriate other sections of the payload. Narda West's primary areas of
    focus are communication satellite payload products. Channel amplifiers
    constitute Narda West's main satellite product. These components amplify
    the weak signals received from earth stations by a factor of 1 million,
    and then drive the power amplifier tubes that broadcast the signal back to
    earth. These products are sold to satellite manufacturers and offer lower
    cost, lower weight and improved performance versus in-house alternatives.
    On a typical satellite, for which there are 20 to 50 channel amps, Narda
    West's channel amps offer cost savings of up to 60% (up to $1 million per
    satellite) and decrease launch weight by up to 25 kilograms.

         The operation also offers a wide variety of high-reliability power
    splitters, combiners and filters for spacecraft and launch vehicles, such
    as LLV, Tiros N, THAAD, Mars Surveyor, Peacekeeper, Galileo, Skynet,
    Cassini, Milstar, Space Shuttle, LandSat, FltSatCom, GPS, GPS Block IIR,
    IUS, ACE, SMEX and certain classified programs. Narda West also produces
    ground transceivers for communication with satellites. These Very Small
    Aperture Terminal ("VSAT") transceivers are used in medium and high data
    rate applications in the C and Ku frequency bands normally used for
    transmit/receiver applications. Other Narda West products include wireless
    microwave components for cellular and PCS base station applications. These
    products include filters used for transmit and receive channel separation
    as well as ferrite components, which isolate certain microwave functions,
    thereby preventing undesired signal interaction. The balance of the
    operation's business is of a historical nature and involves wideband
    filters used for electronic warfare applications and cavity oscillators
    used in commercial test equipment and terrestrial radio applications.

    Avionics

    -- Aviation Recorders

         L-3 manufactures commercial solid-state crash-protected aviation
    recorders ("black boxes") under the Fairchild brand name, and has
    delivered over 40,000 flight recorders to airplane manufacturers and
    airlines around the world. Recorders are mandated and regulated by various
    worldwide agencies for commercial airlines and a large portion of business
    aviation aircraft. Management anticipates growth opportunities in Aviation
<PAGE>
    Recorders as a result of the current high level of orders for new
    commercial aircraft. Additional growth opportunities exist in the military
    market as a result of recent military aircraft accidents. There are two
    types of recorders: (i) the Cockpit Voice Recorder ("CVR") which records
    the last 30 to 120 minutes of crew conversation and ambient sounds from
    the cockpit and (ii) the Flight Data Recorder ("FDR") which records the
    last 25 hours of aircraft flight parameters such as speed, altitude,
    acceleration, thrust from each engine and direction of the flight in its
    final moments. Recorders are highly ruggedized instruments, designed to
    absorb the shock equivalent to that of an object traveling at 268 knots
    stopping in 18 inches, fire resistant to 1,100 degrees centigrade and
    pressure resistance equal to 20,000 feet undersea for 30 days. Management
    believes that the Company has the leading worldwide market position for
    CVR's and FDR's.

    -- Antenna Systems

         Under the Randtron brand name, L-3 produces high performance
    antennas designed for surveillance, high-resolution, ultra-wide frequency
    bands, detection of low radar cross section ("LRCS") targets, LRCS
    installations, severe environmental applications and polarization
    diversity. L-3's main antenna product is a sophisticated 24-foot diameter
    antenna operational on all E-2C aircraft. This airborne antenna consists
    of a 24-foot rotating aerodynamic oblate spheroid radome containing a UHF
    surveillance radar antenna, IFF antenna and forward and aft auxiliary
    antennas. This antenna began production in the early 1980s, and production
    is planned beyond 2000 for the E-2C, P3 and C-130 AEW aircraft. L-3 also
    produces broad-band antennas for a variety of tactical aircraft and rotary
    joints for the AWAC's and E-2C's antenna. Randtron has delivered
    approximately 2,000 aircraft sets of antennas and has a current backlog
    through 1999.

    -- Display Systems

         L-3 specializes in the design, development and manufacture of
    ruggedized display system solutions for military and high-end commercial
    applications. L-3's current product lines include cathode ray tubes
    ("CRTs") and the Actiview family of active matrix liquid crystal displays
    ("AMLCD"). L-3 manufactures flat-panel displays with diagonal screen sizes
    of 10.4 and 20.1 inches that are in platforms such as E-2C (enhanced main
    display unit and Q-70 advanced display system), F-14, F-117 and V-22.

    Telemetry and Instrumentation

         The Company is a leader in component products used in telemetry and
    instrumentation for satellites, aircraft, UAVs, launch vehicles and
    missiles. Telemetry involves the collection of data from these platforms,
    its transmission to ground stations for analysis, and its further
    dissemination or transportation to another platform. A principal use of
    this telemetry data is to measure as many as 1,000 different parameters of
    the platform's operation (in much the same way as a flight data recorder
    on an airplane measures various flight parameters) and transmits this data
    to the ground.
<PAGE>
         Additionally, for satellite platforms, the equipment also provides
    the command uplink that controls the satellite. In these applications,
    high reliability of components is crucial because of the high cost of
    satellite repair and the length of uninterrupted service required.
    Telemetry also provides the data to terminate the flight of missiles and
    rockets under errant conditions and/or at the end of mission.

    -- Airborne, Ground and Space Telemetry

         The Company provides airborne equipment and data link systems to
    gather critical information and to process, format and transmit it to the
    ground through communication data links from a communications satellite,
    spacecraft, aircraft and/or missile. These products are available in both
    COTS and custom configurations. Major customers are the major defense
    contractors who manufacture aircraft, missiles, warheads, launch vehicles,
    munitions and bombs. Ground instrumentation activity occurs at the ground
    station where the serial stream of combined data is received and decoded
    in real-time, as it is received from the airborne platform. Data can be
    encrypted and decrypted during this process, an additional expertise that
    the Company offers. L-3 offers the System 500 which interfaces with
    airborne telemetry and helps determine if it is within certain parameters
    of its flight pattern and displays the information graphically on a ground
    station terminal. The Company is currently developing the NeTstar ground
    station terminal which is capable of handling compressed satellite mission
    time frames.

    -- Range Instrumentation

         A ground-based application for the Company is range instrumentation,
    where equipment that is worn by soldiers or mounted in vehicles transmit
    and receive data that is used for test and evaluation of training
    missions. The Company's Digital Communication Network Subsystem ("DCNS")
    product allows for more effective monitoring and control of training and
    testing ranges.

    -- Transportable Radios

         The Company also manufactures transportable, tunable, microwave
    radios used for commercial and military voice and data communication
    service restoration and features rugged, modularized systems capable of
    data rates up to 155 Mb/s. Frequencies are tunable in RF bands from 1.7
    GHz to 19.7 GHz with simple plug-in radio frequency heads. The radios are
    encased in portable, all-weather outdoor housing for use in restoration
    and temporary service and military tactical communications.

    -- Expendable Countermeasure Systems

         L-3 designs, develops and produces radar, infrared, electro-optical
    and acoustic expendable countermeasure systems, computer-controlled
    launchers and dispensers for ships, aircraft, ground vehicles and base
    defense. L-3 is the world leader in the design, development and production
    of passive off-board ship defense countermeasures systems for the U.S.
    Navy and international customers. The products include the MK 214 and MK
    216 Sea Gnat Decoys, which are the seduction and distraction decoys used
    by the U.S. Navy and NATO for ship defense against radar-guided threats.
    L-3 also manufactures Automatic Launch of Expendables ("ALEX"), a
<PAGE>
    completely automated ship-defense launch system that takes threat
    information from the ship's warning system and speed, direction and wind
    conditions from the ship's navigation system and initiates the optimum
    countermeasure response and/or maneuver based on the decoy load-out
    inventory.

    -- Commercial Communication Products

         The Company and GE Medical Systems have jointly developed
    GEMnet(Trademark), a cardiac image management and archive system.
    GEMnet(Trademark) eliminates the use of cinefilm in a cardiac
    catheterization laboratory by providing a direct digital connection to the
    laboratory. The system provides for acquisition, display, analysis and
    short-and long-term archive of cardiac patient studies, providing
    significant cost savings and process improvements to the hospital.
    EchoNet(Trademark) is a digital archive management and review system
    designed by the Company specifically for the echocardiology profession.
    Echonet(Trademark) is the result of an exclusive strategic partnership
    with Heartlab, Inc. and is distributed by Nova Microsonics. The system
    accepts digital echocardiology studies from a variety of currently
    available ultrasound systems, manages the studies, making them available
    on a network, and allows the physicians and technicians to become more
    productive. DICOMView(Trademark) is a multimodal, low-cost viewing station
    designed by the Company for use with standard IBM-compatible and Macintosh
    personal computer platforms. It makes full motion, full fidelity
    diagnostic images accessible for the cardiologist, surgeon and referring
    physician. EchoNet(Trademark) and DICOMView(Trademark) are trademarks of
    Heartlab, Inc. GEMnet(Trademark) is a trademark of GE.

    Major Customers

         The Company's sales are predominantly derived from contracts with
    agencies of, and prime contractors to, the Government. The various
    Government customers exercise independent purchasing decisions. Sales to
    the Government generally are not regarded as constituting sales to one
    customer. Instead, each contracting entity is considered to be a separate
    customer. In 1996, the Company performed under approximately 180 contracts
    with value exceeding $1 million for the Government. Government pro forma
    sales in 1996, including pro forma sales to the Government through prime
    contractors, were $529 million. Historical sales to Lockheed Martin were
    $70.7 million in 1996. The Company's largest program, representing 14% of
    1996 pro forma sales, is a long-term, sole source cost plus support
    program for the U-2 Directorate. No other program represented more than 7%
    of pro forma 1996 sales.

    Research and Development

         The Company employs scientific, engineering and other personnel to
    improve its existing product lines and to develop new products and
    technologies in the same or related fields. As of December 31, 1996, the
    Company employed approximately 1,580 engineers (of whom over 35% hold
    advanced degrees). The pro forma amounts of research and development
    performed under customer-funded contracts and Company-sponsored research
    projects, including bid and proposal costs, for 1996 were $153.5 million
    and $36.5 million, respectively.
<PAGE>
    Competition

         The Company's ability to compete for defense contracts depends to a
    large extent on the effectiveness and innovativeness of its research and
    development programs, its ability to offer better program performance than
    its competitors at a lower cost to the Government customer, and its
    readiness in facilities, equipment and personnel to undertake the programs
    for which it competes. In some instances, programs are sole source or work
    directed by the Government to a single supplier. In such cases, there may
    be other suppliers who have the capability to compete for the programs
    involved, but they can only enter or reenter the market if the Government
    should choose to reopen the particular program to competition.
    Approximately 67% of the Company's 1996 pro forma sales related to sole
    source contracts.

         The Company experiences competition from industrial firms and U.S.
    government agencies, some of which have substantially greater resources.
    These competitors include: Allied Signal Inc., AMP, Inc., Aydin
    Corporation, Cubic Corporation, GTE Corporation, Harris Corporation, GM
    Hughes Electronics, Motorola, Inc., Raytheon Company and Titan
    Corporation. A majority of the sales of the Company is derived from
    contracts with the Government and its prime contractors, and such
    contracts are awarded on the basis of negotiations or competitive bids.
    Management does not believe any one competitor or a small number of
    competitors is dominant in any of the business areas of the Company.
    Management believes the Company will continue to be able to compete
    successfully based upon the quality and cost competitiveness of its
    products and services.

    Patents and Licenses

         Although the Company owns some patents and has filed applications
    for additional patents, it does not believe that its operations depend
    upon its patents. In addition, the Company's Government contracts
    generally license it to use patents owned by others. Similar provisions in
    the Government contracts awarded to other companies make it impossible for
    the Company to prevent the use by other companies of its patents in most
    domestic work.

    Backlog

         As of December 31, 1996, the Company's funded backlog was
    approximately $542.5 million. This backlog provides management with a
    useful tool to project sales and plan its business on an on-going basis;
    however, no assurance can be given that the Company's backlog will become
    revenues in any particular period or at all. Funded backlog does not
    include the total contract value of multi-year, cost-plus reimbursable
    contracts, which are funded as costs are incurred by the Company. Funded
    backlog also does not include unexercised contract options which represent
    the amount of revenue which would be recognized from the performance of
    contract options that may be exercised by customers under existing
    contracts and from purchase orders to be issued under indefinite quantity
    contracts or basic ordering agreements. Backlog is a more relevant
    predictor of future sales in the Secure Communication Systems business
    area. Current funded backlog in Secure Communication Systems as of
    December 31, 1996 was $331.5 million, of which approximately 81.3% is
<PAGE>
    expected to be shipped in 1997. The Company believes backlog is a less
    relevant factor in the Specialized Communication Products business area
    given the nature of its catalog and commercial oriented business. Overall,
    approximately 77% of the Company's December 31, 1996 funded backlog is
    expected to be shipped in 1997.

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>

                                                      Funded Backlog as of
                                                      December 31, 1996
                                                   ---------------------------
                                                        ($ in millions)
<S>                                                <C>

    Secure Communication Systems  . . . . . . . .             $331.5
    Communication Products  . . . . . . . . . . .              211.0
                                                              ------
                                                              $542.5
                                                              ======
</TABLE>


    Government Contracts

         Approximately 78.4% of the Company's 1996 pro forma sales were made
    to agencies of the Government or to prime contractors or subcontractors of
    the Government.

         Approximately 58% of the Company's pro forma 1996 sales mix of
    contracts were firm fixed price contracts under which the Company agrees
    to perform for a predetermined price. Although the Company's fixed price
    contracts generally permit the Company to keep profits if costs are less
    than projected, the Company does bear the risk that increased or
    unexpected costs may reduce profit or cause the Company to sustain losses
    on the contract. Generally, firm fixed price contracts offer higher margin
    than cost plus type contracts. All domestic defense contracts and
    subcontracts to which the Company is a party are subject to audit, various
    profit and cost controls and standard provisions for termination at the
    convenience of the Government. Upon termination, other than for a
    contractor's default, the contractor will normally be entitled to
    reimbursement for allowable costs and to an allowance for profit. Foreign
    defense contracts generally contain comparable provisions relating to
    termination at the convenience of the government. To date, no significant
    fixed price contract of the Company has been terminated.

         Companies supplying defense-related equipment to the Government are
    subject to certain additional business risks peculiar to that industry.
    Among these risks are the ability of the Government to unilaterally
    suspend the Company from new contracts pending resolution of alleged
    violations of procurement laws or regulations. Other risks include a
    dependence on appropriations by the Government, changes in the
    Government's procurement policies (such as greater emphasis on competitive
    procurements) and the need to bid on programs in advance of design
    completion. A reduction in expenditures by the Government for products of
    the type manufactured by the Company, lower margins resulting from
<PAGE>
    increasingly competitive procurement policies, a reduction in the volume
    of contracts or subcontracts awarded to the Company or substantial cost
    overruns would have an adverse effect on the Company's cash flow.

    Properties

         The table below sets forth, as of December 31, 1996, certain
    information with respect to L-3's manufacturing facilities and properties.


                Location                     Owned           Leased
    --------------------------------     ---------------  --------------
                                           (thousands of square feet)

    L-3 Headquarters, NY  . . . . . . . . .     --               58.5
    Secure Communication Systems:
     Camarillo, CA  . . . . . . . . . . . .     --                1.8
     El Segundo, CA   . . . . . . . . . . .     --                1.4
     Santa Clara, CA  . . . . . . . . . . .     --                5.9
     Santa Maria, CA  . . . . . . . . . . .     --                9.8
     Colorado Springs, CO   . . . . . . . .     --                5.8
     Camden, NJ   . . . . . . . . . . . . .     --              588.6
     Tinton Falls, NJ   . . . . . . . . . .     --                0.8
     Salt Lake City, UT   . . . . . . . . .     --              457.6
    Specialized Communication Products:
     Folsom, CA   . . . . . . . . . . . . .     --               57.5
     Lancaster, CA  . . . . . . . . . . . .     --                5.4
     Menlo Park, CA   . . . . . . . . . . .     --               93.0
     Rancho Cordova, CA   . . . . . . . . .     --               40.4
     Redwood City, CA   . . . . . . . . . .     --                5.2
     San Diego, CA  . . . . . . . . . . . .  196.0               68.9
     San Mateo, CA  . . . . . . . . . . . .     --               14.8
     Santa Clara, CA  . . . . . . . . . . .     --               2.0
     Merrill Island, FL   . . . . . . . . .     --               1.2
     Sarasota, FL   . . . . . . . . . . . .  303.6                --
     Alpharetta, GA   . . . . . . . . . . .   40.0                --
     Atlanta, GA  . . . . . . . . . . . . .   52.1                --
     Norcross, GA   . . . . . . . . . . . .     --               4.8
     Haverhill, MA  . . . . . . . . . . . .    8.0                --
     Lowell, MA   . . . . . . . . . . . . .     --               47.0
     Woburn, MA   . . . . . . . . . . . . .  106.0                 --
     Hauppauge, NY  . . . . . . . . . . . .  150.0                 --
     Warminster, PA   . . . . . . . . . . .   44.7                 --
     Slough, Berkshire (U.K.)   . . . . . .    --                 1.4
                                             -----            -------
    Total . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  900.4            1,471.8
                                             =====            =======

<PAGE>
    Legal Proceedings

         From time to time the Company is involved in legal proceedings
    arising in the ordinary course of its business. As part of the
    Acquisition, the Company has agreed to assume certain litigation relating
    to the Businesses and Lockheed Martin has agreed to indemnify the Company,
    up to certain limits, for a breach of its representations and warranties.
    Management believes it is adequately reserved for these liabilities and
    that there is no litigation pending that could have a material adverse
    effect on the Company or its operations, except as discussed below.

         As of June 30, 1997, the Company and Universal Avionics Systems
    Corporation ("Universal") has reached a settlement with respect to a
    lawsuit brought by Universal against the Company's Aviation Recorders
    operation ("Aviation Recorders"). The terms of this settlement will not
    have a material adverse effect on the Company's financial condition or
    results of operations.

    Environmental Matters

         The Company's operations are subject to various federal, state and
    local environmental laws and regulations relating to the discharge,
    storage, treatment, handling, disposal and remediation of certain
    materials, substances and wastes used in or resulting from its operations.
    The Company continually assesses its obligations and compliance with
    respect to these requirements. Based on a review by an independent
    environmental consulting firm and its own internal assessments, management
    believes that the Company's current operations are in substantial
    compliance with all existing applicable environmental laws and
    regulations. New environmental protection laws that will be effective in
    1997 and thereafter may require the installation of environmental
    protection equipment at the Company's manufacturing facilities. However,
    the Company does not believe that its environmental expenditures, if any,
    will have a material adverse effect on its financial condition or results
    of operations.

         Pursuant to the Transaction Agreement, the Company has agreed to
    assume certain on-site and off-site environmental liabilities related to
    events or activities occurring prior to the consummation of the
    Transaction. Lockheed Martin has agreed to retain all environmental
    liabilities for all facilities not used by the Businesses as of the
    Closing and to indemnify fully the Company for such prior site
    environmental liabilities. Lockheed Martin has also agreed, for the first
    eight years following the Closing, to pay 50% of all costs incurred by the
    Company above those reserved for on the Company's balance sheet at Closing
    relating to certain Company-assumed environmental liabilities and, for the
    seven years thereafter, to pay 40% of certain reasonable operation and
    maintenance costs relating to any environmental remediation projects
    undertaken in the first eight years. The Company is aware of environmental
    contamination at two of its facilities that will require ongoing
    remediation. Management believes that the Company has established adequate
    reserves for the potential costs associated with the assumed environmental
    liabilities. However, there can be no assurance that any costs incurred
    will be reimbursable from the Government or covered by Lockheed Martin
    under the terms of the Transaction Agreement or that the Company's
    environmental reserves will be sufficient.
<PAGE>
    Pension Plans

         The Transaction Agreement provides for transfer by Lockheed Martin
    of certain assets to L-3 and assumption by L-3 of certain liabilities
    relating to defined benefit pension plans for present and former employees
    and retirees of certain businesses transferred to L-3. Lockheed Martin
    received a letter from the Pension Benefit Guaranty Corporation (the
    "PBGC") which requested information regarding the transfer of such pension
    plans. The PBGC's letter indicated that it believed certain of the
    employee pension plans were underfunded using the PBGC's actuarial
    assumptions (which assumptions result in a larger liability for accrued
    benefits than the assumptions used for financial reporting under Statement
    of Financial Accounting Standards No. 87, "Accounting for Pension Costs"
    ("FASB 87")). The Company has calculated the net funding position of the
    pension plans to be transferred and believes the plans to be overfunded by
    approximately $1 million under ERISA assumptions, underfunded by
    approximately $9 million under FASB 87 assumptions and, on a termination
    basis, underfunded by as much as $51 million under PBGC assumptions.
    Substantially all of the PBGC underfunding is related to two pension plans
    covering employees at L-3's Communication Systems -- Salt Lake and
    Aviation Recorders businesses (the "Salt Lake and Fairchild Plans").

         Pursuant to the PBGC's inquiry, representatives of the Company and
    Lockheed Martin met with the PBGC on April 7, 1997. At this meeting, the
    PBGC stated that it would seek some form of commitment or undertaking from
    Lockheed Martin acceptable to it with regard to the Salt Lake and
    Fairchild Plans and the pension plan covering employees at Hycor, another
    business being acquired by L-3 in the Acquisition (collectively, the
    "Subject Plans"). Lockheed Martin has agreed to provide such a commitment
    in an agreement (the "Lockheed Martin Commitment Agreement") among
    Lockheed Martin, L-3 and the PBGC dated as of April 30, 1997. The material
    terms and conditions of the Lockheed Martin Commitment Agreement include a
    commitment by Lockheed Martin to, under certain circumstances, assume
    sponsorship of the Subject Plans or provide another form of financial
    support for the Subject Plans. The Lockheed Martin Commitment Agreement
    will continue until such time as the Subject Plans are no longer
    underfunded on a PBGC basis for two consecutive years or, at any time
    after May 31, 2002, the Company achieves investment grade credit ratings.
    Pursuant to the Lockheed Martin Commitment Agreement, the PBGC has agreed
    that it will take no further action in connection with the Transaction.

         In return for the Lockheed Martin Commitment, the Company has
    entered into an agreement with Lockheed Martin, dated as of April 30,
    1997, pursuant to which the Company will provide certain assurances to
    Lockheed Martin including, but not necessarily limited to, (i) continuing
    to fund the Subject Plans consistent with prior practices and to the
    extent deductible for tax purposes and, where appropriate, recoverable
    under Government contracts, (ii) agreeing to not increase benefits under
    the Subject Plans without the consent of Lockheed Martin,
    (iii) restricting the Company from a sale of any businesses employing
    individuals covered by the Subject Plans if such sale would not result in
    reduction or elimination of the Lockheed Martin Commitment with regard to
    the specific plan and (iv) if the Subject Plans were returned to Lockheed
    Martin, granting Lockheed Martin the right to seek recovery from the
    Company of those amounts actually paid, if any, by Lockheed Martin with
    regard to the Subject Plans after their return. In addition, upon the
<PAGE>
    occurrence of certain events, Lockheed Martin, at its option, will have
    the right to decide whether to assume sponsorship of any or all of the
    Subject Plans, even if the PBGC has not sought to terminate the Subject
    Plans.

         The Company believes, based in part upon discussions with its
    consulting actuaries, that the increase in pension expenses and future
    funding requirements, if any, from those currently anticipated for the
    Subject Plans would not be material.

    Employees

         As of March 31, 1997, the Company employed approximately 5,000
    full-time and part-time employees. The Company believes that its relations
    with its employees are good.

         Approximately 580 of the Company's employees at its Communication
    Systems -- Camden operation in Camden, New Jersey are represented by four
    unions, the Association of Scientists and Professional Engineering
    Personnel, the International Federation of Professional and Technical
    Engineers, the International Union of Electronic, Electrical, Salaried,
    Machine and Furniture Workers and an affiliate of the International
    Brotherhood of Teamsters. Three of the four collective bargaining
    agreements expire in mid-1998. While the Company has not yet initiated
    discussions with representatives of these unions, management believes it
    will be able to negotiate, without material disruption to its business,
    satisfactory new collective bargaining agreements with these employees.
    However, there can be no assurance that a satisfactory agreement will be
    reached with the covered employees or that a material disruption to the
    Company's Camden operations will not occur.
<PAGE>
                                 THE TRANSACTION

    The Acquisition

         Holdings and L-3 were formed by Mr. Frank C. Lanza, the former
    President and Chief Operating Officer of Loral, Mr. Robert V. LaPenta, the
    former Senior Vice President and Controller of Loral, the Lehman
    Partnership and Lockheed Martin to acquire substantially all of the assets
    and certain liabilities of (i) nine business units previously purchased by
    Lockheed Martin as part of its acquisition of Loral in April 1996 and
    (ii) one business unit, Communications Systems -- Camden, purchased by
    Lockheed Martin as part of its acquisition of GE Aerospace in April 1993.
    The total consideration paid to Lockheed Martin was $525 million,
    comprised of $480 million of cash before an estimated $20 million
    reduction related to a purchase price adjustment, and $45 million of
    common equity being retained by Lockheed Martin. L-3 is a wholly-owned
    subsidiary of Holdings. Holdings was capitalized with $125 million of
    common equity, with Messrs. Lanza and LaPenta owning 15.0%, the Lehman
    Partnership owning 50.1% and Lockheed Martin owning 34.9%.

    Transaction Agreement

         The Transaction Agreement provides for the transfer by Lockheed
    Martin to Holdings of substantially all of the assets and certain of the
    liabilities primarily related to the Businesses. The assets transferred
    include, among other things, real property and leases for the business
    units, all contracts including government contracts, and bids for such
    contracts, all machinery and equipment used primarily in connection with
    the Businesses and, subject to certain limitations, all intellectual
    property used primarily in the Businesses. The Transaction Agreement
    provides that L-3 be capitalized with $125 million of common entity
    provided by Holdings and assume the liabilities and obligations of
    Lockheed Martin relating to the Businesses other than certain income and
    franchise tax liabilities arising prior to the closing of the Acquisition,
    certain pension liabilities, certain environmental liabilities and certain
    other excluded liabilities. As consideration for the transfer of the
    assets by Lockheed Martin, Holdings paid Lockheed Martin $479.8 million
    (subject to adjustment based on the difference between $269.1 million and
    the audited combined net tangible assets (as defined in the Transaction
    Agreement) of the Businesses at the end of the month immediately preceding
    the Closing) and Holdings issued to Lockheed Martin 6,980,000 shares of
    its Class A Common Stock.

         The Transaction Agreement contains mutually agreed upon and
    customary representations, warranties and covenants. Lockheed Martin has
    agreed to indemnify Holdings, subject to certain limitations, for its
    breach of (i) non-environmental representations and warranties up to $50
    million (subject to a $5 million threshold) and (ii) for the first eight
    years following the Closing, to pay 50% of all costs incurred by the
    Company above those reserved for on the Company's balance sheet at Closing
    relating to certain Company-assumed environmental liabilities and, for the
    seven years thereafter, 40% of certain reasonable operation and
    maintenance costs relating to any environmental remediation projects
    undertaken in the first eight years (subject to a $6 million threshold).

         In connection with the Transaction Agreement, Holdings, the Company
    and Lockheed Martin have entered into a transition services agreement
<PAGE>
    pursuant to which Lockheed Martin will provide to Holdings and its
    subsidiaries (and Holdings will provide to Lockheed Martin) certain
    corporate services of a type currently provided at costs consistent with
    past practices until December 31, 1997 (or, in the case of Communication
    Systems -- Camden, for a period of up to 18 months after the Closing) and
    the parties also entered into supply agreements which reflect existing
    intercompany work transfer agreements or similar support arrangements upon
    prices and other terms consistent with the present arrangements. Holdings,
    the Company and Lockheed Martin have entered into certain subleases of
    real property and cross-licenses of intellectual property.

         In addition, Holdings and Lockheed Martin have entered into a
    non-competition agreement which, for up to three years, offers a measure
    of protection to Holdings' material core business while permitting
    Lockheed Martin to, among other things, continue its existing and
    currently planned businesses. Certain agreed upon actions included in the
    Transaction Agreement will be finalized after the Closing, including
    novating the Company's Government contracts, and making certain patent
    filings. The Company believes that such matters will be resolved
    satisfactorily, however, there can be no assurance as to the timing and/or
    terms of such final arrangements.

    Stockholders Agreement

         At Closing, Holdings, Lockheed Martin, the Lehman Partnership and
    Messrs. Lanza and LaPenta entered into a stockholders agreement (the
    "Stockholders Agreement") which, except for certain provisions including
    those granting registration rights, terminates upon the consummation of an
    initial public offering of equity securities by Holdings.

         The Stockholders Agreement provides that the Board of Directors will
    initially consist of 11 members including six designees of the Lehman
    Partnership, three designees of Lockheed Martin, and Messrs. Lanza and
    LaPenta. The number of directors which the Lehman Partnership and Lockheed
    Martin have the right to designate will be reduced in proportion to any
    reduction in their ownership of Common Stock, but as long as the Lehman
    Partnership continues to own at least 35% of the outstanding Common Stock
    and represents the largest single stockholder of Holdings, it may
    designate a majority of the members of the Board of Directors.

         Under the Stockholders Agreement Holdings is prohibited from
    commencing an initial public offering for one year after the Closing
    without the consent of each of the parties to the agreement. If an initial
    public offering has not occurred five years after the Closing, the Lehman
    Partnership and Lockheed Martin each have the right to require Holdings to
    consummate an initial public offering, provided that they and their
    permitted transferees own at least 50% of the Common Stock that they owned
    on the date of the Closing.

         The Stockholders Agreement restricts the transfer of shares of
    Common Stock by any party to the agreement for one year and requires that
    any shares transferred thereafter first be offered for sale to the other
    stockholders and Holdings. As to sales of shares by the Lehman Partnership
    that occur one year after the Closing and prior to the consummation of an
    initial public offering and that result in the Lehman Partnership no
    longer owning at least 35% of the issued and outstanding Common Stock,
<PAGE>
    (i) Messrs. Lanza and LaPenta are permitted to "tag along" (as well as
    Lockheed Martin, if either Lanza or LaPenta elects to "tag along") and
    (ii) the Lehman Partnership has the right to "drag along" Messrs. Lanza
    and LaPenta (and at the option of Lockheed Martin, Lockheed Martin may
    sell shares in such transaction). Under the Stockholders Agreement
    Lockheed Martin is subject to a standstill arrangement which generally
    prohibits any increase in its share ownership percentage over 34.9%.

         The Stockholders Agreement also provides that Lehman Brothers Inc.
    has the exclusive right to provide investment banking services to Holdings
    for the five-year period after the Closing (except that the exclusivity
    period is three years as to cash acquisitions undertaken by L-3). In the
    event that Lehman Brothers Inc. agrees to provide any investment banking
    services to L-3, it will be paid fees that are mutually agreed upon based
    on similar transactions and practices in the investment banking industry.
<PAGE>
                                    MANAGEMENT

    Directors and Executive Officers

         The following table provides information concerning the directors
    and executive officers of Holdings after giving effect to the Transaction.
    All directors hold office until the next annual meeting of the
    stockholders. All officers serve at the discretion of the Board of
    Directors.

                                                          
    Name                      Age                Position         
    ----------------------   ----   ----------------------------------------
    Frank C. Lanza            65    Chairman, Chief Executive Officer and
                                    Director
    Robert V. LaPenta         51    President, Chief Financial Officer and
                                    Director
    Michael T. Strianese      41    Vice President--Finance and Controller
    Christopher C. Cambria    39    Vice President--General Counsel and
                                    Secretary
    Robert F. Mehmel          34    Vice President--Planning and Assistant
                                    Secretary
    Jimmie V. Adams           60    Vice President--Washington D.C. Operations
    Robert RisCassi           61    Vice President--Washington D.C. Operations
    Steven J. Berger          40    Director
    David J. Brand            35    Director
    Alberto M. Finali         43    Director
    Eliot M. Fried            63    Director
    Robert B. Millard         46    Director
    Alan H. Washkowitz        56    Director
    Thomas A. Corcoran        53    Director
    Frank H. Menaker, Jr.     56    Director
    John E. Montague          42    Director


         Frank C. Lanza, Chairman and CEO. Mr. Lanza was Executive Vice
    President of Lockheed Martin and a member of Lockheed Martin's Executive
    Council and Board of Directors. Mr. Lanza was formerly President and COO
    of Lockheed Martin's C3I and Systems Integration Sector, which comprised
    many of the businesses acquired by Lockheed Martin from Loral in 1996. At
    the time of the Loral acquisition, Mr. Lanza was President and COO of
    Loral, a position he held since 1981. He joined Loral in 1972 as President
    of its largest division, Electronic Systems. His earlier experience was
    with Dalmo Victor and Philco Western Development Laboratory.

         Robert V. LaPenta, President and Chief Financial Officer. Mr.
    LaPenta was a Vice President of Lockheed Martin and was Vice President and
    Chief Financial Officer of Lockheed's C3I and Systems Integration Sector.
    Prior to Lockheed Martin's acquisition of Loral, he was Loral's Senior
    Vice President and Controller since 1981. He joined Loral in 1972 and was
    named Vice President and Controller of its largest division in 1974. He
    became Corporate Controller in 1978 and was named Vice President in 1979.

         Michael T. Strianese, Vice President--Finance and Controller. Mr.
    Strianese was Vice President and Controller of Lockheed Martin's C3I and
    Systems Integration Sector. From 1991 to the 1996 acquisition of Loral, he
<PAGE>
    was Director of Special Projects at Loral. Prior to joining Loral,
    he spent 11 years with Ernst & Young. Mr. Strianese is a Certified 
    Public Accountant.

         Christopher C. Cambria, Vice President--General Counsel and
    Secretary. Mr. Cambria joined Holdings in June 1997. From 1994
    until joining Holdings, Mr. Cambria was associated with Fried, 
    Frank, Harris, Shriver & Jacobson. From 1986 until 1993, he was 
    associated with Cravath, Swaine & Moore.

         Robert F. Mehmel, Vice President -- Planning and Assistant
    Secretary. Mr. Mehmel was the Director of Financial Planning and Capital
    Review for Lockheed Martin's C3I and Systems Integration Sector. From 1984
    to 1996, Mr. Mehmel held several accounting and financial analysis
    positions at Loral Electronic Systems and Loral. At the time of Lockheed
    Martin's acquisition of Loral, he was Corporate Manager of Business
    Analysis.

         Jimmie V. Adams, Vice President -- Washington, D.C.
    Operations. General Jimmie V. Adams (U.S.A.F.-ret.) was Vice President of
    Lockheed Martin's Washington Operations for the C3I and Systems
    Integration Sector. He held the same position at Loral and was an officer
    of Loral, prior to its acquisition by Lockheed Martin. Before joining
    Loral in 1993, he was Commander in Chief, Pacific Air Forces, Hickam Air
    Force Base, Hawaii, capping a 35-year career with the U.S. Air Force. He
    was also Deputy Chief of Staff for plans and operation for U.S. Air Force
    headquarters and Vice Commander of Headquarters Tactical Air Command and
    Vice Commander in Chief of the U.S. Air Forces Atlantic at Langley Air
    Force Base. He is a command pilot with more than 141 combat missions.

         Robert RisCassi, Vice President -- Washington, D.C.
    Operations. General Robert W. RisCassi, Vice President, Land Systems (U.S.
    Army-ret.) was Vice President of Land Systems for Lockheed Martin's C3I
    and Systems Integration Sector. He held the same position for Loral, prior
    to its acquisition by Lockheed Martin. He joined Loral in 1993 after
    retiring as U.S. Army Commander in Chief, United Nations Command/Korea.
    His 35-year military career included posts as Army Vice Chief of Staff;
    Director, Joint Staff, Joint Chiefs of Staff; Deputy Chief of Staff for
    Operations and Plans; and Commander of the Combined Arms Center.

         Steven J. Berger, Director. Mr. Berger is a Managing Director of
    Lehman Brothers, Co-Head of the Investment Banking Division and Head of
    the Merchant Banking Group. Mr. Berger joined Lehman Brothers in 1983 in
    the Investment Banking Division and spent the early part of his career
    working on principal investment, merger-related advisory and corporate
    finance transactions. Mr. Berger became a Managing Director and Head of
    European Investment Banking in 1991, Head of the Merchant Banking Group in
    1995 and Co-Head of the Investment Banking Division in 1996. Mr. Berger
    holds an M.B.A. and an A.B. Economics, with honors, from Harvard
    University.

         David J. Brand, Director. Mr. Brand is a Managing Director of Lehman
    Brothers and a principal in the Global Mergers & Acquisitions Group,
    leading Lehman Brothers' Technology Mergers and Acquisitions business. Mr.
    Brand joined Lehman Brothers in 1987 and has been responsible for merger
    and corporate finance advisory services for many of Lehman Brothers'
    technology and defense industry clients. Mr. Brand holds an M.B.A. from
<PAGE>
    Stanford University's Graduate School of Business and a B.S. in Mechanical
    Engineering from Boston University.

         Alberto M. Finali, Director. Mr. Finali is a Managing Director of
    Lehman Brothers and principal of the Merchant Banking Group, based in New
    York. Prior to joining the Merchant Banking Group Mr. Finali spent four
    years in Lehman Brothers' London office as a senior member of the M&A
    Group. Mr. Finali joined Lehman Brothers in 1987 as a member of the M&A
    Group in New York and became a Managing Director in 1997. Prior to joining
    Lehman Brothers, Mr. Finali worked in the Pipelines and Production
    Technology Group of Bechtel, Inc. in San Francisco. Mr. Finali holds an
    M.E. and an M.B.A. from the University of California at Berkeley, and a
    Laurea Degree in Civil Engineering from the Polytechnic School in Milan,
    Italy.

         Eliot M. Fried, Director. Mr. Fried is a Managing Director of Lehman
    Brothers. Mr. Fried joined Shearson, Hayden Stone, a predecessor firm, in
    1976 and became a Managing Director in 1982. Mr. Fried has extensive
    experience in portfolio management and equity research. Mr. Fried is
    currently a director of Bridgeport Machines, Inc., Energy Ventures, Inc.,
    SunSource L.P., Vernitron Corporation and Walter Industries, Inc. Mr.
    Fried holds an M.B.A. from Columbia University and a B.A. from Hobart
    College.

         Robert B. Millard, Director. Mr. Millard is a Managing Director of
    Lehman Brothers, Head of Lehman Brothers' Principal Trading & Investments
    Group and principal of the Merchant Banking Group. Mr. Millard joined Kuhn
    Loeb & Co. in 1976 and became a Managing Director of Lehman Brothers in
    1983. Mr. Millard is currently a director of GulfMark International, Inc.
    and Energy Ventures, Inc. Mr. Millard holds an M.B.A. from Harvard
    University and a B.S. from the Massachusetts Institute of Technology.

         Alan H. Washkowitz, Director. Mr. Washkowitz is a Managing Director
    of Lehman Brothers and principal of the Merchant Banking Group, and is
    responsible for the oversight of Lehman Brothers Merchant Banking
    Portfolio Partnership L.P. Mr. Washkowitz joined Lehman Brothers in 1978
    when Kuhn Loeb & Co. was acquired by Lehman Brothers. Mr. Washkowitz is
    currently a director of Illinois Central Corporation, K&F Industries,
    Inc., Lear Corporation and McBride plc. Mr. Washkowitz holds an M.B.A.
    from Harvard University, a J.D. from Columbia University and an A.B. from
    Brooklyn College.

         Thomas A. Corcoran, Director. Mr. Corcoran has been the President and 
    Chief Operating Officer of the Electronic Systems Sector of Lockheed Martin 
    Corporation since March 1995. From 1993 to 1995, Mr. Corcoran was President
    of the Electronics Group of Martin Marietta Corporation. Prior to that he 
    worked for General Electric for 26 years and from 1983 to 1993 he held 
    various management positions with GE Aerospace; he was a company officer 
    from 1990 to 1993. Mr. Corcoran is a member of the Board of Trustees of 
    Worcester Polytechnic Institute, the Board of Trustees of Stevens 
    Institute of Technology, the Board of Governors of the Electronic 
    Industries Association, a Director of the U.S. Navy Submarine League 
    and a Director of REMEC Corporation.

         Frank H. Menaker, Jr., Director. Mr. Menaker has served as Senior
    Vice President and General Counsel of Lockheed Martin since July 1996. He
    served as Vice President and General Counsel of Lockheed Martin from March
<PAGE>
    1995 to July 1996, as Vice President of Martin Marietta Corporation from
    1982 until 1995 and as General Counsel of Martin Marietta Corporation from
    1981 until 1995. He is a director of Martin Marietta Materials, Inc., a
    member of the American Bar Association and has been admitted to practice
    before the United States Supreme Court. Mr. Menaker is a graduate of
    Wilkes University and the Washington College of Law at American
    University.

         John E. Montague, Director. Mr. Montague has been Vice President,
    Financial Strategies at Lockheed Martin responsible for mergers,
    acquisitions and divestiture activities and shareholder value strategies
    since March, 1995. Previously, he was Vice President, Corporate
    Development and Investor Relations at Martin Marietta Corporation from
    1991 to 1995. From 1988 to 1991, he was Director of Corporate Development
    at Martin Marietta Corporation, which he joined in 1977 as a member of the
    engineering staff. Mr. Montague is a director of Rational Software
    Corporation. Mr. Montague received his B.S. from the Georgia Institute of
    Technology and a M.S. in engineering from the University of Colorado.

    Director Compensation and Arrangements

         It is not currently contemplated that the directors of Holdings or
    the Company will receive compensation for their services as directors.
    Members of the Board of Directors will be elected pursuant to certain
    voting agreements outlined in the Stockholders Agreement. See "The
    Transaction--Stockholders Agreement".

    Executive Compensation

         Benefit Plans

         Holdings and the Company intend to establish benefit plans, which
    will provide substantially similar benefits to those provided by Lockheed
    Martin, including a pension plan, a nonqualified supplemental retirement
    plan, a defined contribution plan, a severance plan and a death benefit
    plan.

         Management Incentive Compensation Plans

         Holdings and the Company will establish an incentive compensation
    plan that will provide a bonus to selected employees based on the
    participant's base salary, target level, individual performance rating and
    organizational performance rating and a plan that will allow key
    management employees with base salaries of at least $80,000 to defer
    receipt of awards under the incentive compensation plan that exceed
    $10,000.

         Stock Option Plan

         Holdings sponsors an option plan (the "Option Plan") for key
    employees of Holdings and its subsidiaries, pursuant to which options to
    purchase an aggregate of 12.5% of Holdings' fully-diluted Common Stock
    outstanding at Closing will be granted (inclusive of the grants to Messrs.
    Lanza and LaPenta, see below under "--Employment Agreements"). The
    compensation committee of the Board of Directors of Holdings, in its sole
    discretion, determines the terms of option agreements, including without
    limitation the treatment of option grants in the event of a change of
    control.
<PAGE>
         Employment Agreements

         Holdings entered into an employment agreement (the "Employment
    Agreements") with each of Mr. Lanza, who will serve as Chairman and Chief
    Executive Officer of the Company and Holdings and will receive a base
    salary of $750,000 per annum and appropriate executive level benefits, and
    Mr. LaPenta, who will serve as President and Chief Financial Officer of
    Holdings and the Company and will receive a base salary of $500,000 per
    annum and appropriate executive level benefits. The Employment Agreements
    provide for an initial term of five years, which will automatically renew
    for one-year periods thereafter, unless a party thereto gives notice of
    its intent to terminate at least 90 days prior to the expiration of the
    term. Upon a termination without cause (as defined) or resignation for
    good reason (as defined), Holdings will be obligated, through the end of
    the term, to (i) continue to pay the base salary and (ii) continue to
    provide life insurance and medical and hospitalization benefits comparable
    to those provided to other senior executives; provided, however, that any
    such coverage shall terminate to the extent that Mr. Lanza or Mr. LaPenta,
    as the case may be, is offered or obtains comparable benefits coverage
    from any other employer. The Employment Agreements provide for
    confidentiality during employment and at all times thereafter. There is
    also a noncompetition and non-solicitation covenant which is effective
    during the employment term and for one year thereafter; provided, however,
    that if the employment terminates following the expiration of the initial
    term, the noncompetition covenant will only be effective during the
    period, if any, that Holdings pays the severance described above.

         Holdings has granted each of Messrs. Lanza and LaPenta
    (collectively, the "Equity Executives") nonqualified options to purchase,
    at $6.47 per share of Class A Common Stock, 5% of Holdings' initial
    fully-diluted common stock. In each case, half of the options will be
    "Time Options" and half will be "Performance Options" (collectively, the
    "Options"). The Time Options will become exercisable with respect to 20%
    of the shares subject to the Time Options on each of the first five
    anniversaries of the Closing if employment continues through and including
    such date. The Performance Options will become exercisable nine years
    after the Closing, but will become exercisable earlier with respect to up
    to 20% of the shares subject to the Performance Options on each of the
    first five anniversaries of the Closing, to the extent certain EBITDA
    targets are achieved. The Options will become fully exercisable under
    certain circumstances, including a change in control. The Option term is
    ten years from the Closing; except that (i) if the Equity Executive is
    fired for cause or resigns without good reason, the Options expire upon
    termination of employment; (ii) if the Equity Executive is fired without
    cause, resigns for good reason, dies, becomes disabled or retires, the
    Options expire one year after termination of employment. Unexercisable
    Options will terminate upon termination of employment, unless acceleration
    is expressly provided for. Upon a change of control, Holdings may
    terminate the Options, so long as the Equity Executives are cashed out or
    permitted to exercise their Options prior to such change of control.

         Puts/Calls. In the event that an Equity Executive (i) is terminated
    without cause, (ii) resigns with good reason or (iii) retires
    (collectively, a "Good Termination"), the Equity Executive will have the
    right to require Holdings to, and Holdings will have the right to,
    purchase at the fair market value per share a number of (A) shares
    purchased upon exercise of Options ("Option Shares") and (B) Class B
<PAGE>
    Common Stock purchased at Closing ("Purchased Shares", and collectively
    with the Option Shares, the "Equity Shares") equal to the product of
    (1) the total number of Equity Shares held and (2) the Put/Call
    Percentage. The "Put/Call Percentage" will equal 75% at any time prior to
    the first anniversary of the Closing and will be reduced by 15% on each
    anniversary of the Closing thereafter. In addition, in the event of a Good
    Termination, the Equity Executive will have the right to require Holdings
    to, and Holdings will have the right to, purchase, at the fair market
    value per share less the exercise price per share, the number of shares
    subject to exercisable Options in an amount equal to the product of
    (i) the total number of shares subject to exercisable Options held and
    (ii) the Put/Call Percentage.

         Following the termination of an Equity Executive's employment due to
    death or disability, the Equity Executive will have the right to require
    Holdings to, and Holdings will have the right to, purchase all of (i) the
    Equity Shares held by the Equity Executive at a per share price equal to
    the fair market value per share and (ii) the shares subject to Options
    held by the Equity Executive at the fair market value per share less the
    exercise price per share. Notwithstanding the foregoing, in the event of
    the Equity Executive's death, the Equity Executive's estate will have the
    right to retain 20% of the Purchased Shares.

         In the event that an Equity Executive is terminated with cause or
    quits without good reason (a "Bad Termination"), Holdings will have the
    right to purchase any (i) Option Shares at the lesser of (A) the Equity
    Executive's cost and (B) fair market value and (ii) Purchased Shares at
    the lesser of (A) the Equity Executive's cost plus interest and (B) fair
    market value. In addition, in the event of a Bad Termination all Options
    will terminate without payment. The Equity Executive will not have the
    right to put the Equity Shares to Holdings in the event of a Bad
    Termination.

         Notwithstanding the above, Holdings will not be required to purchase
    for cash any Equity Shares or shares subject to Options if such purchase
    would be or would result in a violation of the terms of its debt
    agreements or applicable statutes. In addition, no such purchase for cash
    will occur if in the reasonable opinion of the Board of Directors of
    Holdings (excluding the Equity Executives) such purchase would be
    reasonably likely to materially impact Holdings's available cash, require
    unsuitable additional debt to be incurred or otherwise have a material
    adverse effect on the financial condition of Holdings. If Holdings is
    unable to purchase any Equity Shares or shares subject to Options for cash
    due to any of the above reasons, Holdings will issue a subordinated note
    in the appropriate principal amount to the Equity Executive or his estate,
    as the case may be.
<PAGE>
                            OWNERSHIP OF CAPITAL STOCK

         All of the outstanding capital stock of the Company is held by
    Holdings. Class A Common Stock of Holdings ("Class A Common Stock")
    possesses full voting rights and Class B Common Stock of Holdings ("Class
    B Common Stock") and Class C Common Stock of Holdings ("Class C Common
    Stock and, together with Class A Common Stock and Class B Common Stock,
    "Common Stock") possess no voting rights except as otherwise required by
    law. Each share of Class B Common Stock will convert into a share of Class
    A Common Stock upon consummation of an initial public offering of equity
    securities of Holdings and certain other events and will convert into a
    share of Class C Common Stock upon certain other events. As of the
    Closing, there were 17,000,000 shares of Class A Common Stock and
    3,000,000 shares of Class B Common Stock outstanding. The following table
    sets forth certain information regarding the beneficial ownership of the
    shares of the Common Stock of Holdings, upon consummation of the
    Transaction, by each person who beneficially owns more than five percent
    the outstanding shares of Common Stock of Holdings and by the directors
    and certain executive officers of the Company, individually and as a
    group.

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                                                  Percentage
                                                                          Class A              Class B           Ownership of
                  Name of Beneficial Owner                             Common Stock          Common Stock        Common Stock
    -------------------------------------------------------------- -------------------   -------------------  -------------------
<S>                                                                <C>                   <C>                  <C>

    Lehman Brothers Capital Partners III, L.P. and affiliates
     c/o Lehman Brothers Inc.
     Three World Financial Center
     New York, New York 10285   . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .       10,020,000                   --                50.1%
    Lockheed Martin Corporation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .        6,980,000                   --                34.9
    Frank C. Lanza  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .               --            1,500,000                 7.5
    Robert V. LaPenta . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .               --            1,500,000                 7.5
    All directors and executive officers as group (15 persons)  .               --            3,000,000                15.0

</TABLE>


                     DESCRIPTION OF SENIOR CREDIT FACILITIES

         The Senior Credit Facilities have been provided by a syndicate of
    banks and other financial institutions led by Lehman Commercial Paper
    Inc., as Arranger and Syndication Agent. The Senior Credit Facilities
    provide for $175.0 million in term loans (the "Term Loan Facilities") and
    for $100.0 million in revolving credit loans (the "Revolving Credit
    Facility"). The Revolving Credit Facility includes borrowing capacity
    available for letters of credit and for borrowings on same-day notice (the
    "Swingline Loans"). The Term Loans are comprised of a Tranche A Term Loan
    ($100.0 million), which have a maturity of six years, a Tranche B Term
    Loan ($45.0 million), which have a maturity of eight years, and a Tranche
    C Term Loan ($30.0 million), which have a maturity of nine years. The
    Revolving Credit Facility commitment terminates six years after the date
    of initial funding of the Senior Credit Facilities.
<PAGE>
         All borrowings under the Senior Credit Facilities bear interest, at
    the Company's option, at either: (A) a "base rate" equal to, for any day,
    the higher of: (a) 0.50% per annum above the latest Federal Funds Rate;
    and (b) the rate of interest in effect for such day as publicly announced
    from time to time by Bank of America NT&SA, as Administrative Agent, in
    San Francisco, California, as its "reference rate" plus (i) in the case of
    the Tranche A Term Loan, the Revolving Credit Facility and the Swingline
    Loans, a debt to EBITDA-dependent rate ranging from 0.50% to 1.25% per
    annum, (ii) in the case of the Tranche B Term Loan, a rate of 1.50% per
    annum or (iii) in the case of the Tranche C Term Loan, a rate of 1.75% per
    annum or (B) a "LIBOR rate" equal to, for any Interest Period (as defined
    in the Senior Credit Facilities), with respect to LIBOR Loans comprising
    part of the same borrowing, the London interbank offered rate of interest
    per annum for such Interest Period as determined by the Administrative
    Agent, plus (i) in the case of the Tranche A Term Loan and the Revolving
    Credit Facility, a debt to EBITDA-dependent rate ranging from 1.50% to
    2.25% per annum, (ii) in the case of the Tranche B Term Loan, a rate of
    2.50% per annum or (iii) in the case of the Tranche C Term Loan, a rate of
    2.75% per annum.

         The Company will pay a commitment fee calculated at a debt to
    EBITDA-dependent rate ranging from 0.375% to 0.50% per annum of the
    available unused commitment under the Revolving Credit Facility, in each
    case in effect on each day. Such fee will be payable quarterly in arrears
    and upon termination of the Revolving Credit Facility.

         The Company will pay a letter of credit fee calculated at a debt to
    EBITDA-dependent rate ranging from 1.50% to 2.25% per annum of the face
    amount of each letter of credit and a fronting fee calculated at a rate
    equal to 0.125% per annum of the face amount of each letter of credit.
    Such fees will be payable quarterly in arrears and upon the termination of
    the Revolving Credit Facility. In addition, the Company will pay customary
    transaction charges in connection with any letters of credit.

         The foregoing debt to EBITDA-dependent rates range from the low rate
    specified if the ratio of debt to EBITDA is less than 3.75 to 1.0 to the
    high rate specified if such ratio is at least equal to 4.75 to 1.0.

         The Term Loans are subject to the following amortization schedule:

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                      Tranche A Term Loan        Tranche B Term Loan         Tranche C Term Loan
                                                  -------------------------   -------------------------  -------------------------
<S>                                               <C>                         <C>                        <C>

    Year 1  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .         $ 4,000,000                 $   500,000                 $   500,000
    Year 2  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .           5,000,000                     500,000                     500,000
    Year 3  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .          15,000,000                     500,000                     500,000
    Year 4  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .          21,000,000                     500,000                     500,000
    Year 5  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .          27,000,000                     500,000                     500,000
    Year 6  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .          28,000,000                     500,000                     500,000
    Year 7  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                  --                  20,000,000                     500,000
    Year 8  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                  --                  22,000,000                     500,000
    Year 9  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                  --                          --                  26,000,000

</TABLE>
<PAGE>
         Borrowings under the Senior Credit Facilities is subject to
    mandatory prepayment (i) with the net proceeds of any incurrence of
    indebtedness with certain exceptions to be agreed, (ii) with the proceeds
    of certain asset sales and (iii) on an annual basis with (A) 75% of the
    Company's excess cash flow (as defined in the Senior Credit Facilities) if
    the ratio of the Company's debt to EBITDA is greater than 3.5 to 1.0 or
    (B) 50% of such excess cash flow if the ratio is less than 3.5 to 1.0.

         The Company's obligations under the Senior Credit Facilities is
    secured by a lien on substantially all of the tangible and intangible
    assets of Holdings, the Company, and their direct and indirect
    subsidiaries, including: (i) a pledge by Holdings of the stock of the
    Company and (ii) a pledge by the Company and its direct and indirect
    subsidiaries of all of the stock of their respective domestic subsidiaries
    and 65% of the stock of the Company's first-tier foreign subsidiaries. In
    addition, indebtedness under the Senior Credit Facilities is guaranteed by
    Holdings and by all of the Company's direct and indirect domestic
    subsidiaries. See "Description of the Exchange Notes--Subordination",
    "Risk Factors--Subordination".

         The Senior Credit Facilities contain customary covenants and
    restrictions on the Company's ability to engage in certain activities. In
    addition, the Senior Credit Facilities provide that the Company must meet
    or exceed certain interest coverage ratios and must not exceed a leverage
    ratio. The Senior Credit Facilities also include customary events of
    default.
<PAGE>
                                THE EXCHANGE OFFER

    General

         The Company hereby offers, upon the terms and subject to the
    conditions set forth in this Prospectus and in the accompanying Letter of
    Transmittal (which together constitute the Exchange Offer), to exchange up
    to $225 million aggregate principal amount of Exchange Notes for a like
    aggregate principal amount of Old Notes properly tendered on or prior to
    the Expiration Date and not withdrawn as permitted pursuant to the
    procedures described below. The Exchange Offer is being made with respect
    to all of the Old Notes. 

         As of the date of this Prospectus, $225 million aggregate principal
    amount of the Old Notes is outstanding. This Prospectus, together with the
    Letter of Transmittal, is first being sent on or about       , 1997, to
    all holders of Old Notes known to the Company. The Company's obligation
    to accept Old Notes for exchange pursuant to the Exchange Offer is subject
    to certain conditions set forth under "Certain Conditions to the Exchange
    Offer" below. The Company currently expects that each of the conditions
    will be satisfied and that no waivers will be necessary. 

    Purpose of the Exchange Offer

         The Old Notes were issued on April 30, 1997 in a transaction exempt
    from the registration requirements of the Securities Act. Accordingly, the
    Old Notes may not be reoffered, resold, or otherwise transferred unless so
    registered or unless an applicable exemption from the registration and
    prospectus delivery requirements of the Securities Act is available. 

         In connection with the issuance and sale of the Old Notes, the
    Company entered into the Registration Rights Agreement, which requires the
    Company to file with the Commission a registration statement relating to
    the Exchange Offer not later than 90 days after the date of issuance of
    the Old Notes, and to use its best efforts to cause the registration
    statement relating to the Exchange Offer to become effective under the
    Securities Act not later than 150 days after the date of issuance of the
    Old Notes and the Exchange Offer to be consummated not later than 30 days
    after the date of the effectiveness of the Registration Statement (or use
    its best efforts to cause to become effective by the 180th calendar day
    after the Issuance Date (as defined) a shelf registration statement with
    respect to resales of the Old Notes). A copy of the Registration Rights
    Agreement has been filed as an exhibit to the Registration Statement. 

         The Exchange Offer is being made by the Company to satisfy its
    obligations with respect to the Registration Rights Agreement. The term
    "holder," with respect to the Exchange Offer, means any person in whose
    name Old Notes are registered on the books of the Company or any other
    person who has obtained a properly completed bond power from the
    registered holder, or any person whose Old Notes are held of record by The
    Depository Trust Company. Other than pursuant to the Registration Rights
    Agreement, the Company is not required to file any registration statement
    to register any outstanding Old Notes. Holders of Old Notes who do not
    tender their Old Notes or whose Old Notes are tendered but not accepted
    would have to rely on exemptions to registration requirements under the
    securities laws, including the Securities Act, if they wish to sell their
    Old Notes. 
<PAGE>
         The Company is making the Exchange Offer in reliance on the position
    of the staff of the Commission as set forth in certain interpretive
    letters addressed to third parties in other transactions. However, the
    Company has not sought its own interpretive letter and there can be no
    assurance that the staff would make a similar determination with respect
    to the Exchange Offer as it has in such interpretive letters to third
    parties. Based on these interpretations by the Staff, the Company believes
    that the Exchange Notes issued pursuant to the Exchange Offer in exchange
    for Old Notes may be offered for resale, resold and otherwise transferred
    by a Holder (other than any Holder who is a broker-dealer or an
    "affiliate" of the Company within the meaning of Rule 405 of the
    Securities Act) without further compliance with the registration and
    prospectus delivery requirements of the Securities Act, provided that such
    Exchange Notes are acquired in the ordinary course of such Holder's
    business and that such Holder is not participating, and has no arrangement
    or understanding with any person to participate, in a distribution (within
    the meaning of the Securities Act) of such Exchange Notes. See "--Resale
    of Exchange Notes". Each broker-dealer that receives Exchange Notes for
    its own account in exchange for Old Notes, where such Old Notes were
    acquired by such broker-dealer as a result of market-making activities or
    other trading activities, must acknowledge that it will deliver a
    prospectus in connection with any resale of such Exchange Notes. See "Plan
    of Distribution".

    Terms of the Exchange

         The Company hereby offers to exchange, subject to the conditions set
    forth herein and in the Letter of Transmittal accompanying this
    Prospectus, $1,000 in principal amount of Exchange Notes for each $1,000
    in principal amount of the Old Notes. The terms of the Exchange Notes are
    identical in all material respects to the terms of the Old Notes for which
    they may be exchanged pursuant to this Exchange Offer, except that the
    Exchange Notes will generally be freely transferable by holders thereof
    and will not be subject to any covenant regarding registration. The
    Exchange Notes will evidence the same indebtedness as the Old Notes and
    will be entitled to the benefits of the Indenture. See "Description of
    Exchange Notes". 

         The Exchange Offer is not conditioned upon any minimum aggregate
    principal amount of Old Notes being tendered for exchange. 

         The Company has not requested, and does not intend to request, an
    interpretation by the staff of the Commission with respect to whether the
    Exchange Notes issued pursuant to the Exchange Offer in exchange for the
    Old Notes may be offered for sale, resold or otherwise transferred by any
    holder without compliance with the registration and prospectus delivery
    provisions of the Securities Act. Instead, based on an interpretation by
    the staff of the Commission set forth in a series of no-action letters
    issued to third parties, the Company believes that Exchange Notes issued
    pursuant to the Exchange Offer in exchange for Old Notes may be offered
    for sale, resold and otherwise transferred by any holder of such Exchange
    Notes (other than any such holder that is a broker-dealer or is an
    "affiliate" of the Company within the meaning of Rule 405 under the
    Securities Act) without compliance with the registration and prospectus
    delivery provisions of the Securities Act, provided that such Exchange
    Notes are acquired in the ordinary course of such holder's business and
<PAGE>
    such holder has no arrangement or understanding with any person to
    participate in the distribution of such Exchange Notes and neither such
    holder nor any other such person is engaging in or intends to engage in a
    distribution of such Exchange Notes. Since the Commission has not
    considered the Exchange Offer in the context of a no-action letter, there
    can be no assurance that the staff of the Commission would make a similar
    determination with respect to the Exchange Offer. Any holder who is an
    affiliate of the Company or who tenders in the Exchange Offer for the
    purpose of participating in a distribution of the Exchange Notes cannot
    rely on such interpretation by the staff of the Commission and must comply
    with the registration and prospectus delivery requirements of the
    Securities Act in connection with any resale transaction. Each holder,
    other than a broker-dealer, must acknowledge that it is not engaged in,
    and does not intend to engage in, a distribution of Exchange Notes. Each
    broker-dealer that receives Exchange Notes for its own account in exchange
    for Old Notes, where such Old Notes were acquired by such broker-dealer as
    a result of market-making activities or other trading activities, must
    acknowledge that it will deliver a prospectus in connection with any
    resale of such Exchange Notes. See "Plan of Distribution". 

         Interest on the Exchange Notes will accrue from the last Interest
    Payment Date on which interest was paid on the Old Notes so surrendered
    or, if no interest has been paid on such Notes, from April 30, 1997.

         Tendering holders of the Old Notes shall not be required to pay
    brokerage commissions or fees or, subject to the instructions in the
    Letter of Transmittal, transfer taxes with respect to the exchange of the
    Old Notes pursuant to the Exchange Offer. 


    Expiration Date; Extension; Termination; Amendment

         The Exchange Offer will expire at 5:00 p.m., New York City time, on
    __________, 1997, unless the Company, in its sole discretion, has extended
    the period of time for which the Exchange Offer is open (such date, as it
    may be extended, is referred to herein as the "Expiration Date"). The
    Expiration Date will be at least 20 business days after the commencement
    of the Exchange Offer in accordance with Rule 14e-1(a) under the Exchange
    Act. The Company expressly reserves the right, at any time or from time to
    time, to extend the period of time during which the Exchange Offer is
    open, and thereby delay acceptance for exchange of any Old Notes, by
    giving oral or written notice to the Exchange Agent and by timely public
    announcement no later than 9:00 a.m. New York City time, on the next
    business day after the previously scheduled Expiration Date. During any
    such extension, all Old Notes previously tendered will remain subject to
    the Exchange Offer unless properly withdrawn. 

         The Company expressly reserves the right to (i) terminate or amend
    the Exchange Offer and not to accept for exchange any Old Notes not
    theretofore accepted for exchange upon the occurrence of any of the events
    specified below under "Certain Conditions to the Exchange Offer" which
    have not been waived by the Company and (ii) amend the terms of the
    Exchange Offer in any manner which, in its good faith judgment, is
    advantageous to the holders of the Old Notes, whether before or after any
    tender of the Notes. If any such termination or amendment occurs, the
<PAGE>
    Company will notify the Exchange Agent and will either issue a press
    release or give oral or written notice to the holders of the Old Notes as
    promptly as practicable. 

         For purposes of the Exchange Offer, a "business day" means any day
    other than Saturday, Sunday or a date on which banking institutions are
    required or authorized by New York State law to be closed, and consists of
    the time period from 12:01 a.m. through 12:00 midnight, New York City
    time. Unless the Company terminates the Exchange Offer prior to 5:00 p.m.,
    New York City time, on the Expiration Date, the Company will exchange the
    Exchange Notes for the Old Notes on the Exchange Date. 

    Procedures for Tendering Old Notes

         The tender to the Company of Old Notes by a holder thereof as set
    forth below and the acceptance thereof by the Company will constitute a
    binding agreement between the tendering holder and the Company upon the
    terms and subject to the conditions set forth in this Prospectus and in
    the accompanying Letter of Transmittal. 

         A holder of Old Notes may tender the same by (i) properly completing
    and signing the Letter of Transmittal or a facsimile thereof (all
    references in this Prospectus to the Letter of Transmittal shall be deemed
    to include a facsimile thereof) and delivering the same, together with the
    certificate or certificates representing the Old Notes being tendered and
    any required signature guarantees and any other documents required by the
    Letter of Transmittal, to the Exchange Agent at its address set forth
    below on or prior to the Expiration Date (or complying with the procedure
    for book-entry transfer described below) or (ii) complying with the
    guaranteed delivery procedures described below. 

         The method of delivery of Old Notes, Letters of Transmittal and all
    other required documents is at the election and risk of the holders. If
    such delivery is by mail, it is recommended that registered mail properly
    insured, with return receipt requested, be used. In all cases, sufficient
    time should be allowed to insure timely delivery. No Old Notes or Letters
    of Transmittal should be sent to the Company. 

         If tendered Old Notes are registered in the name of the signer of
    the Letter of Transmittal and the Exchange Notes to be issued in exchange
    therefor are to be issued (and any untendered Old Notes are to be
    reissued) in the name of the registered holder (which term, for the
    purposes described herein, shall include any participant in The Depository
    Trust Company (also referred to as a "book-entry transfer facility") whose
    name appears on a security listing as the owner of Old Notes), the
    signature of such signer need not be guaranteed. In any other case, the
    tendered Old Notes must be endorsed or accompanied by written instruments
    of transfer in form satisfactory to the Company and duly executed by the
    registered holder, and the signature on the endorsement or instrument of
    transfer must be guaranteed by a bank, broker, dealer, credit union,
    savings association, clearing agency or other institution (each an
    "Eligible Institution") that is a member of a recognized signature
    guarantee medallion program within the meaning of Rule 17Ad-15 under the
    Exchange Act. If the Exchange Notes and/or Old Notes not exchanged are to
    be delivered to an address other than that of the registered holder
    appearing on the note register for the Old Notes, the signature in the
    Letter of Transmittal must be guaranteed by an Eligible Institution. 
<PAGE>
         The Exchange Agent will make a request within two business days
    after the date of receipt of this Prospectus to establish accounts with
    respect to the Old Notes at the book-entry transfer facility for the
    purpose of facilitating the Exchange Offer, and subject to the
    establishment thereof, any financial institution that is a participant in
    the book-entry transfer facility's system may make book-entry delivery of
    Old Notes by causing such book-entry transfer facility to transfer such
    Old Notes into the Exchange Agent's account with respect to the Old Notes
    in accordance with the book-entry transfer facility's procedures for such
    transfer. Although delivery of Old Notes may be effected through
    book-entry transfer into the Exchange Agent's account at the book-entry
    transfer facility, an appropriate Letter of Transmittal with any required
    signature guarantee and all other required documents must in each case be
    transmitted to and received or confirmed by the Exchange Agent at its
    address set forth below on or prior to the Expiration Date, or, if the
    guaranteed delivery procedures described below are complied with, within
    the time period provided under such procedures. 

         If a holder desires to accept the Exchange Offer and time will not
    permit a Letter of Transmittal or Old Notes to reach the Exchange Agent
    before the Expiration Date or the procedure for book-entry transfer cannot
    be completed on a timely basis, a tender may be effected if the Exchange
    Agent has received at its address set forth below on or prior to the
    Expiration Date, a letter, telegram or facsimile transmission (receipt
    confirmed by telephone and an original delivered by guaranteed overnight
    courier) from an Eligible Institution setting forth the name and address
    of the tendering holder, the names in which the Old Notes are registered
    and, if possible, the certificate numbers of the Old Notes to be tendered,
    and stating that the tender is being made thereby and guaranteeing that
    within three business days after the Expiration Date, the Old Notes in
    proper form for transfer (or a confirmation of book-entry transfer of such
    Old Notes into the Exchange Agent's account at the book-entry transfer
    facility), will be delivered by such Eligible Institution together with a
    properly completed and duly executed Letter of Transmittal (and any other
    required documents). Unless Old Notes being tendered by the
    above-described method are deposited with the Exchange Agent within the
    time period set forth above (accompanied or preceded by a properly
    completed Letter of Transmittal and any other required documents), the
    Company may, at its option, reject the tender. Copies of the notice of
    guaranteed delivery ("Notice of Guaranteed Delivery") which may be used by
    Eligible Institutions for the purposes described in this paragraph are
    available from the Exchange Agent. 

         A tender will be deemed to have been received as of the date when
    (i) the tendering holder's properly completed and duly signed Letter of
    Transmittal accompanied by the Old Notes (or a confirmation of book-entry
    transfer of such Old Notes into the Exchange Agent's account at the
    book-entry transfer facility) is received by the Exchange Agent, or (ii) a
    Notice of Guaranteed Delivery or letter, telegram or facsimile
    transmission to similar effect (as provided above) from an Eligible
    Institution is received by the Exchange Agent. Issuances of Exchange Notes
    in exchange for Old Notes tendered pursuant to a Notice of Guaranteed
    Delivery or letter, telegram or facsimile transmission to similar effect
    (as provided above) by an Eligible Institution will be made only against
    deposit of the Letter of Transmittal (and any other required documents)
    and the tendered Old Notes. 
<PAGE>
         All questions as to the validity, form, eligibility (including time
    of receipt) and acceptance of Old Notes tendered for exchange will be
    determined by the Company in its sole discretion, which determination
    shall be final and binding. The Company reserves the absolute right to
    reject any and all tenders of any particular Old Notes not properly
    tendered or not to accept any particular Old Notes which acceptance might,
    in the judgment of the Company or its counsel, be unlawful. The Company
    also reserves the absolute right to waive any defects or irregularities or
    conditions of the Exchange Offer as to any particular Old Notes either
    before or after the Expiration Date (including the right to waive the
    ineligibility of any holder who seeks to tender Old Notes in the Exchange
    Offer). The interpretation of the terms and conditions of the Exchange
    Offer (including the Letter of Transmittal and the instructions thereto)
    by the Company shall be final and binding on all parties. Unless waived,
    any defects or irregularities in connection with tenders of Old Notes for
    exchange must be cured within such reasonable period of time as the
    Company shall determine. Neither the Company, the Exchange Agent nor any
    other person shall be under any duty to give notification of any defect or
    irregularity with respect to any tender of Old Notes for exchange, nor
    shall any of them incur any liability for failure to give such
    notification. 

         If the Letter of Transmittal is signed by a person or persons other
    than the registered holder or holders of Old Notes, such Old Notes must be
    endorsed or accompanied by appropriate powers of attorney, in either case
    signed exactly as the name or names of the registered holder or holders
    appear on the Old Notes. 

         If the Letter of Transmittal or any Old Notes or powers of attorney
    are signed by trustees, executors, administrators, guardians,
    attorneys-in-fact, officers of corporations or others acting in a
    fiduciary or representative capacity, such persons should so indicate when
    signing, and, unless waived by the Company, proper evidence satisfactory
    to the Company of their authority to so act must be submitted. 

         By tendering, each holder will represent to the Company that, among
    other things, the Exchange Notes acquired pursuant to the Exchange Offer
    are being acquired in the ordinary course of business of the person
    receiving such Exchange Notes, whether or not such person is the holder,
    that neither the holder nor any such other person has an arrangement or
    understanding with any person to participate in the distribution of such
    Exchange Notes and that neither the holder nor any such other person is an
    "affiliate," as defined under Rule 405 of the Securities Act, of the
    Company, or if it is an affiliate it will comply with the registration and
    prospectus requirements of the Securities Act to the extent applicable. 

         Each broker-dealer that receives Exchange Notes for its own account
    in exchange for Old Notes where such Old Notes were acquired by such
    broker-dealer as a result of market-making activities or other trading
    activities must acknowledge that it will deliver a prospectus in
    connection with any resale of such Exchange Notes. See "Plan of
    Distribution." 

    Terms and Conditions of the Letter of Transmittal

         The Letter of Transmittal contains, among other things, the
    following terms and conditions, which are part of the Exchange Offer. 
<PAGE>
         The party tendering Notes for exchange (the "Transferor") exchanges,
    assigns and transfers the Old Notes to the Company and irrevocably
    constitutes and appoints the Exchange Agent as the Transferor's agent and
    attorney-in-fact to cause the Old Notes to be assigned, transferred and
    exchanged. The Transferor represents and warrants that it has full power
    and authority to tender, exchange, assign and transfer the Old Notes and
    to acquire Exchange Notes issuable upon the exchange of such tendered
    Notes, and that, when the same are accepted for exchange, the Company will
    acquire good and unencumbered title to the tendered Old Notes, free and
    clear of all liens, restrictions, charges and encumbrances and not subject
    to any adverse claim. The Transferor also warrants that it will, upon
    request, execute and deliver any additional documents deemed by the
    Exchange Agent or the Company to be necessary or desirable to complete the
    exchange, assignment and transfer of tendered Old Notes or transfer
    ownership of such Old Notes on the account books maintained by a
    book-entry transfer facility. The Transferor further agrees that
    acceptance of any tendered Old Notes by the Company and the issuance of
    Exchange Notes in exchange therefor shall constitute performance in full
    by the Company of certain of its obligations under the Registration Rights
    Agreement. All authority conferred by the Transferor will survive the
    death or incapacity of the Transferor and every obligation of the
    Transferor shall be binding upon the heirs, legal representatives,
    successors, assigns, executors and administrators of such Transferor. 

         The Transferor certifies that it is not an "affiliate" of the
    Company within the meaning of Rule 405 under the Securities Act and that
    it is acquiring the Exchange Notes offered hereby in the ordinary course
    of such Transferor's business and that such Transferor has no arrangement
    with any person to participate in the distribution of such Exchange Notes.
    Each holder, other than a broker-dealer, must acknowledge that it is not
    engaged in, and does not intend to engage in, a distribution of Exchange
    Notes. Each Transferor which is a broker-dealer receiving Exchange Notes
    for its own account must acknowledge that it will deliver a prospectus in
    connection with any resale of such Exchange Notes. By so acknowledging and
    by delivering a prospectus, a broker-dealer will not be deemed to admit
    that it is an "underwriter" within the meaning of the Securities Act. In
    connection with the offering of the Old Notes, the Company agreed to file
    and maintain, subject to certain limitations, a registration statement
    that would allow Lehman Brothers Inc. to engage in market-making
    transactions with respect to the Notes. The Company has agreed to bear
    registration expenses incurred under such agreement.

    Withdrawal Rights

         Tenders of Old Notes may be withdrawn at any time prior to the
    Expiration Date. 

         For a withdrawal to be effective, a written notice of withdrawal
    sent by telegram, facsimile transmission (receipt confirmed by telephone)
    or letter must be received by the Exchange Agent at the address set forth
    herein prior to the Expiration Date. Any such notice of withdrawal must
    (i) specify the name of the person having tendered the Old Notes to be
    withdrawn (the "Depositor"), (ii) identify the Old Notes to be withdrawn
    (including the certificate number or numbers and principal amount of such
    Old Notes), (iii) specify the principal amount of Notes to be withdrawn,
    (iv) include a statement that such holder is withdrawing his election to
<PAGE>
    have such Old Notes exchanged, (v) be signed by the holder in the same
    manner as the original signature on the Letter of Transmittal by which
    such Old Notes were tendered or as otherwise described above (including
    any required signature guarantees) or be accompanied by documents of
    transfer sufficient to have the Trustee under the Indenture register the
    transfer of such Old Notes into the name of the person withdrawing the
    tender and (vi) specify the name in which any such Old Notes are to be
    registered, if different from that of the Depositor. The Exchange Agent
    will return the properly withdrawn Old Notes promptly following receipt of
    notice of withdrawal. If Old Notes have been tendered pursuant to the
    procedure for book-entry transfer, any notice of withdrawal must specify
    the name and number of the account at the book-entry transfer facility to
    be credited with the withdrawn Old Notes or otherwise comply with the
    book-entry transfer facility procedure. All questions as to the validity
    of notices of withdrawals, including time of receipt, will be determined
    by the Company and such determination will be final and binding on all
    parties. 

         Any Old Notes so withdrawn will be deemed not to have been validly
    tendered for exchange for purposes of the Exchange Offer. Any Old Notes
    which have been tendered for exchange but which are not exchanged for any
    reason will be returned to the holder thereof without cost to such holder
    (or, in the case of Old Notes tendered by book-entry transfer into the
    Exchange Agent's account at the book-entry transfer facility pursuant to
    the book-entry transfer procedures described above, such Old Notes will be
    credited to an account with such book-entry transfer facility specified by
    the holder) as soon as practicable after withdrawal, rejection of tender
    or termination of the Exchange Offer. Properly withdrawn Old Notes may be
    retendered by following one of the procedures described under "Procedures
    for Tendering Old Notes" above at any time on or prior to the Expiration
    Date. 

    Acceptance of Old Notes for Exchange; Delivery of Exchange Notes

         Upon satisfaction or waiver of all of the conditions to the Exchange
    Offer, the Company will accept, promptly on the Exchange Date, all Old
    Notes properly tendered and will issue the Exchange Notes promptly after
    such acceptance. See "Certain Conditions to the Exchange Offer" below. For
    purposes of the Exchange Offer, the Company shall be deemed to have
    accepted properly tendered Old Notes for exchange when, as and if the
    Company has given oral or written notice thereof to the Exchange Agent. 

         For each Old Note accepted for exchange, the holder of such Old Note
    will receive an Exchange Note having a principal amount equal to that of
    the surrendered Old Note. 

         In all cases, issuance of Exchange Notes for Old Notes that are
    accepted for exchange pursuant to the Exchange Offer will be made only
    after timely receipt by the Exchange Agent of certificates for such Old
    Notes or a timely book-entry confirmation of such Old Notes into the
    Exchange Agent's account at the book-entry transfer facility, a properly
    completed and duly executed Letter of Transmittal and all other required
    documents. If any tendered Old Notes are not accepted for any reason set
    forth in the terms and conditions of the Exchange Offer or if Old Notes
    are submitted for a greater principal amount than the holder desires to
<PAGE>
    exchange, such unaccepted or non-exchanged Old Notes will be returned
    without expense to the tendering holder thereof (or, in the case of Old
    Notes tendered by book-entry transfer into the Exchange Agent's account at
    the book-entry transfer facility pursuant to the book-entry transfer
    procedures described above, such non-exchanged Old Notes will be credited
    to an account maintained with such book-entry transfer facility) as
    promptly as practicable after the expiration of the Exchange Offer. 

    Certain Conditions to the Exchange Offer

         Notwithstanding any other provision of the Exchange Offer, or any
    extension of the Exchange Offer, the Company shall not be required to
    accept for exchange, or to issue Exchange Notes in exchange for, any Old
    Notes and may terminate or amend the Exchange Offer (by oral or written
    notice to the Exchange Agent or by a timely press release) if at any time
    before the acceptance of such Old Notes for exchange or the exchange of
    the Exchange Notes for such Old Notes, any of the following conditions
    exist:

                   (a)  any action or proceeding is instituted or threatened
         in any court or by or before any governmental agency or regulatory
         authority or any injunction, order or decree is issued with respect
         to the Exchange Offer which, in the sole judgment of the Company,
         might materially impair the ability of the Company to proceed with
         the Exchange Offer or have a material adverse effect on the
         contemplated benefits of the Exchange Offer to the Company; or 

                   (b)  any change (or any development involving a
         prospective change) shall have occurred or be threatened in the
         business, properties, assets, liabilities, financial condition,
         operations, results of operations or prospects of the Company that
         is or may be adverse to the Company, or the Company shall have
         become aware of facts that have or may have adverse significance
         with respect to the value of the Old Notes or the Exchange Notes or
         that may materially impair the contemplated benefits of the Exchange
         Offer to the Company; or 

                   (c)  any law, rule or regulation or applicable
         interpretations of the staff of the Commission is issued or
         promulgated which, in the good faith determination of the Company,
         do not permit the Company to effect the Exchange Offer; or 

                   (d)  any governmental approval has not been obtained,
         which approval the Company, in its sole discretion, deems necessary
         for the consummation of the Exchange Offer; or 

                   (e)  there shall have been proposed, adopted or enacted
         any law, statute, rule or regulation (or an amendment to any
         existing law statute, rule or regulation) which, in the sole
         judgment of the Company, might materially impair the ability of the
         Company to proceed with the Exchange Offer or have a material
         adverse effect on the contemplated benefits of the Exchange Offer to
         the Company; or 
<PAGE>
                   (f)  there shall occur a change in the current
         interpretation by the staff of the Commission which permits the
         Exchange Notes issued pursuant to the Exchange Offer in exchange for
         Old Notes to be offered for resale, resold and otherwise transferred
         by holders thereof (other than any such holder that is an
         "affiliate" of the Company within the meaning of Rule 405 under the
         Securities Act) without compliance with the registration and
         prospectus delivery provisions of the Securities Act provided that
         such Exchange Notes are acquired in the ordinary course of such
         holders' business and such holders have no arrangement with any
         person to participate in the distribution of such Exchange Notes; or

                   (g)  there shall have occurred (i) any general suspension
         of, shortening of hours for, or limitation on prices for, trading in
         securities on any national securities exchange or in the
         over-the-counter market (whether or not mandatory), (ii) any
         limitation by any governmental agency or authority which may
         adversely affect the ability of the Company to complete the
         transactions contemplated by the Exchange Offer, (iii) a declaration
         of a banking moratorium or any suspension of payments in respect of
         banks by Federal or state authorities in the United States (whether
         or not mandatory), (iv) a commencement of a war, armed hostilities
         or other international or national crisis directly or indirectly
         involving the United States, (v) any limitation (whether or not
         mandatory) by any governmental authority on, or other event having a
         reasonable likelihood of affecting, the extension of credit by banks
         or other leading institutions in the United States, or (vi) in the
         case of any of the foregoing existing at the time of the
         commencement of the Exchange Offer, a material acceleration or
         worsening thereof. 

         The Company expressly reserves the right to terminate the Exchange
    Offer and not accept for exchange any Old Notes upon the occurrence of any
    of the foregoing conditions (which represent all of the material
    conditions to the acceptance by the Company of properly tendered Old
    Notes). In addition, the Company may amend the Exchange Offer at any time
    prior to the Expiration Date if any of the conditions set forth above
    occur. Moreover, regardless of whether any of such conditions has
    occurred, the Company may amend the Exchange Offer in any manner which, in
    its good faith judgment, is advantageous to holders of the Old Notes. 

         The foregoing conditions are for the sole benefit of the Company and
    may be asserted by the Company regardless of the circumstances giving rise
    to any such condition or may be waived by the Company in whole or in part
    at any time and from time to time in its sole discretion. The failure by
    the Company at any time to exercise any of the foregoing rights shall not
    be deemed a waiver of any such right and each such right shall be deemed
    an ongoing right which may be asserted at any time and from time to time.
    If the Company waives or amends the foregoing conditions, it will, if
    required by law, extend the Exchange Offer for a minimum of five business
    days from the date that the Company first gives notice, by public
    announcement or otherwise, of such waiver or amendment, if the Exchange
    Offer would otherwise expire within such five business-day period. Any
    determination by the Company concerning the events described above will be
    final and binding upon all parties. 
<PAGE>
         In addition, the Company will not accept for exchange any Old Notes
    tendered, and no Exchange Notes will be issued in exchange for any such
    Old Notes, if at such time any stop order shall be threatened or in effect
    with respect to the Registration Statement of which this Prospectus
    constitutes a part or the qualification of the Indenture under the Trust
    Indenture Act of 1939, as amended. In any such event the Company is
    required to use every reasonable effort to obtain the withdrawal of any
    stop order at the earliest possible time. 

         The Exchange Offer is not conditioned upon any minimum principal
    amount of Old Notes being tendered for exchange. 

    Exchange Agent

         The Bank of New York has been appointed as the Exchange Agent for
    the Exchange Offer. All executed Letters of Transmittal should be directed
    to the Exchange Agent at one of the addresses set forth below:

        By Hand/Overnight Courier:                         By Mail:
          The Bank of New York                       The Bank of New York 
    Attn: Corporate Trust Operations           Attn: Corporate Trust Operations
                                                                         
           New York, New York                         New York, New York

                                        By Facsimile:
                                      (212)           
                                      Attn.:           
                                 Telephone: (212)           

    Questions and requests for assistance, requests for additional copies of
    this Prospectus or of the Letter of Transmittal and requests for Notices
    of Guaranteed Delivery should be directed to the Exchange Agent at the
    address and telephone number set forth in the Letter of Transmittal. 

         DELIVERY TO AN ADDRESS OTHER THAN AS SET FORTH ON THE LETTER OF
    TRANSMITTAL, OR TRANSMISSIONS OF INSTRUCTIONS VIA A FACSIMILE OR TELEX
    NUMBER OTHER THAN THE ONES SET FORTH ON THE LETTER OF TRANSMITTAL, WILL
    NOT CONSTITUTE A VALID DELIVERY. 

    Solicitation of Tenders; Fees and Expenses

         The Company has not retained any dealer-manager in connection with
    the Exchange Offer and will not make any payments to brokers, dealers or
    others soliciting acceptances of the Exchange Offer. The Company, however,
    will pay the Exchange Agent reasonable and customary fees for its services
    and will reimburse it for its reasonable out-of-pocket expenses in
    connection therewith. The Company will also pay brokerage houses and other
    custodians, nominees and fiduciaries the reasonable out-of-pocket expenses
    incurred by them in forwarding copies of this and other related documents
    to the beneficial owners of the Old Notes and in handling or forwarding
    tenders for their customers. 

         The estimated cash expenses to be incurred in connection with the
    Exchange Offer will be paid by the Company and are estimated in the
    aggregate to be approximately $500,000, which includes fees and expenses
    of the Exchange Agent, Trustee, registration fees, accounting, legal,
    printing and related fees and expenses. 
<PAGE>
         No person has been authorized to give any information or to make any
    representations in connection with the Exchange Offer other than those
    contained in this Prospectus. If given or made, such information or
    representations should not be relied upon as having been authorized by the
    Company. Neither the delivery of this Prospectus nor any exchange made
    hereunder shall, under any circumstances, create any implication that
    there has been no change in the affairs of the Company since the
    respective dates as of which information is given herein. The Exchange
    Offer is not being made to (nor will tenders be accepted from or on behalf
    of) holders of Old Notes in any jurisdiction in which the making of the
    Exchange Offer or the acceptance thereof would not be in compliance with
    the laws of such jurisdiction. However, the Company may, at its
    discretion, take such action as it may deem necessary to make the Exchange
    Offer in any such jurisdiction and extend the Exchange Offer to holders of
    Old Notes in such jurisdiction. In any jurisdiction in which the
    securities laws or blue sky laws of which require the Exchange Offer to be
    made by a licensed broker or dealer, the Exchange Offer is being made on
    behalf of the Company by one or more registered brokers or dealers which
    are licensed under the laws of such jurisdiction. 

    Transfer Taxes

         The Company will pay all transfer taxes, if any, applicable to the
    exchange of Old Notes pursuant to the Exchange Offer. If, however,
    certificates representing Exchange Notes or Old Notes for principal
    amounts not tendered or accepted for exchange are to be delivered to, or
    are to be issued in the name of, any person other than the registered
    holder of the Old Notes tendered, or if tendered Old Notes are registered
    in the name of any person other than the person signing the Letter of
    Transmittal, or if a transfer tax is imposed for any reason other than the
    exchange of Old Notes pursuant to the Exchange Offer, then the amount of
    any such transfer taxes (whether imposed on the registered holder or any
    other persons) will be payable by the tendering holder. If satisfactory
    evidence of payment of such taxes or exemption therefrom is not submitted
    with the Letter of Transmittal, the amount of such transfer taxes will be
    billed directly to such tendering holder. 

    Accounting Treatment

         The Exchange Notes will be recorded at the carrying value of the Old
    Notes as reflected in the Company's accounting records on the date of the
    exchange. Accordingly, no gain or loss for accounting purposes will be
    recognized by the Company upon the exchange of Exchange Notes for Old
    Notes. Expenses incurred in connection with the issuance of the Exchange
    Notes will be amortized over the term of the Exchange Notes. 

    Consequences of Failure to Exchange

         Holders of Old Notes who do not exchange their Old Notes for
    Exchange Notes pursuant to the Exchange Offer will continue to be subject
    to the restrictions on transfer of such Old Notes as set forth in the
    legend thereon. Old Notes not exchanged pursuant to the Exchange Offer
    will continue to remain outstanding in accordance with their terms. In
    general, the Old Notes may not be offered or sold unless registered under
    the Securities Act, except pursuant to an exemption from, or in a
    transaction not subject to, the Securities Act and applicable state
<PAGE>
    securities laws. The Company does not currently anticipate that it will
    register the Old Notes under the Securities Act. 

         Participation in the Exchange Offer is voluntary, and holders of Old
    Notes should carefully consider whether to participate. Holders of Old
    Notes are urged to consult their financial and tax advisors in making
    their own decision on what action to take. 

         As a result of the making of, and upon acceptance for exchange of
    all validly tendered Old Notes pursuant to the terms of, this Exchange
    Offer, the Company will have fulfilled a covenant contained in the
    Registration Rights Agreement. Holders of Old Notes who do not tender
    their Old Notes in the Exchange Offer will continue to hold such Old Notes
    and will be entitled to all the rights and limitations applicable thereto
    under the Indenture, except for any such rights under the Registration
    Rights Agreement that by their terms terminate or cease to have further
    effectiveness as a result of the making of this Exchange Offer. All
    untendered Old Notes will continue to be subject to the restrictions on
    transfer set forth in the Indenture. To the extent that Old Notes are
    tendered and accepted in the Exchange Offer, the trading market for
    untendered Old Notes could be adversely affected. 

         The Company may in the future seek to acquire, subject to the terms
    of the Indenture, untendered Old Notes in open market or privately
    negotiated transactions, through subsequent exchange offers or otherwise.
    The Company has no present plan to acquire any Old Notes which are not
    tendered in the Exchange Offer. 

    Resale of Exchange Notes

         The Company is making the Exchange Offer in reliance on the position
    of the staff of the Commission as set forth in certain interpretive
    letters addressed to third parties in other transactions. However, the
    Company has not sought its own interpretive letter and there can be no
    assurance that the Staff would make a similar determination with respect
    to the Exchange Offer as it has in such interpretive letters to third
    parties. Based on these interpretations by the staff, the Company believes
    that the Exchange Notes issued pursuant to the Exchange Offer in exchange
    for Old Notes may be offered for resale, resold and otherwise transferred
    by a Holder (other than any Holder who is a broker-dealer or an
    "affiliate" of the Company within the meaning of Rule 405 of the
    Securities Act) without further compliance with the registration and
    prospectus delivery requirements of the Securities Act, provided that such
    Exchange Notes are acquired in the ordinary course of such Holder's
    business and that such Holder is not participating, and has no arrangement
    or understanding with any person to participate, in a distribution (within
    the meaning of the Securities Act) of such Exchange Notes. However, any
    holder who is an "affiliate" of the Company or who has an arrangement or
    understanding with respect to the distribution of the Exchange Notes to be
    acquired pursuant to the Exchange Offer, or any broker-dealer who
    purchased Old Notes from the Company to resell pursuant to Rule 144A or
    any other available exemption under the Securities Act (i) could not rely
    on the applicable interpretations of the staff and (ii) must comply with
    the registration and prospectus delivery requirements of the Securities
    Act. A broker-dealer who holds Old Notes that were acquired for its own
<PAGE>
    account as a result of market-making or other trading activities may be
    deemed to be an "underwriter" within the meaning of the Securities Act and
    must, therefore, deliver a prospectus meeting the requirements of the
    Securities Act in connection with any resale of Exchange Notes. Each such
    broker-dealer that receives Exchange Notes for its own account in exchange
    for Old Notes, where such Old Notes were acquired by such broker-dealer as
    a result of market-making activities or other trading activities, must
    acknowledge in the Letter of Transmittal that it will deliver a prospectus
    in connection with any resale of such Exchange Notes. See "Plan of
    Distribution." 

         In addition, to comply with the securities laws of certain
    jurisdictions, if applicable, the Exchange Notes may not be offered or
    sold unless they have been registered or qualified for sale in such
    jurisdiction or an exemption from registration or qualification is
    available and is complied with. The Company has agreed, pursuant to the
    Registration Rights Agreement and subject to certain specified limitations
    therein, to register or qualify the Exchange Notes for offer or sale under
    the securities or blue sky laws of such jurisdictions as any holder of the
    Exchange Notes reasonably requests. Such registration or qualification may
    require the imposition of restrictions or conditions (including
    suitability requirements for offerees or purchasers) in connection with
    the offer or sale of any Exchange Notes.
<PAGE>
                        DESCRIPTION OF THE EXCHANGE NOTES

    General

         The Old Notes were issued and the Exchange Notes offered hereby will
    be issued under an indenture dated as of April 30, 1997 (the "Indenture")
    between the Company, as issuer, and The Bank of New York, as trustee (the
    "Trustee"). The terms of the Exchange Notes include those stated in the
    Indenture and those made part of the Indenture by reference to the Trust
    Indenture Act of 1939, as amended (the "Trust Indenture Act"). The
    Exchange Notes are subject to all such terms, and holders of the Exchange
    Notes are referred to the Indenture and the Trust Indenture Act for a
    statement thereof. The following summary of the material provisions of the
    Indenture describes the material terms of the Indenture but does not
    purport to be complete and is subject to, and qualified in its entirety by
    reference to, the provisions of the Indenture, including the definitions
    of certain terms contained therein and those terms made part of the
    Indenture by reference to the Trust Indenture Act. For definitions of
    certain capitalized terms used in the following summary, see "--Certain
    Definitions". The Indenture is an exhibit to the Registration Statement of
    which this Prospectus is a part. 

         On April 30, 1997, the Company issued $225.0 million aggregate
    principal amount of Old Notes under the Indenture. The terms of the
    Exchange Notes are identical in all material respects to the Old Notes,
    except for certain transfer restrictions and registration and other rights
    relating to the exchange of the Old Notes for Exchange Notes. The Trustee
    will authenticate and deliver Exchange Notes for original issue only in
    exchange for a like principal amount of Old Notes. Any Old Notes that
    remain outstanding after the consummation of the Exchange Offer, together
    with the Exchange Notes, will be treated as a single class of securities
    under the Indenture. Accordingly, all references herein to specified
    percentages in aggregate principal amount of the outstanding Exchange
    Notes shall be deemed to mean, at any time after the Exchange Offer is
    consummated, such percentage in aggregate principal amount of the Old
    Notes and Exchange Notes then outstanding.

         The Exchange Notes will be general unsecured obligations of the
    Company and will be subordinated in right of payment to all current and
    future Senior Debt. At December 31, 1996, on a pro forma basis giving
    effect to the Acquisition and the initial borrowings under the Senior
    Credit Facilities, the Company would have had Senior Debt of approximately
    $175.0 million outstanding (excluding letters of credit). The Indenture
    will permit the incurrence of additional Senior Debt in the future.

         The Company will not have any Subsidiaries as of the Issue Date.
    However, the Indenture will provide that the Company's payment obligations
    under the Exchange Notes will be jointly and severally guaranteed (the
    "Subsidiary Guarantees") by all of the Company's future Restricted
    Subsidiaries, other than Foreign Subsidiaries (collectively, the
    "Guarantors"). The Subsidiary Guarantee of each Guarantor will be
    subordinated to the prior payment in full of all Senior Debt of such
    Guarantor, which would include the guarantees of amounts borrowed under
    the Senior Credit Facilities.
<PAGE>
    Principal, Maturity and Interest

         The Exchange Notes will be limited in aggregate principal amount to
    $225.0 million and will mature on May 1, 2007. Interest on the Exchange
    Notes will accrue at the rate of 10 3/8% per annum and will be payable
    semi-annually in arrears on May 1 and November 1, commencing on November
    1, 1997, to Holders of record on the immediately preceding April 15 and
    October 15. Interest on the Exchange Notes will accrue from the most
    recent date to which interest has been paid or, if no interest has been
    paid, from the date of original issuance. Interest will be computed on the
    basis of a 360-day year comprised of twelve 30-day months. Principal,
    premium, if any, and interest on the Exchange Notes will be payable at the
    office or agency of the Company maintained for such purpose within the
    City and State of New York or, at the option of the Company, payment of
    interest may be made by check mailed to the Holders of the Exchange Notes
    at their respective addresses set forth in the register of Holders of
    Exchange Notes; provided that all payments of principal, premium and
    interest with respect to Exchange Notes the Holders of which have given
    wire transfer instructions to the Company will be required to be made by
    wire transfer of immediately available funds to the accounts specified by
    the Holders thereof if such Holders shall be registered Holders of at
    least $250,000 in principal amount of Exchange Notes. Until otherwise
    designated by the Company, the Company's office or agency in New York will
    be the office of the Trustee maintained for such purpose. The Exchange
    Notes will be issued in denominations of $1,000 and integral multiples
    thereof.

    Optional Redemption

         The Exchange Notes will not be redeemable at the Company's option
    prior to May 1, 2002. Thereafter, the Exchange Notes will be subject to
    redemption at any time at the option of the Company, in whole or in part,
    upon not less than 30 nor more than 60 days' notice, at the redemption
    prices (expressed as percentages of principal amount) set forth below plus
    accrued and unpaid interest to the applicable redemption date, if redeemed
    during the twelve-month period beginning on May 1 of the years indicated
    below: 


    Year                                   Percentage
    --------------------------------   -----------------

    2002  . . . . . . . . . . . . . .     105.188%
    2003  . . . . . . . . . . . . . .     103.458%
    2004  . . . . . . . . . . . . . .     101.729%
    2005 and thereafter . . . . . . .     100.000%



         Notwithstanding the foregoing, during the first 36 months after the
    Issue Date, the Company may on any one or more occasions redeem up to an
    aggregate of 35% of the Exchange Notes originally issued at a redemption
<PAGE>
    price of 109.375% of the principal amount thereof, plus accrued and unpaid
    interest to the redemption date, with the net cash proceeds of one or more
    Equity Offerings by the Company or the net cash proceeds of one or more
    Equity Offerings by Holdings that are contributed to the Company as common
    equity capital; provided that at least 65% of the Exchange Notes
    originally issued remain outstanding immediately after the occurrence of
    each such redemption; and provided, further, that any such redemption must
    occur within 120 days of the date of the closing of such Equity Offering.

    Subordination

         The payment of principal of, premium, if any, and interest on the
    Exchange Notes will be subordinated in right of payment, as set forth in
    the Indenture, to the prior payment in full of all Senior Debt, whether
    outstanding on the Issue Date or thereafter incurred.

         Upon any distribution to creditors of the Company in a liquidation
    or dissolution of the Company or in a bankruptcy, reorganization,
    insolvency, receivership or similar proceeding relating to the Company or
    its property, an assignment for the benefit of creditors or any
    marshalling of the Company's assets and liabilities, the holders of Senior
    Debt will be entitled to receive payment in full in cash of all
    Obligations due in respect of such Senior Debt (including interest after
    the commencement of any such proceeding at the rate specified in the
    applicable Senior Debt, whether or not an allowable claim in any such
    proceeding) before the Holders of Exchange Notes will be entitled to
    receive any payment with respect to the Exchange Notes, and until all
    Obligations with respect to Senior Debt are paid in full, any distribution
    to which the Holders of Exchange Notes would be entitled shall be made to
    the holders of Senior Debt (except, in each case, that Holders of Exchange
    Notes may receive Permitted Junior Securities and payments made from the
    trust described under "--Legal Defeasance and Covenant Defeasance").

         The Company also may not make any payment upon or in respect of the
    Exchange Notes (except from the trust described under "--Legal Defeasance
    and Covenant Defeasance") if (i) a default in the payment of the principal
    of, premium, if any, or interest on Designated Senior Debt occurs and is
    continuing or (ii) any other default occurs and is continuing with respect
    to Designated Senior Debt that permits holders of the Designated Senior
    Debt as to which such default relates to accelerate its maturity (or that
    would permit such holders to accelerate with the giving of notice or the
    passage of time or both) and the Trustee receives a notice of such default
    (a "Payment Blockage Notice") from the Company or the holders of any
    Designated Senior Debt. Payments on the Exchange Notes may and shall be
    resumed (A) in the case of a payment default, upon the date on which such
    default is cured or waived and (B) in case of a nonpayment default, the
    earlier of the date on which such nonpayment default is cured or waived or
    179 days after the date on which the applicable Payment Blockage Notice is
    received, unless the maturity of any Designated Senior Debt has been
    accelerated. No new period of payment blockage may be commenced unless and
    until (i) 360 days have elapsed since the effectiveness of the immediately
    prior Payment Blockage Notice and (ii) all scheduled payments of
    principal, premium, if any, and interest on the Exchange Notes that have
    come due have been paid in full in cash. No nonpayment default that
    existed or was continuing on the date of delivery of any Payment Blockage
    Notice to the Trustee shall be, or be made, the basis for a subsequent
<PAGE>
    Payment Blockage Notice unless such default shall have been waived for a
    period of not less than 90 days.

         The Indenture further requires that the Company promptly notify
    holders of Senior Debt if payment of the Exchange Notes is accelerated
    because of an Event of Default.

         As a result of the subordination provisions described above, in the
    event of a liquidation or insolvency, Holders of Exchange Notes may
    recover less ratably than creditors of the Company who are holders of
    Senior Debt. On a pro forma basis, after giving effect to the Acquisition
    and the initial borrowing under the Senior Credit Facilities, the
    principal amount of Senior Debt outstanding (excluding letters of credit)
    at December 31, 1996 would have been approximately $175.0 million.

    Selection and Notice

         If less than all of the Exchange Notes are to be redeemed at any
    time, selection of Exchange Notes for redemption will be made by the
    Trustee in compliance with the requirements of the principal national
    securities exchange, if any, on which the Exchange Notes are listed, or,
    if the Exchange Notes are not so listed, on a pro rata basis, by lot or by
    such method as the Trustee shall deem fair and appropriate; provided that
    no Exchange Notes of $1,000 or less shall be redeemed in part. Notices of
    redemption shall be mailed by first class mail at least 30 but not more
    than 60 days before the redemption date to each Holder of Exchange Notes
    to be redeemed at its registered address. Notices of redemption may not be
    conditional. If any Note is to be redeemed in part only, the notice of
    redemption that relates to such Note shall state the portion of the
    principal amount thereof to be redeemed. A new Note in principal amount
    equal to the unredeemed portion thereof will be issued in the name of the
    Holder thereof upon cancellation of the original Note. Exchange Notes
    called for redemption become due on the date fixed for redemption. On and
    after the redemption date, interest ceases to accrue on Exchange Notes or
    portions of them called for redemption.

    Mandatory Redemption

         Except as set forth below under "--Repurchase at the Option of
    Holders", the Company is not required to make mandatory redemption or
    sinking fund payments with respect to the Exchange Notes.

    Repurchase at the Option of Holders

    Change of Control

         Upon the occurrence of a Change of Control, each Holder of Exchange
    Notes will have the right to require the Company to repurchase all or any
    part (equal to $1,000 or an integral multiple thereof) of such Holder's
    Exchange Notes pursuant to the offer described below (the "Change of
    Control Offer") at an offer price in cash equal to 101% of the aggregate
    principal amount thereof plus accrued and unpaid interest to the date of
    purchase (the "Change of Control Payment"). Within ten days following any
    Change of Control, the Company will mail a notice to each Holder
    describing the transaction or transactions that constitute the Change of
    Control and offering to repurchase Exchange Notes on the date specified in
<PAGE>
    such notice, which date shall be no earlier than 30 days and no later than
    60 days from the date such notice is mailed (the "Change of Control
    Payment Date"), pursuant to the procedures required by the Indenture and
    described in such notice. The Company will comply with the requirements of
    Rule 14e-1 under the Exchange Act and any other securities laws and
    regulations thereunder to the extent such laws and regulations are
    applicable in connection with the repurchase of the Exchange Notes as a
    result of a Change of Control.

         On the Change of Control Payment Date, the Company will, to the
    extent lawful, (i) accept for payment all Exchange Notes or portions
    thereof properly tendered pursuant to the Change of Control Offer,
    (ii) deposit with the Paying Agent an amount equal to the Change of
    Control Payment in respect of all Exchange Notes or portions thereof so
    tendered and (iii) deliver or cause to be delivered to the Trustee the
    Exchange Notes so accepted together with an Officers' Certificate stating
    the aggregate principal amount of Exchange Notes or portions thereof being
    purchased by the Company. The Paying Agent will promptly mail to each
    Holder of Exchange Notes so tendered the Change of Control Payment for
    such Exchange Notes, and the Trustee will promptly authenticate and mail
    (or cause to be transferred by book entry) to each Holder a new Note equal
    in principal amount to any unpurchased portion of the Exchange Notes
    surrendered, if any; provided that each such new Note will be in a
    principal amount of $1,000 or an integral multiple thereof. 

         The Indenture will provide that, prior to mailing a Change of
    Control Offer, but in any event within 90 days following a Change of
    Control, the Company will either repay all outstanding Senior Debt or
    offer to repay all Senior Debt and terminate all commitments thereunder of
    each lender who has accepted such offer or obtain the requisite consents,
    if any, under all agreements governing outstanding Senior Debt to permit
    the repurchase of Exchange Notes required by this covenant. The Company
    will publicly announce the results of the Change of Control Offer on or as
    soon as practicable after the Change of Control Payment Date.

         The Change of Control provisions described above will be applicable
    whether or not any other provisions of the Indenture are applicable.
    Except as described above with respect to a Change of Control, the
    Indenture does not contain provisions that permit the Holders of the
    Exchange Notes to require that the Company repurchase or redeem the
    Exchange Notes in the event of a takeover, recapitalization or similar
    transaction.

         The Senior Credit Facilities will prohibit the Company from
    purchasing any Exchange Notes, and also provides that certain change of
    control events with respect to the Company would constitute a default
    thereunder. Any future credit agreements or other agreements relating to
    Senior Debt to which the Company becomes a party may contain similar
    restrictions and provisions. In the event a Change of Control occurs at a
    time when the Company is prohibited from purchasing Exchange Notes, the
    Company could seek the consent of its lenders to the purchase of Exchange
    Notes or could attempt to refinance the borrowings that contain such
    prohibition. If the Company does not obtain such a consent or repay such
    borrowings, the Company will remain prohibited from purchasing Exchange
    Notes. In such case, the Company's failure to purchase tendered Exchange
    Notes would constitute an Event of Default under the Indenture which
<PAGE>
    would, in turn, constitute a default under the Senior Credit Facilities.
    In such circumstances, the subordination provisions in the Indenture would
    likely restrict payments to the Holders of Exchange Notes. See "Risk
    Factors--Change of Control".

         The Company will not be required to make a Change of Control Offer
    upon a Change of Control if a third party makes the Change of Control
    Offer in the manner, at the times and otherwise in compliance with the
    requirements set forth in the Indenture applicable to a Change of Control
    Offer made by the Company and purchases all Exchange Notes validly
    tendered and not withdrawn under such Change of Control Offer.

         "Change of Control" means the occurrence of any of the following:
    (i) the sale, lease, transfer, conveyance or other disposition (other than
    by way of merger or consolidation), in one or a series of related
    transactions, of all or substantially all of the assets of the Company and
    its Restricted Subsidiaries taken as a whole to any "person" (as such term
    is used in Section 13(d)(3) of the Exchange Act) other than the Principals
    or their Related Parties (as defined below), (ii) the adoption of a plan
    relating to the liquidation or dissolution of the Company, (iii) the
    consummation of any transaction (including, without limitation, any merger
    or consolidation) the result of which is that any "person" (as defined
    above), other than the Principals and their Related Parties, becomes the
    "beneficial owner" (as such term is defined in Rule 13d-3 and Rule 13d-5
    under the Exchange Act), directly or indirectly, of more than 50% of the
    Voting Stock of the Company (measured by voting power rather than number
    of shares) or (iv) the first day on which a majority of the members of the
    Board of Directors of the Company are not Continuing Directors.

         "Continuing Directors" means, as of any date of determination, any
    member of the Board of Directors of the Company who (i) was a member of
    such Board of Directors on the Issue Date or (ii) was nominated for
    election or elected to such Board of Directors with the approval of a
    majority of the Continuing Directors who were members of such Board at the
    time of such nomination or election.

         "Principals" means any Lehman Investor, Lockheed Martin Corporation,
    Frank C. Lanza and Robert V. LaPenta.

         "Related Party" with respect to any Principal means (i) any
    controlling stockholder, 50% (or more) owned Subsidiary, or spouse or
    immediate family member (in the case of an individual) of such Principal
    or (ii) any trust, corporation, partnership or other entity, the
    beneficiaries, stockholders, partners, owners or Persons beneficially
    holding a more than 50% controlling interest of which consist of such
    Principal and/or such other Persons referred to in the immediately
    preceding clause (i).

         "Voting Stock" of any Person as of any date means the Capital Stock
    of such Person that is at the time entitled to vote in the election of the
    Board of Directors of such Person.

    Asset Sales

         The Indenture will provide that the Company will not, and will not
    permit any of its Restricted Subsidiaries to, consummate an Asset Sale
    unless (i) the Company (or the Restricted Subsidiary, as the case may be)
<PAGE>
    receives consideration at the time of such Asset Sale at least equal to
    the fair market value (evidenced by a resolution of the Board of Directors
    set forth in an Officers' Certificate delivered to the Trustee) of the
    assets or Equity Interests issued or sold or otherwise disposed of and
    (ii) at least 80% of the consideration therefor received by the Company or
    such Restricted Subsidiary, as the case may be, consists of cash, Cash
    Equivalents and/or Marketable Securities; provided, however, that (A) the
    amount of any Senior Debt of the Company or such Restricted Subsidiary
    that is assumed by the transferee in any such transaction and (B) any
    consideration received by the Company or such Restricted Subsidiary, as
    the case may be, that consists of (1) all or substantially all of the
    assets of one or more Similar Businesses, (2) other long-term assets that
    are used or useful in one or more Similar Businesses and (3) Permitted
    Securities shall be deemed to be cash for purposes of this provision.

         Within 365 days after the receipt of any Net Proceeds from an Asset
    Sale, the Company may apply such Net Proceeds, at its option, (i) to repay
    Indebtedness under a Credit Facility, or (ii) to the acquisition of
    Permitted Securities, all or substantially all of the assets of one or
    more Similar Businesses, or the making of a capital expenditure or the
    acquisition of other long-term assets in a Similar Business. Pending the
    final application of any such Net Proceeds, the Company may temporarily
    reduce Indebtedness under a Credit Facility or otherwise invest such Net
    Proceeds in any manner that is not prohibited by the Indenture. Any Net
    Proceeds from Asset Sales that are not applied or invested as provided in
    the first sentence of this paragraph will be deemed to constitute "Excess
    Proceeds". When the aggregate amount of Excess Proceeds exceeds $10.0
    million, the Company will be required to make an offer to all Holders of
    Exchange Notes (an "Asset Sale Offer") to purchase the maximum principal
    amount of Exchange Notes that may be purchased out of the Excess Proceeds,
    at an offer price in cash in an amount equal to 100% of the principal
    amount thereof plus accrued and unpaid interest and Liquidated Damages
    thereon, if any, to the date of purchase, in accordance with the
    procedures set forth in the Indenture. To the extent that the aggregate
    amount of Exchange Notes tendered pursuant to an Asset Sale Offer is less
    than the Excess Proceeds, the Company may use any remaining Excess
    Proceeds for general corporate purposes. If the aggregate principal amount
    of Exchange Notes surrendered by Holders thereof exceeds the amount of
    Excess Proceeds, the Trustee shall select the Exchange Notes to be
    purchased on a pro rata basis. Upon completion of such offer to purchase,
    the amount of Excess Proceeds shall be reset at zero.

         The Senior Credit Facilities will substantially limit the Company's
    ability to purchase subordinated Indebtedness, including the Exchange
    Notes. Any future credit agreements relating to Senior Debt may contain
    similar restrictions. See "Description of Senior Credit Facilities".

    Certain Covenants

    Restricted Payments

         The Indenture will provide that the Company will not, and will not
    permit any of its Restricted Subsidiaries to, directly or indirectly:
    (i) declare or pay any dividend or make any other payment or distribution
    on account of the Company's or any of its Restricted Subsidiaries' Equity
    Interests (including, without limitation, any payment in connection with
<PAGE>
    any merger or consolidation involving the Company) or to the direct or
    indirect holders of the Company's or any of its Restricted Subsidiaries'
    Equity Interests in their capacity as such (other than (A) dividends or
    distributions payable in Equity Interests (other than Disqualified Stock)
    of the Company or (B) dividends or distributions by a Restricted
    Subsidiary so long as, in the case of any dividend or distribution payable
    on or in respect of any class or series of securities issued by a
    Restricted Subsidiary other than a Wholly Owned Restricted Subsidiary, the
    Company or a Restricted Subsidiary receives at least its pro rata share of
    such dividend or distribution in accordance with its Equity Interests in
    such class or series of securities); (ii) purchase, redeem or otherwise
    acquire or retire for value (including without limitation, in connection
    with any merger or consolidation involving the Company) any Equity
    Interests of the Company or any direct or indirect parent of the Company;
    (iii) make any payment on or with respect to, or purchase, redeem, defease
    or otherwise acquire or retire for value any Indebtedness that is
    subordinated to the Exchange Notes except a payment of interest or
    principal at Stated Maturity; or (iv) make any Restricted Investment (all
    such payments and other actions set forth in clauses (i) through
    (iv) above being collectively referred to as "Restricted Payments"),
    unless, at the time of and after giving effect to such Restricted Payment:

                   (a)  no Default or Event of Default shall have occurred
         and be continuing or would occur as a consequence thereof; and

                   (b)  the Company would, at the time of such Restricted
         Payment and after giving pro forma effect thereto as if such
         Restricted Payment had been made at the beginning of the applicable
         four-quarter period, have been permitted to incur at least $1.00 of
         additional Indebtedness pursuant to the Fixed Charge Coverage Ratio
         test set forth in the first paragraph of the covenant described
         below under caption "Incurrence of Indebtedness and Issuance of
         Preferred Stock"; and

                   (c)  such Restricted Payment, together with the aggregate
         amount of all other Restricted Payments made by the Company and its
         Restricted Subsidiaries after the Issue Date (excluding Restricted
         Payments permitted by clauses (ii) through (vii) of the next
         succeeding paragraph), is less than the sum of (i) 50% of the
         Consolidated Net Income of the Company for the period (taken as one
         accounting period) from the beginning of the first fiscal quarter
         commencing after the Issue Date to the end of the Company's most
         recently ended fiscal quarter for which internal financial
         statements are available at the time of such Restricted Payment (or,
         if such Consolidated Net Income for such period is a deficit, less
         100% of such deficit), plus (ii) 100% of the aggregate net cash
         proceeds received by the Company from a contribution to its common
         equity capital or the issue or sale since the Issue Date of Equity
         Interests of the Company (other than Disqualified Stock) or of
         Disqualified Stock or debt securities of the Company that have been
         converted into such Equity Interests (other than Equity Interests
         (or Disqualified Stock or convertible debt securities) sold to a
         Subsidiary of the Company and other than Disqualified Stock or
         convertible debt securities that have been converted into
         Disqualified Stock), plus (iii) to the extent that any Restricted
         Investment that was made after the Issue Date is sold for cash or
<PAGE>
         otherwise liquidated or repaid for cash, the amount of cash received
         in connection therewith (or from the sale of Marketable Securities
         received in connection therewith), plus (iv) to the extent not
         already included in such Consolidated Net Income of the Company for
         such period and without duplication, (A) 100% of the aggregate
         amount of cash received as a dividend from an Unrestricted
         Subsidiary, (B) 100% of the cash received upon the sale of
         Marketable Securities received as a dividend from an Unrestricted
         Subsidiary, and (C) 100% of the net assets of any Unrestricted
         Subsidiary on the date that it becomes a Restricted Subsidiary.

         The foregoing provisions will not prohibit:

                     (i)     the payment of any dividend within 60 days after
         the date of declaration thereof, if at said date of declaration such
         payment would have complied with the provisions of the Indenture;

                    (ii)     the redemption, repurchase, retirement,
         defeasance or other acquisition of any subordinated Indebtedness or
         Equity Interests of the Company in exchange for, or out of the net
         cash proceeds of the substantially concurrent sale (other than to a
         Subsidiary of the Company) of, other Equity Interests of the Company
         (other than any Disqualified Stock); provided that the amount of any
         such net cash proceeds that are utilized for any such redemption,
         repurchase, retirement, defeasance or other acquisition shall be
         excluded from clause (c)(ii) of the preceding paragraph;

                   (iii)     the defeasance, redemption, repurchase or other
         acquisition of subordinated Indebtedness (other than intercompany
         Indebtedness) in exchange for, or with the net cash proceeds from an
         incurrence of, Permitted Refinancing Indebtedness;

                    (iv)     the repurchase, retirement or other acquisition
         or retirement for value of common Equity Interests of the Company or
         Holdings held by any future, present or former employee, director or
         consultant of the Company or any Subsidiary or Holdings issued
         pursuant to any management equity plan or stock option plan or any
         other management or employee benefit plan or agreement; provided,
         however, that the aggregate amount of Restricted Payments made under
         this clause (iv) does not exceed $1.5 million in any calendar year
         and provided further that cancellation of Indebtedness owing to the
         Company from members of management of the Company or any of its
         Restricted Subsidiaries in connection with a repurchase of Equity
         Interests of the Company will not be deemed to constitute a
         Restricted Payment for purposes of this covenant or any other
         provision of the Indenture;

                     (v)     repurchases of Equity Interests deemed to occur
         upon exercise of stock options upon surrender of Equity Interests to
         pay the exercise price of such options;

                    (vi)     payments to Holdings (A) in amounts equal to the
         amounts required for Holdings to pay franchise taxes and other fees
         required to maintain its legal existence and provide for other
         operating costs of up to $500,000 per fiscal year and (B) in amounts
         equal to amounts required for Holdings to pay federal, state and
<PAGE>
         local income taxes to the extent such income taxes are actually due
         and owing; provided that the aggregate amount paid under this clause
         (B) does not exceed the amount that the Company would be required to
         pay in respect of the income of the Company and its Subsidiaries if
         the Company were a stand alone entity that was not owned by
         Holdings; and

                   (vii)     other Restricted Payments in an aggregate amount
         since the Issue Date not to exceed $20.0 million.

         The Board of Directors of the Company may designate any Restricted
    Subsidiary to be an Unrestricted Subsidiary if such designation would not
    cause a Default. For purposes of making such determination, all
    outstanding Investments by the Company and its Restricted Subsidiaries
    (except to the extent repaid in cash) in the Subsidiary so designated will
    be deemed to be Restricted Payments at the time of such designation and
    will reduce the amount available for Restricted Payments under the first
    paragraph of this covenant. All such outstanding Investments will be
    deemed to constitute Investments in an amount equal to the fair market
    value of such Investments at the time of such designation. Such
    designation will only be permitted if such Restricted Payment would be
    permitted at such time and if such Restricted Subsidiary otherwise meets
    the definition of an Unrestricted Subsidiary.

         The amount of all Restricted Payments (other than cash) shall be the
    fair market value on the date of the Restricted Payment of the asset(s) or
    securities proposed to be transferred or issued by the Company or such
    Subsidiary, as the case may be, pursuant to the Restricted Payment. The
    fair market value of any non-cash Restricted Payment shall be determined
    by the Board of Directors whose resolution with respect thereto shall be
    delivered to the Trustee. Not later than the date of making any Restricted
    Payment, the Company shall deliver to the Trustee an Officers' Certificate
    stating that such Restricted Payment is permitted and setting forth the
    basis upon which the calculations required by the covenant "Restricted
    Payments" were computed.

    Incurrence of Indebtedness and Issuance of Preferred Stock

         The Indenture will provide that the Company will not, and will not
    permit any of its Subsidiaries to, directly or indirectly, create, incur,
    issue, assume, guarantee or otherwise become directly or indirectly
    liable, contingently or otherwise, with respect to (collectively, "incur")
    any Indebtedness (including Acquired Debt) and that the Company will not
    issue any Disqualified Stock and will not permit any of its Subsidiaries
    to issue any shares of preferred stock; provided, however, that the
    Company and any Restricted Subsidiary may incur Indebtedness (including
    Acquired Debt) or issue shares of preferred stock if the Fixed Charge
    Coverage Ratio for the Company's most recently ended four full fiscal
    quarters for which internal financial statements are available immediately
    preceding the date on which such additional Indebtedness is incurred or
    such preferred stock is issued would have been at least 2.0 to 1.0,
    determined on a pro forma basis (including a pro forma application of the
    net proceeds therefrom), as if the additional Indebtedness had been
    incurred, or the preferred stock had been issued, as the case may be, at
    the beginning of such four-quarter period.
<PAGE>
         The forgoing limitation will not apply to the incurrence of any of
    the following items of Indebtedness (collectively, "Permitted Debt"):

                     (i)     the incurrence by the Company of term
         Indebtedness under Credit Facilities (and the guarantee thereof by
         the Guarantors); provided that the aggregate principal amount of all
         term Indebtedness outstanding under all Credit Facilities after
         giving effect to such incurrence, including all Permitted
         Refinancing Indebtedness incurred to refund, refinance or replace
         any other Indebtedness incurred pursuant to this clause (i), does
         not exceed an amount equal to $175.0 million less the aggregate
         amount of all repayments, optional or mandatory, of the principal of
         any Indebtedness under a Credit Facility (or any such Permitted
         Refinancing Indebtedness) that have been made since the Issue Date;

                    (ii)     the incurrence by the Company of revolving
         credit Indebtedness and letters of credit (with letters of credit
         being deemed to have a principal amount equal to the maximum
         potential liability of the Company and its Restricted Subsidiaries
         thereunder) under Credit Facilities (and the guarantee thereof by
         the Guarantors); provided that the aggregate principal amount of all
         revolving credit Indebtedness outstanding under all Credit
         Facilities after giving effect to such incurrence, including all
         Permitted Refinancing Indebtedness incurred to refund, refinance or
         replace any other Indebtedness incurred pursuant to this clause
         (ii), does not exceed an amount equal to $100.0 million less the
         aggregate amount of all Net Proceeds of Asset Sales applied to repay
         any such Indebtedness (including any such Permitted Refinancing
         Indebtedness) pursuant to the covenant described above under the
         caption "--Asset Sales";

                   (iii)     the incurrence by the Company and its Restricted
         Subsidiaries of the Existing Indebtedness;

                    (iv)     the incurrence by the Company and the Guarantors
         of the Exchange Notes and the Subsidiary Guarantees;

                     (v)     the incurrence by the Company or any of its
         Restricted Subsidiaries of Indebtedness represented by Capital Lease
         Obligations, mortgage financings or purchase money obligations, in
         each case incurred for the purpose of financing all or any part of
         the purchase price or cost of construction or improvement of
         property, plant or equipment used in the business of the Company or
         such Restricted Subsidiary, in an aggregate principal amount,
         including all Permitted Refinancing Indebtedness incurred to refund,
         refinance or replace any other Indebtedness incurred pursuant to
         this clause (v), not to exceed $30.0 million at any time
         outstanding;

                    (vi)     the incurrence by the Company or any of its
         Restricted Subsidiaries of Indebtedness in connection with the
         acquisition of assets or a new Restricted Subsidiary; provided that
         such Indebtedness was incurred by the prior owner of such assets or
         such Restricted Subsidiary prior to such acquisition by the Company
         or one of its Restricted Subsidiaries and was not incurred in
         connection with, or in contemplation of, such acquisition by the
         Company or one of its Restricted Subsidiaries; and provided further
<PAGE>
         that the principal amount (or accreted value, as applicable) of such
         Indebtedness, together with any other outstanding Indebtedness
         incurred pursuant to this clause (vi), does not exceed $10.0
         million;

                   (vii)     the incurrence by the Company or any of its
         Restricted Subsidiaries of Permitted Refinancing Indebtedness in
         exchange for, or the net proceeds of which are used to refund,
         refinance or replace, Indebtedness that was permitted by the
         Indenture to be incurred;

                  (viii)     Indebtedness incurred by the Company or any of
         its Restricted Subsidiaries constituting reimbursement obligations
         with respect to letters of credit issued in the ordinary course of
         business in respect of workers' compensation claims or
         self-insurance, or other Indebtedness with respect to reimbursement
         type obligations regarding workers' compensation claims; provided,
         however, that upon the drawing of such letters of credit or the
         incurrence of such Indebtedness, such obligations are reimbursed
         within 30 days following such drawing or incurrence;

                    (ix)     Indebtedness arising from agreements of the
         Company or a Restricted Subsidiary providing for indemnification,
         adjustment of purchase price or similar obligations, in each case,
         incurred or assumed in connection with the disposition of any
         business, assets or a Subsidiary, other than guarantees of
         Indebtedness incurred by any Person acquiring all or any portion of
         such business, assets or a Subsidiary for the purpose of financing
         such acquisition; provided, however, that (A) such Indebtedness is
         not reflected on the balance sheet of the Company or any Restricted
         Subsidiary (contingent obligations referred to in a footnote to
         financial statements and not otherwise reflected on the balance
         sheet will not be deemed to be reflected on such balance sheet for
         purposes of this clause (A)) and (B) the maximum assumable liability
         in respect of all such Indebtedness shall at no time exceed the
         gross proceeds including noncash proceeds (the fair market value of
         such noncash proceeds being measured at the time received and
         without giving effect to any subsequent changes in value) actually
         received by the Company and its Restricted Subsidiaries in
         connection with such disposition;

                     (x)     the incurrence by the Company or any of its
         Restricted Subsidiaries of intercompany Indebtedness between or
         among the Company and any of its Restricted Subsidiaries; provided,
         however, that (A) if the Company is the obligor on such
         Indebtedness, such Indebtedness is expressly subordinated to the
         prior payment in full in cash of all Obligations with respect to the
         Exchange Notes and (B)(1) any subsequent issuance or transfer of
         Equity Interests that results in any such Indebtedness being held by
         a Person other than the Company or one of its Restricted
         Subsidiaries and (2) any sale or other transfer of any such
         Indebtedness to a Person that is not either the Company or one of
         its Restricted Subsidiaries shall be deemed, in each case, to
         constitute an incurrence of such Indebtedness by the Company or such
         Restricted Subsidiary, as the case may be;
<PAGE>
                    (xi)     the incurrence by the Company or any of the
         Guarantors of Hedging Obligations that are incurred for the purpose
         of (A) fixing, hedging or capping interest rate risk with respect to
         any floating rate Indebtedness that is permitted by the terms of the
         Indenture to be outstanding or (B) protecting the Company and its
         Restricted Subsidiaries against changes in currency exchange rates;

                   (xii)     the guarantee by the Company or any of the
         Guarantors of Indebtedness of the Company or a Restricted Subsidiary
         of the Company that was permitted to be incurred by another
         provision of this covenant;

                  (xiii)     the incurrence by the Company's Unrestricted
         Subsidiaries of Non-Recourse Debt, provided, however, that if any
         such Indebtedness ceases to be Non-Recourse Debt of an Unrestricted
         Subsidiary, such event shall be deemed to constitute an incurrence
         of Indebtedness by a Restricted Subsidiary of the Company that was
         not permitted by this clause (xiii), and the issuance of preferred
         stock by Unrestricted Subsidiaries;

                   (xiv)     obligations in respect of performance and surety
         bonds and completion guarantees provided by the Company or any
         Restricted Subsidiaries in the ordinary course of business; and

                    (xv)     the incurrence by the Company or any of its
         Restricted Subsidiaries of additional Indebtedness in an aggregate
         principal amount (or accreted value, as applicable) at any time
         outstanding, including all Permitted Refinancing Indebtedness
         incurred to refund, refinance or replace any other Indebtedness
         incurred pursuant to this clause (xv), not to exceed $50.0 million.

         For purposes of determining compliance with this covenant, in the
    event that an item of Indebtedness meets the criteria of more than one of
    the categories of Permitted Debt described in clauses (i) through
    (xv) above or is entitled to be incurred pursuant to the first paragraph
    of this covenant, the Company shall, in its sole discretion, classify such
    item of Indebtedness in any manner that complies with this covenant.
    Accrual of interest, the accretion of accreted value and the payment of
    interest in the form of additional Indebtedness will not be deemed to be
    an incurrence of Indebtedness for purposes of this covenant.

    Liens

         The Indenture will provide that the Company will not, and will not
    permit any of its Restricted Subsidiaries to, directly or indirectly,
    create, incur, assume or suffer to exist any Lien securing Indebtedness on
    any asset now owned or hereafter acquired, or any income or profits
    therefrom or assign or convey any right to receive income therefrom,
    except Permitted Liens.

    Antilayering Provision

         The Indenture will provide that (i) the Company will not incur,
    create, issue, assume, guarantee or otherwise become liable for any
    Indebtedness that is subordinate or junior in right of payment to any
<PAGE>
    Senior Debt and senior in any respect in right of payment to the Exchange
    Notes, and (ii) no Guarantor will incur, create, issue, assume, guarantee
    or otherwise become liable for any Indebtedness that is subordinate or
    junior in right of payment to any Senior Debt of a Guarantor and senior in
    any respect in right of payment to any of the Subsidiary Guarantees.

    Dividend and Other Payment Restrictions Affecting Subsidiaries

         The Indenture will provide that the Company will not, and will not
    permit any of its Restricted Subsidiaries to, directly or indirectly,
    create or otherwise cause or suffer to exist or become effective any
    encumbrance or restriction on the ability of any Restricted Subsidiary to
    (i)(A) pay dividends or make any other distributions to the Company or any
    of its Restricted Subsidiaries (1) on its Capital Stock or (2) with
    respect to any other interest or participation in, or measured by, its
    profits, or (B) pay any indebtedness owed to the Company or any of its
    Restricted Subsidiaries, (ii) make loans or advances to the Company or any
    of its Restricted Subsidiaries or (iii) transfer any of its properties or
    assets to the Company or any of its Restricted Subsidiaries, except for
    such encumbrances or restrictions existing under or by reason of (A) the
    provisions of security agreements that restrict the transfer of assets
    that are subject to a Lien created by such security agreements, (B) the
    provisions of agreements governing Indebtedness incurred pursuant to
    clause (v) of the second paragraph of the covenant described above under
    the caption "--Incurrence of Indebtedness and Issuance of Preferred Stock,
    (C) the Indenture and the Exchange Notes, (D) applicable law, (E) any
    instrument governing Indebtedness or Capital Stock of a Person acquired by
    the Company or any of its Restricted Subsidiaries as in effect at the time
    of such acquisition (except to the extent such Indebtedness was incurred
    in connection with or in contemplation of such acquisition), which
    encumbrance or restriction is not applicable to any Person, or the
    properties or assets of any Person, other than the Person, or the property
    or assets of the Person, so acquired, provided that, in the case of
    Indebtedness, such Indebtedness was permitted by the terms of the
    Indenture to be incurred, (F) by reason of customary non-assignment
    provisions in leases entered into in the ordinary course of business and
    consistent with past practices, (G) purchase money obligations for
    property acquired in the ordinary course of business that impose
    restrictions of the nature described in clause (iii) above on the property
    so acquired, (H) Permitted Refinancing Indebtedness, provided that the
    restrictions contained in the agreements governing such Permitted
    Refinancing Indebtedness are no more restrictive than those contained in
    the agreements governing the Indebtedness being refinanced, (I) contracts
    for the sale of assets, including, without limitation, customary
    restrictions with respect to a Subsidiary pursuant to an agreement that
    has been entered into for the sale or disposition of all or substantially
    all of the Capital Stock or assets of such Subsidiary, (J) agreements
    relating to secured Indebtedness otherwise permitted to be incurred
    pursuant to the covenants described under "Limitations on Incurrence of
    Indebtedness and Issuance of Preferred Stock" and "Liens" that limit the
    right of the debtor to dispose of the assets securing such Indebtedness,
    (K) restrictions on cash or other deposits or net worth imposed by
    customers under contracts entered into in the ordinary course of business,
    or (L) customary provisions in joint venture agreements and other similar
    agreements entered into in the ordinary course of business.
<PAGE>
    Merger, Consolidation or Sale of Assets

         The Indenture will provide that the Company may not consolidate or
    merge with or into (whether or not the Company is the surviving
    corporation), or sell, assign, transfer, lease, convey or otherwise
    dispose of all or substantially all of its properties or assets in one or
    more related transactions, to another corporation, Person or entity unless
    (i) the Company is the surviving corporation or the entity or the Person
    formed by or surviving any such consolidation or merger (if other than the
    Company) or to which such sale, assignment, transfer, lease, conveyance or
    other disposition shall have been made is a corporation organized or
    existing under the laws of the United States, any state thereof or the
    District of Columbia; (ii) the entity or Person formed by or surviving any
    such consolidation or merger (if other than the Company) or the entity or
    Person to which such sale, assignment, transfer, lease, conveyance or
    other disposition shall have been made assumes all the obligations of the
    Company under the Exchange Notes and the Indenture pursuant to a
    supplemental indenture in a form reasonably satisfactory to the Trustee;
    (iii) immediately after such transaction no Default or Event of Default
    exists; and (iv) except in the case of a merger of the Company with or
    into a Wholly Owned Restricted Subsidiary of the Company, the Company or
    the entity or Person formed by or surviving any such consolidation or
    merger (if other than the Company), or to which such sale, assignment,
    transfer, lease, conveyance or other disposition shall have been made,
    after giving pro forma effect to such transaction as if such transaction
    had occurred at the beginning of the most recently ended four full fiscal
    quarters for which internal financial statements are available immediately
    preceding such transaction either (A) would be permitted to incur at least
    $1.00 of additional Indebtedness pursuant to the Fixed Charge Coverage
    Ratio test set forth in the first paragraph of the covenant described
    above under the caption "--Incurrence of Indebtedness and Issuance of
    Preferred Stock" or (B) would have a pro forma Fixed Charge Coverage Ratio
    that is greater than the actual Fixed Charge Coverage Ratio for the same
    four-quarter period without giving pro forma effect to such transaction.

         Notwithstanding the foregoing clause (iv), (i) any Restricted
    Subsidiary may consolidate with, merge into or transfer all or part of its
    properties and assets to the Company and (ii) the Company may merge with
    an Affiliate that has no significant assets or liabilities and was
    incorporated solely for the purpose of reincorporating the Company in
    another State of the United States so long as the amount of Indebtedness
    of the Company and its Restricted Subsidiaries is not increased thereby.

    Transactions with Affiliates

         The Indenture will provide that the Company will not, and will not
    permit any of its Restricted Subsidiaries to, make any payment to, or
    sell, lease, transfer or otherwise dispose of any of its properties or
    assets to, or purchase any property or assets from, or enter into or make
    or amend any transaction, contract, agreement, understanding, loan,
    advance or guarantee with, or for the benefit of, any Affiliate (each of
    the foregoing, an "Affiliate Transaction"), unless (i) such Affiliate
    Transaction is on terms that are no less favorable to the Company or the
    relevant Restricted Subsidiary than those that would have been obtained in
    a comparable transaction by the Company or such Restricted Subsidiary with
    an unrelated Person and (ii) the Company delivers to the Trustee (A) with
<PAGE>
    respect to any Affiliate Transaction or series of related Affiliate
    Transactions involving aggregate consideration in excess of $3.0 million,
    a resolution of the Board of Directors set forth in an Officers'
    Certificate certifying that such Affiliate Transaction complies with
    clause (i) above and that such Affiliate Transaction has been approved by
    a majority of the disinterested members of the Board of Directors and
    (B) with respect to any Affiliate Transaction or series of related
    Affiliate Transactions involving aggregate consideration in excess of
    $10.0 million, an opinion as to the fairness to the Holders of such
    Affiliate Transaction from a financial point of view issued by an
    accounting, appraisal or investment banking firm of national standing.

         The foregoing provisions will not prohibit: (i) any employment
    agreement entered into by the Company or any of its Restricted
    Subsidiaries in the ordinary course of business; (ii) any transaction with
    a Lehman Investor; (iii) any transaction between or among the Company
    and/or its Restricted Subsidiaries; (iv) transactions between the Company
    or any of its Restricted Subsidiaries, on the one hand, and Lockheed
    Martin or any of its Subsidiaries, on the other hand, on terms that are
    not materially less favorable to the Company or the applicable Restricted
    Subsidiary of the Company than those that could have been obtained from an
    unaffiliated third party; provided that (A) in the case of any such
    transaction or series of related transactions pursuant to this clause
    (iv) involving aggregate consideration in excess of $1.0 million but less
    than $25.0 million, such transaction or series of transactions (or the
    agreement pursuant to which the transactions were executed) was approved
    by the Company's Chief Executive Officer or Chief Financial Officer and
    (B) in the case of any such transaction or series of related transactions
    pursuant to this clause (iv) involving aggregate consideration equal to or
    in excess of $25.0 million, such transaction or series of related
    transactions (or the agreement pursuant to which the transactions were
    executed) was approved by a majority of the disinterested members of the
    Board of Directors; (v) any transaction pursuant to and in accordance with
    the provisions of the Transaction Documents as the same are in effect on
    the Issue Date; and (vi) any Restricted Payment that is permitted by the
    provisions of the Indenture described above under the caption "--
    Restricted Payments".

    Payments for Consent

         The Indenture will provide that neither the Company nor any of its
    Subsidiaries will, directly or indirectly, pay or cause to be paid any
    consideration, whether by way of interest, fee or otherwise, to any Holder
    of any Exchange Notes for or as an inducement to any consent, waiver or
    amendment of any of the terms or provisions of the Indenture or the
    Exchange Notes unless such consideration is offered to be paid or is paid
    to all Holders of the Exchange Notes that consent, waive or agree to amend
    in the time frame set forth in the solicitation documents relating to such
    consent, waiver or agreement.

    Reports

         The Indenture will provide that, whether or not required by the
    rules and regulations of the Securities and Exchange Commission (the
    "Commission"), so long as any Exchange Notes are outstanding, the Company
    will furnish to the Holders of Exchange Notes (i) all quarterly and annual
    financial information that would be required to be contained in a filing
<PAGE>
    with the Commission on Forms 10-Q and 10-K if the Company were required to
    file such Forms, including a "Management's Discussion and Analysis of
    Financial Condition and Results of Operations" that describes the
    financial condition and results of operations of the Company and its
    consolidated Subsidiaries (showing in reasonable detail, either on the
    face of the financial statements or in the footnotes thereto and in
    Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of
    Operations, the financial condition and results of operations of the
    Company and its Restricted Subsidiaries separately from the financial
    condition and results of operations of the Unrestricted Subsidiaries of
    the Company) and, with respect to the annual information only, a report
    thereon by the Company's certified independent accountants and (ii) all
    current reports that would be required to be filed with the Commission on
    Form 8-K if the Company were required to file such reports, in each case
    within the time periods specified in the Commission's rules and
    regulations. In addition, whether or not required by the rules and
    regulations of the Commission, following the consummation of the Exchange
    Offer contemplated by the Registration Rights Agreement, the Company will
    file a copy of all such information and reports with the Commission for
    public availability within the time periods set forth in the Commission's
    rules and regulations (unless the Commission will not accept such a
    filing) and make such information available to securities analysts and
    prospective investors upon request. In addition, the Company and the
    Subsidiary Guarantors have agreed that, for so long as any Old Notes
    remain outstanding and are required to bear the transfer restriction
    legend, they will furnish to the Holders and to securities analysts and
    prospective investors, upon their request, the information required to be
    delivered pursuant to Rule 144A(d)(4) under the Securities Act.

    Future Subsidiary Guarantees

         The Company will not have any Subsidiaries as of the Issue Date.
    However, the Company's payment obligations under the Exchange Notes will
    be jointly and severally guaranteed by all of the Company's future
    Restricted Subsidiaries, other than Foreign Subsidiaries. The Indenture
    will provide that if the Company or any of its Subsidiaries shall acquire
    or create a Subsidiary (other than a Foreign Subsidiary or an Unrestricted
    Subsidiary) after the Issue Date, then such Subsidiary shall execute a
    Subsidiary Guarantee and deliver an opinion of counsel, in accordance with
    the terms of the Indenture. The Subsidiary Guarantee of each Guarantor
    will be subordinated to the prior payment in full of all Senior Debt of
    such Guarantor, which would include the guarantees of amounts borrowed
    under the Senior Credit Facilities. The obligations of each Guarantor
    under its Subsidiary Guarantee will be limited so as not to constitute a
    fraudulent conveyance under applicable law.

         The Indenture will provide that no Guarantor may consolidate with or
    merge with or into (whether or not such Guarantor is the surviving Person)
    another Person (except the Company or another Guarantor) unless
    (i) subject to the provisions of the following paragraph, the Person
    formed by or surviving any such consolidation or merger (if other than
    such Guarantor) or to which such sale, assignment, transfer, lease,
    conveyance or other disposition shall have been made assumes all the
    obligations of such Guarantor pursuant to a supplemental indenture in form
    and substance reasonably satisfactory to the Trustee, under the Exchange
    Notes and the Indenture; (ii) immediately after giving effect to such
<PAGE>
    transaction, no Default or Event of Default exists; and (iii) the Company
    (A) would be permitted by virtue of the Company's pro forma Fixed Charge
    Coverage Ratio, immediately after giving effect to such transaction, to
    incur at least $1.00 of additional Indebtedness pursuant to the Fixed
    Charge Coverage Ratio test set forth in the covenant described above under
    the caption "--Incurrence of Indebtedness and Issuance of Preferred Stock"
    or (B) would have a pro forma Fixed Charge Coverage Ratio that is greater
    than the actual Fixed Charge Coverage Ratio for the same four-quarter
    period without giving pro forma effect to such transaction.

         Notwithstanding the foregoing paragraph, (i) any Guarantor may
    consolidate with, merge into or transfer all or part of its properties and
    assets to the Company and (ii) any Guarantor may merge with an Affiliate
    that has no significant assets or liabilities and was incorporated solely
    for the purpose of reincorporating such Guarantor in another State of the
    United States so long as the amount of Indebtedness of the Company and its
    Restricted Subsidiaries is not increased thereby.

         The Indenture will provide that in the event of a sale or other
    disposition of all of the assets of any Guarantor, by way of merger,
    consolidation or otherwise, or a sale or other disposition of all of the
    capital stock of any Guarantor, then such Guarantor (in the event of a
    sale or other disposition, by way of such a merger, consolidation or
    otherwise, of all of the capital stock of such Guarantor) or the
    corporation acquiring the property (in the event of a sale or other
    disposition of all of the assets of such Guarantor) will be released and
    relieved of any obligations under its Subsidiary Guarantee; provided that
    the Net Proceeds of such sale or other disposition are applied in
    accordance with the applicable provisions of the Indenture. See
    "Redemption or Repurchase at Option of Holders--Asset Sales".

    Events of Default and Remedies

         The Indenture will provide that each of the following constitutes an
    Event of Default: (i) default for 30 days in the payment when due of
    interest on, or Liquidated Damages with respect to, the Exchange Notes
    (whether or not prohibited by the subordination provisions of the
    Indenture); (ii) default in payment when due of the principal of or
    premium, if any, on the Exchange Notes (whether or not prohibited by the
    subordination provisions of the Indenture); (iii) failure by the Company
    to comply with the provisions described under the captions "--Change of
    Control", "--Asset Sales" or "--Merger, Consolidation or Sale of Assets";
    (iv) failure by the Company for 60 days after notice to comply with any of
    its other agreements in the Indenture or the Exchange Notes; (v) default
    under any mortgage, indenture or instrument under which there may be
    issued or by which there may be secured or evidenced any Indebtedness for
    money borrowed by the Company or any of its Restricted Subsidiaries (or
    the payment of which is guaranteed by the Company or any of its Restricted
    Subsidiaries) whether such Indebtedness or guarantee now exists, or is
    created after the Issue Date, which default results in the acceleration of
    such Indebtedness prior to its express maturity and, in each case, the
    principal amount of any such Indebtedness, together with the principal
    amount of any other such Indebtedness the maturity of which has been so
    accelerated, aggregates $10.0 million or more; (vi) failure by the Company
    or any of its Restricted Subsidiaries to pay final judgments aggregating
    in excess of $10.0 million, which judgments are not paid, discharged or
<PAGE>
    stayed for a period of 60 days; (vii) certain events of bankruptcy or
    insolvency with respect to the Company or any of its Restricted
    Subsidiaries; and (viii) except as permitted by the Indenture, any
    Subsidiary Guarantee shall be held in any judicial proceeding to be
    unenforceable or invalid.

         If any Event of Default occurs and is continuing, the Trustee or the
    Holders of at least 25% in principal amount of the then outstanding
    Exchange Notes may declare all the Exchange Notes to be due and payable
    immediately; provided, however, that so long as any Designated Senior Debt
    is outstanding, such declaration shall not become effective until the
    earlier of (i) the day which is five Business Days after receipt by the
    Representatives of Designated Senior Debt of such notice of acceleration
    or (ii) the date of acceleration of any Designated Senior Debt.
    Notwithstanding the foregoing, in the case of an Event of Default arising
    from certain events of bankruptcy or insolvency, with respect to the
    Company or any Restricted Subsidiary, all outstanding Exchange Notes will
    become due and payable without further action or notice. Holders of the
    Exchange Notes may not enforce the Indenture or the Exchange Notes except
    as provided in the Indenture. Subject to certain limitations, Holders of a
    majority in principal amount of the then outstanding Exchange Notes may
    direct the Trustee in its exercise of any trust or power. The Trustee may
    withhold from Holders of the Exchange Notes notice of any continuing
    Default or Event of Default (except a Default or Event of Default relating
    to the payment of principal or interest) if it determines that withholding
    notice is in their interest.

         In the case of any Event of Default occurring by reason of any
    willful action (or inaction) taken (or not taken) by or on behalf of the
    Company with the intention of avoiding payment of the premium that the
    Company would have had to pay if the Company then had elected to redeem
    the Exchange Notes pursuant to the optional redemption provisions of the
    Indenture, an equivalent premium shall also become and be immediately due
    and payable to the extent permitted by law upon the acceleration of the
    Exchange Notes. If an Event of Default occurs prior to May 1, 2002 by
    reason of any willful action (or inaction) taken (or not taken) by or on
    behalf of the Company with the intention of avoiding the prohibition on
    redemption of the Exchange Notes prior to May 1, 2002, then the premium
    specified in the Indenture shall also become immediately due and payable
    to the extent permitted by law upon the acceleration of the Exchange
    Notes.

         The Holders of a majority in aggregate principal amount of the
    Exchange Notes then outstanding by notice to the Trustee may on behalf of
    the Holders of all of the Exchange Notes waive any existing Default or
    Event of Default and its consequences under the Indenture except a
    continuing Default or Event of Default in the payment of interest on, or
    the principal of, the Exchange Notes.

         The Company is required to deliver to the Trustee annually a
    statement regarding compliance with the Indenture, and the Company is
    required upon becoming aware of any Default or Event of Default, to
    deliver to the Trustee a statement specifying such Default or Event of
    Default.
<PAGE>
    No Personal Liability of Directors, Officers, Employees and Stockholders

         No director, officer, employee, incorporator or stockholder of the
    Company, as such, shall have any liability for any obligations of the
    Company under the Exchange Notes and the Indenture or for any claim based
    on, in respect of, or by reason of, such obligations or their creation.
    Each Holder of Exchange Notes by accepting a Note waives and releases all
    such liability. The waiver and release are part of the consideration for
    issuance of the Exchange Notes. Such waiver may not be effective to waive
    liabilities under the federal securities laws and it is the view of the
    Commission that such a waiver is against public policy.

    Legal Defeasance and Covenant Defeasance

         The Company may, at its option and at any time, elect to have all of
    its obligations discharged with respect to the outstanding Exchange Notes
    ("Legal Defeasance") except for (i) the rights of Holders of outstanding
    Exchange Notes to receive payments in respect of the principal of,
    premium, if any, and interest and Liquidated Damages on such Exchange
    Notes when such payments are due from the trust referred to below,
    (ii) the Company's obligations with respect to the Exchange Notes
    concerning issuing temporary Exchange Notes, registration of Exchange
    Notes, mutilated, destroyed, lost or stolen Exchange Notes and the
    maintenance of an office or agency for payment and money for security
    payments held in trust, (iii) the rights, powers, trusts, duties and
    immunities of the Trustee, and the Company's obligations in connection
    therewith and (iv) the Legal Defeasance provisions of the Indenture. In
    addition, the Company may, at its option and at any time, elect to have
    the obligations of the Company released with respect to certain covenants
    that are described in the Indenture ("Covenant Defeasance") and thereafter
    any omission to comply with such obligations shall not constitute a

    Default or Event of Default with respect to the Exchange Notes. In the
    event Covenant Defeasance occurs, certain events (not including
    non-payment, bankruptcy, receivership, rehabilitation and insolvency
    events) described under "Events of Default" will no longer constitute an
    Event of Default with respect to the Exchange Notes.

         In order to exercise either Legal Defeasance or Covenant Defeasance,
    (i) the Company must irrevocably deposit with the Trustee, in trust, for
    the benefit of the Holders of the Exchange Notes, cash in U.S. dollars,
    non-callable Government Securities, or a combination thereof, in such
    amounts as will be sufficient, in the opinion of a nationally recognized
    firm of independent public accountants, to pay the principal of, premium,
    if any, and interest and Liquidated Damages on the outstanding Exchange
    Notes on the stated maturity or on the applicable redemption date, as the
    case may be, and the Company must specify whether the Exchange Notes are
    being defeased to maturity or to a particular redemption date; (ii) in the
    case of Legal Defeasance, the Company shall have delivered to the Trustee
    an opinion of counsel in the United States reasonably acceptable to the
    Trustee confirming that (A) the Company has received from, or there has
    been published by, the Internal Revenue Service a ruling or (B) since the
    Issue Date, there has been a change in the applicable federal income tax
    law, in either case to the effect that, and based thereon such opinion of
    counsel shall confirm that, the Holders of the outstanding Exchange Notes
    will not recognize income, gain or loss for federal income tax purposes as
<PAGE>
    a result of such Legal Defeasance and will be subject to federal income
    tax on the same amounts, in the same manner and at the same times as would
    have been the case if such Legal Defeasance had not occurred; (iii) in the
    case of Covenant Defeasance, the Company shall have delivered to the
    Trustee an opinion of counsel in the United States reasonably acceptable
    to the Trustee confirming that the Holders of the outstanding Exchange
    Notes will not recognize income, gain or loss for federal income tax
    purposes as a result of such Covenant Defeasance and will be subject to
    federal income tax on the same amounts, in the same manner and at the same
    times as would have been the case if such Covenant Defeasance had not
    occurred; (iv) no Default or Event of Default shall have occurred and be
    continuing on the date of such deposit (other than a Default or Event of
    Default resulting from the borrowing of funds to be applied to such
    deposit) or insofar as Events of Default from bankruptcy or insolvency
    events are concerned, at any time in the period ending on the 91st day
    after the date of deposit; (v) such Legal Defeasance or Covenant
    Defeasance will not result in a breach or violation of, or constitute a
    default under any material agreement or instrument (other than the
    Indenture) to which the Company or any of its Subsidiaries is a party or
    by which the Company or any of its Subsidiaries is bound; (vi) the Company
    must have delivered to the Trustee an opinion of counsel to the effect
    that after the 91st day following the deposit, the trust funds will not be
    subject to the effect of any applicable bankruptcy, insolvency,
    reorganization or similar laws affecting creditors' rights generally;
    (vii) the Company must deliver to the Trustee an Officers' Certificate
    stating that the deposit was not made by the Company with the intent of
    preferring the Holders of Exchange Notes over the other creditors of the
    Company with the intent of defeating, hindering, delaying or defrauding
    creditors of the Company or others; and (viii) the Company must deliver to
    the Trustee an Officers' Certificate and an opinion of counsel, each
    stating that all conditions precedent provided for relating to the Legal
    Defeasance or the Covenant Defeasance have been complied with.

    Transfer and Exchange

         A Holder may transfer or exchange Exchange Notes in accordance with
    the Indenture. The Registrar and the Trustee may require a Holder, among
    other things, to furnish appropriate endorsements and transfer documents
    and the Company may require a Holder to pay any taxes and fees required by
    law or permitted by the Indenture. The Company is not required to transfer
    or exchange any Note selected for redemption. Also, the Company is not
    required to transfer or exchange any Note for a period of 15 days before a
    selection of Exchange Notes to be redeemed.

         The registered Holder of a Note will be treated as the owner of it
    for all purposes.

    Amendment, Supplement and Waiver

         Except as provided in the next two succeeding paragraphs, the
    Indenture or the Exchange Notes may be amended or supplemented with the
    consent of the Holders of at least a majority in principal amount of the
    Exchange Notes then outstanding (including, without limitation, consents
    obtained in connection with a purchase of, or tender offer or exchange
    offer for, Exchange Notes), and any existing default or compliance with
    any provision of the Indenture or the Exchange Notes may be waived with
<PAGE>
    the consent of the Holders of a majority in principal amount of the then
    outstanding Exchange Notes (including consents obtained in connection with
    a tender offer or exchange offer for Exchange Notes).

         Without the consent of each Holder affected, an amendment or waiver
    may not (with respect to any Exchange Notes held by a non-consenting
    Holder): (i) reduce the principal amount of Exchange Notes whose Holders
    must consent to an amendment, supplement or waiver, (ii) reduce the
    principal of or change the fixed maturity of any Note or alter the
    provisions with respect to the redemption of the Exchange Notes (other
    than provisions relating to the covenants described above under the
    caption "--Repurchase at the Option of Holders"), (iii) reduce the rate of
    or change the time for payment of interest on any Note, (iv) waive a
    Default or Event of Default in the payment of principal of or premium, if
    any, or interest on the Exchange Notes (except a rescission of
    acceleration of the Exchange Notes by the Holders of at least a majority
    in aggregate principal amount of the Exchange Notes and a waiver of the
    payment default that resulted from such acceleration), (v) make any Note
    payable in money other than that stated in the Exchange Notes, (vi) make
    any change in the provisions of the Indenture relating to waivers of past
    Defaults or the rights of Holders of Exchange Notes to receive payments of
    principal of or premium, if any, or interest on the Exchange Notes,
    (vii) waive a redemption payment with respect to any Note (other than a
    payment required by one of the covenants described above under the caption
    "--Repurchase at the Option of Holders") or (viii) make any change in the
    foregoing amendment and waiver provisions. In addition, any amendment to
    the provisions of Article 10 of the Indenture (which relates to
    subordination) will require the consent of the Holders of at least 75% in
    aggregate principal amount of the Exchange Notes then outstanding if such
    amendment would adversely affect the rights of Holders of Exchange Notes.

         Notwithstanding the foregoing, without the consent of any Holder of
    Exchange Notes, the Company and the Trustee may amend or supplement the
    Indenture or the Exchange Notes to cure any ambiguity, defect or
    inconsistency, to provide for uncertificated Exchange Notes in addition to
    or in place of certificated Exchange Notes, to provide for the assumption
    of the Company's obligations to Holders of Exchange Notes in the case of a
    merger or consolidation, to make any change that would provide any
    additional rights or benefits to the Holders of Exchange Notes or that
    does not adversely affect the legal rights under the Indenture of any such
    Holder, or to comply with requirements of the Commission in order to
    effect or maintain the qualification of the Indenture under the Trust
    Indenture Act.

    Concerning the Trustee

         The Indenture contains certain limitations on the rights of the
    Trustee, should it become a creditor of the Company, to obtain payment of
    claims in certain cases, or to realize on certain property received in
    respect of any such claim as security or otherwise. The Trustee will be
    permitted to engage in other transactions; however, if it acquires any
    conflicting interest it must eliminate such conflict within 90 days, apply
    to the Commission for permission to continue or resign.

         The Holders of a majority in principal amount of the then
    outstanding Exchange Notes will have the right to direct the time, method
    and place of conducting any proceeding for exercising any remedy available
<PAGE>
    to the Trustee, subject to certain exceptions. The Indenture provides that
    in case an Event of Default shall occur (which shall not be cured), the
    Trustee will be required, in the exercise of its power, to use the degree
    of care of a prudent man in the conduct of his own affairs. Subject to
    such provisions, the Trustee will be under no obligation to exercise any
    of its rights or powers under the Indenture at the request of any Holder
    of Exchange Notes, unless such Holder shall have offered to the Trustee
    security and indemnity satisfactory to it against any loss, liability or
    expense.

    Book-Entry, Delivery and Form

         The certificates representing the Exchange Notes will be issued in
    fully registered form and will be deposited with the Trustee as custodian
    for The Depository Trust Company, New York, New York (The "Depository"),
    and registered in the name of a nominee of the Depository.

    Depository Procedures

         The Depository has advised the Company that the Depository is a
    limited-purpose trust company created to hold securities for its
    participating organizations (collectively, the "Participants") and to
    facilitate the clearance and settlement of transactions in those
    securities between Participants through electronic book-entry changes in
    accounts of Participants. The Participants include securities brokers and
    dealers (including the Initial Purchasers), banks, trust companies,
    clearing corporations and certain other organizations. Access to the
    Depository's system is also available to other entities such as banks,
    brokers, dealers and trust companies that clear through or maintain a
    custodial relationship with a Participant, either directly or indirectly
    (collectively, "Indirect Participants"). Persons who are not Participants
    may beneficially own securities held by or on behalf of the Depository
    only through the Participants or Indirect Participants. The ownership
    interest and transfer of ownership interest of each actual purchaser of
    each security held by or on behalf of the Depository are recorded on the
    records of the Participants and Indirect Participants.

         The Depository has also advised the Company that pursuant to
    procedures established by it, (i) upon deposit of the Global Exchange
    Notes, the Depository will credit the accounts of Participants designated
    by the Initial Purchasers with portions of the principal amount of Global
    Exchange Notes and (ii) ownership of such interests in the Global Exchange
    Notes will be shown on, and the transfer of ownership thereof will be
    effected only through, records maintained by the Depository (with respect
    to Participants) or by Participants and the Indirect Participants (with
    respect to other owners of beneficial interests in the Global Exchange
    Notes).

         Investors in the Global Note may hold their interests therein
    directly through the Depository, if they are Participants in such system,
    or indirectly through organizations (including Euroclear and CEDEL) that
    are Participants in such system. Investors in the Regulation S Global Note
    may hold their interests therein through Euroclear or CEDEL, if they are
    participants in such systems, or indirectly through organizations that are
    participants in such systems or in the Depository system. Euroclear and
    CEDEL will hold interests in the Regulation S Global Note on behalf of
<PAGE>
    their Participants through customers' securities accounts in their
    respective names on the books of their respective depositories, which are
    Morgan Guaranty Trust Company of New York, Brussels office, as operator of
    Euroclear, and Citibank, N.A. as operator of CEDEL. The depositories, in
    turn, will hold such interests in the Regulation S Global Note in
    customers' securities accounts in the depositories' names on the books of
    the Depository. All interests in a Global Note, including those held
    through Euroclear or CEDEL, may be subject to the procedures and
    requirements of the Depository. Those interests held by Euroclear or CEDEL
    may be also be subject to the procedures and requirements of such system.

         The laws of some states require that certain persons take physical
    delivery in definitive form of securities that they own. Consequently, the
    ability to transfer beneficial interest in a Global Note to such persons
    may be limited to that extent. Because the Depository can act only on
    behalf of Participants, which in turn act on behalf of Indirect
    Participants and certain banks, the ability of a person having a
    beneficial interest in a Global Note to pledge such interest to persons or
    entities that do not participate in the Depository system, or otherwise
    take actions in respect of such interests, may be affected by the lack of
    physical certificate evidencing such interests. For certain other
    restrictions on the transferability of the Exchange Notes see, "--Exchange
    of Book-Entry Exchange Notes for Certificated Exchange Notes".

         Except as described below, owners of interests in the Global
    Exchange Notes will not have Exchange Notes registered in their names,
    will not receive physical delivery of Exchange Notes in certificated form
    and will not be considered the registered owners or Holders thereof under
    the Indenture for any purpose.

         Payments in respect of the principal and premium and interest on a
    Global Note registered in the name of the Depository or its nominee will
    be payable by the Trustee to the Depository or its nominee in its capacity
    as the registered Holder under the Indenture. Under the terms of the
    Indenture, the Company and the Trustee will treat the persons in whose
    names the Exchange Notes, including the Global Exchange Notes, are
    registered as the owners thereof for the purpose of receiving such
    payments and for any and all other purposes whatsoever. Consequently,
    neither the Company, the Trustee nor any agent of the Company or the
    Trustee has or will have any responsibility or liability for (i) any
    aspect of the Depository's records or any Participant's or Indirect
    Participant's records relating to or payments made on account of
    beneficial ownership interests in the Global Exchange Notes, or for
    maintaining, supervising or reviewing any of the Depository's records or
    any Participant's or Indirect Participant's records relating to the
    beneficial ownership interests in the Global Exchange Notes or (ii) any
    other matter relating to the actions and practices of the Depository or
    any of its Participants or Indirect Participants.

         The Depository has advised the Company that its current practices,
    upon receipt of any payment in respect of securities such as the Exchange
    Notes (including principal and interest), is to credit the accounts of the
    relevant Participants with the payment on the payment date, in amounts
    proportionate to their respective holdings in principal amount of
    beneficial interests in the relevant security such as the Global Exchange
    Notes as shown on the records of the Depository. Payments by Participants
<PAGE>
    and the Indirect Participants to the beneficial owners of Exchange Notes
    will be governed by standing instructions and customary practices and will
    not be the responsibility of the Depository, the Trustee or the Company.
    Neither the Company nor the Trustee will be liable for any delay by the
    Depository or its Participants in identifying the beneficial owners of the
    Exchange Notes, and the Company and the Trustee may conclusively rely on
    and will be protected in relying on instructions from the Depository or
    its nominee as the registered owner of the Exchange Notes for all
    purposes.

         Except for trades involving only Euroclear and CEDEL participants,
    interests in the Global Exchange Notes will trade in the Depository's
    Same-Day Funds Settlement System and secondary market trading activity in
    such interests will, therefore, settle in immediately available funds,
    subject in all cases to the rules and procedures of the Depository and its
    participants.

         Transfers between Participants in the Depository will be effected in
    accordance with the Depository's procedures, and will be settled in
    same-day funds. Transfers between participants in Euroclear and CEDEL will
    be effected in the ordinary way in accordance with their respective rules
    and operating procedures.

         Subject to compliance with the transfer restrictions applicable to
    the Exchange Notes described herein, crossmarket transfers between
    Participants in the Depository, on the one hand, and Euroclear or CEDEL
    participants, on the other hand, will be effected through the Depository
    in accordance with the Depository's rules on behalf of Euroclear or CEDEL,
    as the case may be, by its respective depository; however, such
    cross-market transactions will require delivery of instructions to
    Euroclear or CEDEL, as the case may be, by the counterparty in such system
    in accordance with the rules and procedures and within the established
    deadlines (Brussels time) of such system. Euroclear or CEDEL, as the case
    may be, will, if the transaction meets its settlement requirements,
    deliver instructions to its respective depository to take action to effect
    final settlement on its behalf by delivering or receiving interests in the
    relevant Global Note in the Depository, and making or receiving payment in
    accordance with normal procedures for same-day fund settlement applicable
    the Depository. Euroclear participants and CEDEL participants may not
    deliver instructions directly to the Depositaries for Euroclear or CEDEL.

         Because of time zone differences, the securities accounts of a
    Euroclear or CEDEL participant purchasing an interest in a Global Note
    from a Participant in the Depository will be credited, and any such
    crediting will be reported to the relevant Euroclear or CEDEL participant,
    during the securities settlement processing day (which must be a business
    day for Euroclear or CEDEL) immediately following the settlement date of
    the Depository. Cash received in Euroclear or CEDEL as a result of sales
    of interests in a Global Note by or through a Euroclear or CEDEL
    participant to a Participant in the Depository will be received with value
    on the settlement date of the Depository but will be available in the
    relevant Euroclear or CEDEL cash account only as of the business day for
    Euroclear or CEDEL following the Depository's settlement date.

         The Depository has advised the Company that it will take any action
    permitted to be taken by a Holder of Exchange Notes only at the direction
    of one or more Participants to whose account the Depository interests in
<PAGE>
    the Global Exchange Notes are credited and only in respect of such portion
    of the aggregate principal amount of the Exchange Notes as to which such
    Participant or Participants has or have given direction. However, if there
    is an Event of Default under the Exchange Notes, the Depository reserves
    the right to exchange Global Exchange Notes for legended Exchange Notes in

    certificated form, and to distribute such Exchange Notes to its
    Participants.

         The information in this section concerning the Depository, Euroclear
    and CEDEL and their book-entry systems has been obtained from sources that
    the Company believes to be reliable, but the Company takes no
    responsibility for the accuracy thereof.

         Although the Depository, Euroclear and CEDEL have agreed to the
    foregoing procedures to facilitate transfers of interests in the Global
    Note among participants in the Depository, Euroclear and CEDEL, they are
    under no obligation to perform or to continue to perform such procedures,
    and such procedures may be discontinued at any time. None of the Company,
    the Initial Purchasers or the Trustee will have any responsibility for the
    performance by the Depository, Euroclear or CEDEL or their respective
    participants or indirect participants of their respective obligations
    under the rules and procedures governing their operations.

    Exchange of Book-Entry Exchange Notes for Certificated Exchange Notes

         A Global Note is exchangeable for definitive Exchange Notes in
    registered certificated form if (i) the Depository (A) notifies the
    Company that it is unwilling or unable to continue as depository for the
    Global Note and the Company thereupon fails to appoint a successor
    depository or (B) has ceased to be a clearing agency registered under the
    Exchange Act or (ii) the Company, at its option, notifies the Trustee in
    writing that it elects to cause issuance of the Exchange Notes in
    certificated form. In addition, beneficial interests in a Global Note may
    be exchanged for certificated Exchange Notes upon request but only upon at
    least 20 days prior written notice given to the Trustee by or on behalf of
    the Depository in accordance with customary procedures. In all cases,
    certificated Exchange Notes delivered in exchange for any Global Note or
    beneficial interest therein will be registered in names, and issued in any
    approved denominations, requested by or on behalf of the Depository (in
    accordance with its customary procedures).

    Certificated Exchange Notes

         Subject to certain conditions, any person having a beneficial
    interest in the Global Note may, upon request to the Trustee, exchange
    such beneficial interest for Exchange Notes in the form of certificated
    Exchange Notes. Upon any such issuance, the Trustee is required to
    register such certificated Exchange Notes in the name of, and cause the
    same to be delivered to, such person or persons (or the nominee of any
    thereof). In addition, if (i) the Company notifies the Trustee in writing
    that the Depository is no longer willing or able to act as a depository
    and the Company is unable to locate a qualified successor within 90 days
    or (ii) the Company, at its option, notifies the Trustee in writing that
    it elects to cause the issuance of Exchange Notes in the form of
    certificated Exchange Notes under the Indenture, then, upon surrender by
<PAGE>
    the Global Note Holder of its Global Note, Exchange Notes in such form
    will be issued to each person that the Global Note Holder and the
    Depository identify as being the beneficial owner of the related Exchange
    Notes.

         Neither the Company nor the Trustee will be liable for any delay by
    the Global Note Holder or the Depository in identifying the beneficial
    owners of Exchange Notes and the Company and the Trustee may conclusively
    rely on, and will be protected in relying on, instructions from the Global
    Note Holder or the Depository for all purposes.

    Same Day Settlement and Payment

         The Indenture will require that payments in respect of the Exchange
    Notes represented by the Global Note (including principal, premium, if
    any, interest) be made by wire transfer of immediately available funds to
    the accounts specified by the Global Note Holder. With respect to
    certificated Exchange Notes, the Company will make all payments of
    principal, premium, if any, and interest by wire transfer of immediately
    available funds to the accounts specified by the Holders thereof or, if no
    such account is specified, by mailing a check to each such Holder's
    registered address. The Company expects that secondary trading in the
    certificated Exchange Notes will also be settled in immediately available
    funds.

    Registration Rights; Liquidated Damages

         The Company and the Initial Purchasers entered into the Registration
    Rights Agreement on the Issue Date. Pursuant to the Registration Rights
    Agreement, the Company agreed to file with the Commission the Exchange
    Offer Registration Statement on the appropriate form under the Securities
    Act with respect to the Exchange Notes. Upon the effectiveness of the
    Exchange Offer Registration Statement, the Company will offer to the
    Holders of Transfer Restricted Securities pursuant to the Exchange Offer
    who are able to make certain representations the opportunity to exchange
    their Transfer Restricted Securities for Exchange Notes. If (i) the
    Company is not required to file the Exchange Offer Registration Statement
    or permitted to consummate the Exchange Offer because the Exchange Offer
    is not permitted by applicable law or Commission policy or (ii) any Holder
    of Transfer Restricted Securities notifies the Company prior to the 20th
    day following consummation of the Exchange Offer that (A) it is prohibited
    by law or Commission policy from participating in the Exchange Offer or
    (B) that it may not resell the Exchange Notes acquired by it in the
    Exchange Offer to the public without delivering a prospectus and the
    prospectus contained in the Exchange Offer Registration Statement is not
    appropriate or available for such resales or (C) that it is a
    broker-dealer and owns Old Notes acquired directly from the Company or an
    affiliate of the Company, the Company will file with the Commission a
    Shelf Registration Statement to cover resales of the Exchange Notes by the
    Holders thereof who satisfy certain conditions relating to the provision
    of information in connection with the Shelf Registration Statement. The
    Company will use its best efforts to cause the applicable registration
    statement to be declared effective as promptly as possible by the
    Commission. For purposes of the foregoing, "Transfer Restricted
    Securities" means each Old Note until (i) the date on which such Old Note
    has been exchanged by a person other than a broker-dealer for an Exchange
<PAGE>
    Note in the Exchange Offer, (ii) following the exchange by a broker-dealer
    in the Exchange Offer of an Old Note for an Exchange Note, the date on
    which such Exchange Note is sold to a purchaser who receives from such
    broker-dealer on or prior to the date of such sale a copy of the
    prospectus contained in the Exchange Offer Registration Statement,
    (iii) the date on which such Old Note has been effectively registered
    under the Securities Act and disposed of in accordance with the Shelf
    Registration Statement or (iv) the date on which such Old Note is
    distributed to the public pursuant to Rule 144 under the Act.

         The Registration Rights Agreement provides that (i) the Company will
    file an Exchange Offer Registration Statement with the Commission on or
    prior to 90 days after the Issue Date, (ii) the Company will use its best
    efforts to have the Exchange Offer Registration Statement declared
    effective by the Commission on or prior to 150 days after the Issue Date,
    (iii) unless the Exchange Offer would not be permitted by applicable law
    or Commission policy, the Company will commence the Exchange Offer and use
    its best efforts to issue on or prior to 30 business days after the date
    on which the Exchange Offer Registration Statement was declared effective
    by the Commission, New Exchange Notes in exchange for all Exchange Notes
    tendered prior thereto in the Exchange Offer and (iv) if obligated to file
    the Shelf Registration Statement, the Company will use its best efforts to
    file the Shelf Registration Statement with the Commission on or prior to
    30 days after such filing obligation arises and to cause the Shelf
    Registration Statement to be declared effective by the Commission on or
    prior to 90 days after such obligation arises. If (A) the Company fails to
    file any of the Registration Statements required by the Registration
    Rights Agreement on or before the date specified above for such filing,
    (B) any of such Registration Statements is not declared effective by the
    Commission on or prior to the date specified for such effectiveness (the
    "Effectiveness Target Date"), (C) the Company fails to consummate the
    Exchange Offer within 30 business days of the Effectiveness Target Date
    with respect to the Exchange Offer Registration Statement, or (D) the
    Shelf Registration Statement or the Exchange Offer Registration Statement
    is declared effective but thereafter ceases to be effective or usable in
    connection with resales of Transfer Restricted Securities during the
    periods specified in the Registration Rights Agreement (each such event
    referred to in clauses (A) through (D) above a "Registration Default"),
    then the Company will pay Liquidated Damages to each Holder of Old Notes,
    with respect to the first 90-day period immediately following the
    occurrence of the first Registration Default in an amount equal to $.05
    per week per $1,000 principal amount of Old Notes held by such Holder. The
    amount of the Liquidated Damages will increase by an additional $.05 per
    week per $1,000 principal amount of Old Notes with respect to each
    subsequent 90-day period until all Registration Defaults have been cured,
    up to a maximum amount of Liquidated Damages of $.50 per week per $1,000
    principal amount of Old Notes. All accrued Liquidated Damages will be paid
    by the Company on each Damages Payment Date to the Global Note Holder by
    wire transfer of immediately available funds or by federal funds check and
    to Holders of certificated Old Notes by wire transfer to the accounts
    specified by them or by mailing checks to their registered addresses if no
    such accounts have been specified. Following the cure of all Registration
    Defaults, the accrual of Liquidated Damages will cease.

         Holders of Old Notes will be required to make certain
    representations to the Company (as described in the Registration Rights
    Agreement) in order to participate in the Exchange Offer and will be
<PAGE>
    required to deliver information to be used in connection with the Shelf
    Registration Statement and to provide comments on the Shelf Registration
    Statement within the time periods set forth in the Registration Rights
    Agreement in order to have their Old Notes included in the Shelf
    Registration Statement and benefit from the provisions regarding
    Liquidated Damages set forth above.

    Certain Definitions

         Set forth below are certain defined terms used in the Indenture.
    Reference is made to the Indenture for a full disclosure of all such
    terms, as well as any other capitalized terms used herein for which no
    definition is provided.

         "Acquired Debt" means, with respect to any specified Person,
    (i) Indebtedness of any other Person existing at the time such other
    Person is merged with or into or became a Subsidiary of such specified
    Person, including, without limitation, Indebtedness incurred in connection
    with, or in contemplation of, such other Person merging with or into or
    becoming a Subsidiary of such specified Person, and (ii) Indebtedness
    secured by a Lien encumbering any asset acquired by such specified Person.

         "Affiliate" of any specified Person means any other Person directly
    or indirectly controlling or controlled by or under direct or indirect
    common control with such specified Person. For purposes of this
    definition, "control" (including, with correlative meanings, the terms
    "controlling", "controlled by" and "under common control with"), as used
    with respect to any Person, shall mean the possession, directly or
    indirectly, of the power to direct or cause the direction of the
    management or policies of such Person, whether through the ownership of
    voting securities, by agreement or otherwise; provided that beneficial
    ownership of 10% or more of the voting securities of a Person shall be
    deemed to be control.

         "Asset Sale" means (i) the sale, lease, conveyance or other
    disposition of any assets or rights (including, without limitation, by way
    of a sale and leaseback) other than sales of inventory in the ordinary
    course of business consistent with past practices (provided that the sale,
    lease, conveyance or other disposition of all or substantially all of the
    assets of the Company and its Restricted Subsidiaries taken as a whole
    will be governed by the provisions of the Indenture described above under
    the caption "--Change of Control" and/or the provisions described above
    under the caption "--Merger, Consolidation or Sale of Assets" and not by
    the provisions of the Asset Sale covenant), and (ii) the issue or sale by
    the Company or any of its Subsidiaries of Equity Interests of any of the
    Company's Restricted Subsidiaries, in the case of either clause (i) or
    (ii), whether in a single transaction or a series of related transactions
    (A) that have a fair market value in excess of $1.0 million or (B) for net
    proceeds in excess of $1.0 million. Notwithstanding the foregoing: (i) a
    transfer of assets by the Company to a Restricted Subsidiary or by a
    Restricted Subsidiary to the Company or to another Restricted Subsidiary,
    (ii) an issuance of Equity Interests by a Restricted Subsidiary to the
    Company or to another Restricted Subsidiary, (iii) a Restricted Payment
    that is permitted by the covenant described above under the caption "--
    Restricted Payments" and (iv) a disposition of Cash Equivalents in the
    ordinary course of business will not be deemed to be an Asset Sale.
<PAGE>
         "Attributable Debt" in respect of a sale and leaseback transaction
    means, at the time of determination, the present value (discounted at the
    rate of interest implicit in such transaction, determined in accordance
    with GAAP) of the obligation of the lessee for net rental payments during
    the remaining term of the lease included in such sale and leaseback
    transaction (including any period for which such lease has been extended
    or may, at the option of the lessor, be extended).

         "Capital Lease Obligation" means, at the time any determination
    thereof is to be made, the amount of the liability in respect of a capital
    lease that would at such time be required to be capitalized on a balance
    sheet in accordance with GAAP.

         "Capital Stock" means (i) in the case of a corporation, corporate
    stock, (ii) in the case of an association or business entity, any and all
    shares, interests, participations, rights or other equivalents (however
    designated) of corporate stock, (iii) in the case of a partnership or
    limited liability company, partnership or membership interests (whether
    general or limited) and (iv) any other interest or participation that
    confers on a Person the right to receive a share of the profits and losses
    of, or distributions of assets of, the issuing Person.

         "Cash Equivalents" means (i) United States dollars, (ii) securities
    issued or directly and fully guaranteed or insured by the United States
    government or any agency or instrumentality thereof having maturities of
    not more than one year from the date of acquisition, (iii) certificates of
    deposit and eurodollar time deposits with maturities of six months or less
    from the date of acquisition, bankers' acceptances with maturities not
    exceeding six months and overnight bank deposits, in each case with any
    domestic financial institution to the Senior Credit Facilities or with any
    domestic commercial bank having capital and surplus in excess of $500.0
    million and a Thompson Bank Watch Rating of "B" or better, (iv) repurchase
    obligations with a term of not more than seven days for underlying
    securities of the types described in clauses (ii) and (iii) above entered
    into with any financial institution meeting the qualifications specified
    in clause (iii) above, (v) commercial paper having the highest rating
    obtainable from Moody's or S&P's and in each case maturing within six
    months after the date of acquisition, (vi) investment funds investing 95%
    of their assets in securities of the types described in clauses (i)-(v)
    above, and (vii) readily marketable direct obligations issued by any State
    of the United States of America or any political subdivision thereof
    having maturities of not more than one year from the date of acquisition
    and having one of the two highest rating categories obtainable from either
    Moody's or S&P.

         "Consolidated Cash Flow" means, with respect to any Person for any
    period, the Consolidated Net Income of such Person for such period plus
    (i) an amount equal to any extraordinary loss plus any net loss realized
    in connection with an Asset Sale (to the extent such losses were deducted
    in computing such Consolidated Net Income), plus (ii) provision for taxes
    based on income or profits of such Person and its Restricted Subsidiaries
    for such period, to the extent that such provision for taxes was included
    in computing such Consolidated Net Income, plus (iii) consolidated
    interest expense of such Person and its Restricted Subsidiaries for such
    period, whether paid or accrued and whether or not capitalized (including,
    without limitation, original issue discount, non-cash interest payments,
<PAGE>
    the interest component of any deferred payment obligations, the interest
    component of all payments associated with Capital Lease Obligations,
    imputed interest with respect to Attributable Debt, commissions, discounts
    and other fees and charges incurred in respect of letter of credit or
    bankers' acceptance financings, and net payments (if any) pursuant to
    Hedging Obligations), to the extent that any such expense was deducted in
    computing such Consolidated Net Income, plus (iv) depreciation,
    amortization (including amortization of goodwill, debt issuance costs and
    other intangibles but excluding amortization of other prepaid cash
    expenses that were paid in a prior period) and other non-cash expenses
    (excluding any such non-cash expense to the extent that it represents an
    accrual of or reserve for cash expenses in any future period or
    amortization of a prepaid cash expense that was paid in a prior period) of
    such Person and its Restricted Subsidiaries for such period to the extent
    that such depreciation, amortization and other non-cash expenses were
    deducted in computing such Consolidated Net Income, minus (v) non-cash
    items increasing such Consolidated Net Income for such period, in each
    case, on a consolidated basis and determined in accordance with GAAP.

         "Consolidated Net Income" means, with respect to any Person for any
    period, the aggregate of the Net Income of such Person and its Restricted
    Subsidiaries for such period, on a consolidated basis, determined in
    accordance with GAAP; provided that (i) the Net Income of any Person that
    is not a Restricted Subsidiary or that is accounted for by the equity
    method of accounting shall be included only to the extent of the amount of
    dividends or distributions paid in cash to the referent Person or a
    Restricted Subsidiary thereof that is a Guarantor, (ii) the Net Income of
    any Restricted Subsidiary shall be excluded to the extent that the
    declaration or payment of dividends or similar distributions by that
    Restricted Subsidiary of that Net Income is not at the date of
    determination permitted without any prior governmental approval (that has
    not been obtained) or, directly or indirectly, by operation of the terms
    of its charter or any agreement, instrument, judgment, decree, order,
    statute, rule or governmental regulation applicable to that Restricted
    Subsidiary or its stockholders, (iii) the Net Income of any Person
    acquired in a pooling of interests transaction for any period prior to the
    date of such acquisition shall be excluded, (iv) the cumulative effect of
    a change in accounting principles shall be excluded, (v) the Net Income of
    any Unrestricted Subsidiary shall be excluded, whether or not distributed
    to the Company or one of its Restricted Subsidiaries, and (vi) the Net
    Income of any Restricted Subsidiary shall be calculated after deducting
    preferred stock dividends payable by such Restricted Subsidiary to Persons
    other than the Company and its other Restricted Subsidiaries.

         "Consolidated Net Tangible Assets" means, as of any date of
    determination, shareholders' equity of the Company and its Restricted
    Subsidiaries, determined on a consolidated basis in accordance with GAAP,
    less goodwill and other intangibles (other than patents, trademarks,
    licenses, copyrights and other intellectual property and prepaid assets).

         "Credit Facilities" means, with respect to the Company, one or more
    debt facilities (including, without limitation, the Senior Credit
    Facilities) or commercial paper facilities with banks or other
    institutional lenders providing for revolving credit loans, term loans,
    receivables financing (including through the sale of receivables to such
    lenders or to special purpose entities formed to borrow from such lenders
<PAGE>
    against such receivables) or letters of credit, in each case, as amended,
    restated, modified, renewed, refunded, replaced or refinanced in whole or
    in part from time to time.

         "Default" means any event that is, or with the passage of time or
    the giving of notice or both would be, an Event of Default.

         "Designated Senior Debt" means (i) any Indebtedness outstanding
    under the Senior Credit Facilities and (ii) any other Senior Debt
    permitted under the Indenture the principal amount of which is $25.0
    million or more and that has been designated by the Company as "Designated
    Senior Debt".

         "Disqualified Stock" means any Capital Stock that, by its terms (or
    by the terms of any security into which it is convertible or for which it
    is exchangeable at the option of the holder thereof), or upon the
    happening of any event, matures or is mandatorily redeemable, pursuant to
    a sinking fund obligation or otherwise, or redeemable at the option of the
    Holder thereof, in whole or in part, on or prior to the date that is 91
    days after the date on which the Exchange Notes mature; provided, however,
    that if such Capital Stock is issued to any plan for the benefit of
    employees of the Company or its Subsidiaries or by any such plan to such
    employees, such Capital Stock shall not constitute Disqualified Stock
    solely because it may be required to be repurchased by the Company in
    order to satisfy applicable statutory or regulatory obligations.

         "Equity Interests" means Capital Stock and all warrants, options or
    other rights to acquire Capital Stock (but excluding any debt security
    that is convertible into, or exchangeable for, Capital Stock).

         "Equity Offering" means any public or private sale of equity
    securities (excluding Disqualified Stock) of the Company or Holdings,
    other than any private sales to an Affiliate of the Company or Holdings.

         "Existing Indebtedness" means any Indebtedness of the Company (other
    than Indebtedness under the Senior Credit Facilities and the Exchange
    Notes) in existence on the Issue Date, until such amounts are repaid.

         "Fixed Charges" means, with respect to any Person for any period,
    the sum, without duplication, of (i) the consolidated interest expense of
    such Person and its Restricted Subsidiaries for such period, whether paid
    or accrued (including, without limitation, original issue discount,
    non-cash interest payments, the interest component of any deferred payment
    obligations, the interest component of all payments associated with
    Capital Lease Obligations, imputed interest with respect to Attributable
    Debt, commissions, discounts and other fees and charges incurred in
    respect of letter of credit or bankers' acceptance financings, and net
    payments (if any) pursuant to Hedging Obligations, but excluding
    amortization of debt issuance costs) and (ii) the consolidated interest of
    such Person and its Restricted Subsidiaries that was capitalized during
    such period, and (iii) any interest expense on Indebtedness of another
    Person that is guaranteed by such Person or one of its Restricted
    Subsidiaries or secured by a Lien on assets of such Person or one of its
    Restricted Subsidiaries (whether or not such Guarantee or Lien is called
    upon) and (iv) the product of (A) all dividend payments, whether or not in
    cash, on any series of preferred stock of such Person or any of its
<PAGE>
    Restricted Subsidiaries, other than dividend payments on Equity Interests
    payable solely in Equity Interests of the Company, times (B) a fraction,
    the numerator of which is one and the denominator of which is one minus
    the then current combined federal, state and local statutory tax rate of
    such Person, expressed as a decimal, in each case, on a consolidated basis
    and in accordance with GAAP.

         "Fixed Charge Coverage Ratio" means with respect to any Person for
    any period, the ratio of the Consolidated Cash Flow of such Person for
    such period to the Fixed Charges of such Person and its Restricted
    Subsidiaries for such period. In the event that the Company or any of its
    Restricted Subsidiaries incurs, assumes, Guarantees or redeems any
    Indebtedness (other than revolving credit borrowings) or issues preferred
    stock subsequent to the commencement of the period for which the Fixed
    Charge Coverage Ratio is being calculated but on or prior to the date on
    which the event for which the calculation of the Fixed Charge Coverage
    Ratio is made (the "Calculation Date"), then the Fixed Charge Coverage
    Ratio shall be calculated giving pro forma effect to such incurrence,
    assumption, Guarantee or redemption of Indebtedness, or such issuance or
    redemption of preferred stock, as if the same had occurred at the
    beginning of the applicable four-quarter reference period. In addition,
    for purposes of making the computation referred to above, (i) acquisitions
    that have been made by the Company or any of its Restricted Subsidiaries,
    including through mergers or consolidations and including any related
    financing transactions, during the four-quarter reference period or
    subsequent to such reference period and on or prior to the Calculation
    Date shall be deemed to have occurred on the first day of the four-quarter
    reference period and Consolidated Cash Flow for such reference period
    shall be calculated without giving effect to clause (iii) of the proviso
    set forth in the definition of Consolidated Net Income, and (ii) the
    Consolidated Cash Flow attributable to discontinued operations, as
    determined in accordance with GAAP, and operations or businesses disposed
    of prior to the Calculation Date, shall be excluded, and (iii) the Fixed
    Charges attributable to discontinued operations, as determined in
    accordance with GAAP, and operations or businesses disposed of prior to
    the Calculation Date, shall be excluded, but only to the extent that the
    obligations giving rise to such Fixed Charges will not be obligations of
    the referent Person or any of its Restricted Subsidiaries following the
    Calculation Date.

         "Foreign Subsidiary" means a Restricted Subsidiary of the Company
    that was not organized or existing under the laws of the United States,
    any state thereof, the District of Columbia or any territory thereof.

         "GAAP" means generally accepted accounting principles set forth in
    the opinions and pronouncements of the Accounting Principles Board of the
    American Institute of Certified Public Accountants and statements and
    pronouncements of the Financial Accounting Standards Board or in such
    other statements by such other entity as have been approved by a
    significant segment of the accounting profession, which are in effect on
    the Issue Date.

         "Guarantee" means a guarantee (other than by endorsement of
    negotiable instruments for collection in the ordinary course of business),
    direct or indirect, in any manner (including, without limitation, letters
    of credit and reimbursement agreements in respect thereof), of all or any
    part of any Indebtedness.
<PAGE>
         "Guarantors" means each Subsidiary of the Company that executes a
    Subsidiary Guarantee in accordance with the provisions of the Indenture,
    and their respective successors and assigns.

         "Hedging Obligations" means, with respect to any Person, the
    obligations of such Person under (i) currency exchange or interest rate
    swap agreements, interest rate cap agreements and currency exchange or
    interest rate collar agreements and (ii) other agreements or arrangements
    designed to protect such Person against fluctuations in currency exchange
    rates or interest rates.

         "Holdings" means L-3 Communications Holdings, Inc.

         "Indebtedness" means, with respect to any Person, any indebtedness
    of such Person, whether or not contingent, in respect of borrowed money or
    evidenced by bonds, notes, debentures or similar instruments or letters of
    credit (or reimbursement agreements in respect thereof) or banker's
    acceptances or representing Capital Lease Obligations or the balance
    deferred and unpaid of the purchase price of any property or representing
    any Hedging Obligations, except any such balance that constitutes an
    accrued expense or trade payable, if and to the extent any of the
    foregoing indebtedness (other than letters of credit and Hedging
    Obligations) would appear as a liability upon a balance sheet of such
    Person prepared in accordance with GAAP, as well as all indebtedness of
    others secured by a Lien on any asset of such Person (whether or not such
    indebtedness is assumed by such Person) and, to the extent not otherwise
    included, the Guarantee by such Person of any indebtedness of any other
    Person. The amount of any Indebtedness outstanding as of any date shall be
    (i) the accreted value thereof, in the case of any Indebtedness that does
    not require current payments of interest, and (ii) the principal amount

    thereof, together with any interest thereon that is more than 30 days past
    due, in the case of any other Indebtedness.

         "Investments" means, with respect to any Person, all investments by
    such Person in other Persons (including Affiliates) in the forms of direct
    or indirect loans (including guarantees of Indebtedness or other
    obligations), advances or capital contributions (excluding commission,
    travel, moving and similar loans or advances to officers and employees
    made in the ordinary course of business), purchases or other acquisitions
    for consideration of Indebtedness, Equity Interests or other securities,
    together with all items that are or would be classified as investments on
    a balance sheet prepared in accordance with GAAP. If the Company or any
    Subsidiary of the Company sells or otherwise disposes of any Equity
    Interests of any direct or indirect Subsidiary of the Company such that,
    after giving effect to any such sale or disposition, such Person is no
    longer a Subsidiary of the Company, the Company shall be deemed to have
    made an Investment on the date of any such sale or disposition equal to
    the fair market value of the Equity Interests of such Subsidiary not sold
    or disposed of in an amount determined as provided in the last paragraph
    of the covenant described above under the caption "--Restricted Payments".

         "Issue Date" means the closing date for the sale and original
    issuance of the Exchange Notes under the Indenture.

         "Lehman Investor" means Lehman Brothers Holdings Inc. and any of its
    Affiliates.
<PAGE>
         "Lien" means, with respect to any asset, any mortgage, lien, pledge,
    charge, security interest or encumbrance of any kind in respect of such
    asset, whether or not filed, recorded or otherwise perfected under
    applicable law (including any conditional sale or other title retention
    agreement, any lease in the nature thereof, any option or other agreement
    to sell or give a security interest in and any filing of or agreement to
    give any financing statement under the Uniform Commercial Code (or
    equivalent statutes) of any jurisdiction).

         "Marketable Securities" means, with respect to any Asset Sale, any
    readily marketable equity securities that are (i) traded on the New York
    Stock Exchange, the American Stock Exchange or the Nasdaq National Market;
    and (ii) issued by a corporation having a total equity market
    capitalization of not less than $250.0 million; provided that the excess
    of (A) the aggregate amount of securities of any one such corporation held
    by the Company and any Restricted Subsidiary over (B) ten times the
    average daily trading volume of such securities during the 20 immediately
    preceding trading days shall be deemed not to be Marketable Securities; as
    determined on the date of the contract relating to such Asset Sale.

         "Moody's" means Moody's Investors Services, Inc.

         "Net Income" means, with respect to any Person, the net income
    (loss) of such Person, determined in accordance with GAAP and before any
    reduction in respect of preferred stock dividends, excluding, however,
    (i) any gain or loss, together with any related provision for taxes
    thereon, realized in connection with (A) any Asset Sale (including,
    without limitation, dispositions pursuant to sale and leaseback
    transactions) or (B) the disposition of any securities by such Person or
    any of its Restricted Subsidiaries or the extinguishment of any
    Indebtedness of such Person or any of its Restricted Subsidiaries and
    (ii) any extraordinary gain or loss, together with any related provision
    for taxes on such extraordinary gain or loss and (iii) the cumulative
    effect of a change in accounting principles.

         "Net Proceeds" means the aggregate cash proceeds received by the
    Company or any of its Subsidiaries in respect of any Asset Sale
    (including, without limitation, any cash received upon the sale or other
    disposition of any non-cash consideration received in any Asset Sale), net
    of the direct costs relating to such Asset Sale (including, without
    limitation, legal, accounting and investment banking fees, and sales
    commissions) and any relocation expenses incurred as a result thereof,
    taxes paid or payable as a result thereof (after taking into account any
    available tax credits or deductions and any tax sharing arrangements),
    amounts required to be applied to the repayment of Indebtedness secured by
    a Lien on the asset or assets that were the subject of such Asset Sale and
    any reserve for adjustment in respect of the sale price of such asset or
    assets established in accordance with GAAP.

         "Non-Recourse Debt" means Indebtedness (i) as to which neither the
    Company nor any of its Restricted Subsidiaries (A) provides credit support
    of any kind (including any undertaking, agreement or instrument that would
    constitute Indebtedness), (B) is directly or indirectly liable (as a
    guarantor or otherwise), or (C) constitutes the lender; and (ii) no
    default with respect to which (including any rights that the holders
    thereof may have to take enforcement action against an Unrestricted
    Subsidiary) would permit (upon notice, lapse of time or both) any holder
<PAGE>
    of any other Indebtedness (other than Indebtedness incurred under Credit
    Facilities) of the Company or any of its Restricted Subsidiaries to
    declare a default on such other Indebtedness or cause the payment thereof
    to be accelerated or payable prior to its stated maturity; and (iii) as to
    which the lenders have been notified in writing that they will not have
    any recourse to the stock or assets of the Company or any of its
    Restricted Subsidiaries.

         "Obligations" means any principal, premium (if any), interest
    (including interest accruing on or after the filing of any petition in
    bankruptcy or for reorganization, whether or not a claim for post-filing
    interest is allowed in such proceeding), penalties, fees, charges,
    expenses, indemnifications, reimbursement obligations, damages (including
    Liquidated Damages), guarantees and other liabilities or amounts payable
    under the documentation governing any Indebtedness or in respect thereto.

         "Permitted Investments" means (i) any Investment in the Company or
    in a Restricted Subsidiary of the Company that is a Guarantor (ii) any
    Investment in cash or Cash Equivalents; (iii) any Investment by the
    Company or any Restricted Subsidiary of the Company in a Person, if as a
    result of such Investment (A) such Person becomes a Restricted Subsidiary
    of the Company and a Guarantor or (B) such Person is merged, consolidated
    or amalgamated with or into, or transfers or conveys substantially all of
    its assets to, or is liquidated into, the Company or a Restricted
    Subsidiary of the Company that is a Guarantor; (iv) any Restricted
    Investment made as a result of the receipt of non-cash consideration from
    an Asset Sale that was made pursuant to and in compliance with the
    covenant described above under the caption "--Repurchase at the Option of
    Holders--Asset Sales" or any disposition of assets not constituting an
    Asset sale; (v) any acquisition of assets solely in exchange for the
    issuance of Equity Interests (other than Disqualified Stock) of the
    Company; (vi) advances to employees not to exceed $2.5 million at any one
    time outstanding; (vii) any Investment acquired in connection with or as a
    result of a workout or bankruptcy of a customer or supplier;
    (viii) Hedging Obligations permitted to be incurred under the covenant
    described above under the caption "--Incurrence of Indebtedness and
    Issuance of Preferred Stock"; (ix) any Investment in a Similar Business
    that is not a Restricted Subsidiary; provided that the aggregate fair
    market value of all Investments made pursuant to this clause (ix) (valued
    on the date each such Investment was made and without giving effect to
    subsequent changes in value) may not exceed 5% of the Consolidated Net
    Tangible Assets of the Company; and (x) other Investments in any Person
    having an aggregate fair market value (measured on the date each such
    Investment was made and without giving effect to subsequent changes in
    value), when taken together with all other Investments made pursuant to
    this clause (x) that are at the time outstanding, not to exceed $15.0
    million.

         "Permitted Junior Securities" means Equity Interests in the Company
    or debt securities that are subordinated to all Senior Debt (and any debt
    securities issued in exchange for Senior Debt) to substantially the same
    extent as, or to a greater extent than, the Exchange Notes and the
    Subsidiary Guarantees are subordinated to Senior Debt pursuant to Article
    10 of the Indenture.
<PAGE>
         "Permitted Liens" means (i) Liens securing Senior Debt of the
    Company or any Guarantor that was permitted by the terms of the Indenture
    to be incurred; (ii) Liens in favor of the Company or any Guarantor;
    (iii) Liens on property of a Person existing at the time such Person is
    merged into or consolidated with the Company or any Restricted Subsidiary
    of the Company; provided that such Liens were in existence prior to the
    contemplation of such merger or consolidation and do not extend to any
    assets other than those of the Person merged into or consolidated with the
    Company; (iv) Liens on property existing at the time of acquisition
    thereof by the Company or any Subsidiary of the Company, provided that
    such Liens were in existence prior to the contemplation of such
    acquisition and do not extend to any other assets of the Company or any of
    its Restricted Subsidiaries; (v) Liens to secure the performance of
    statutory obligations, surety or appeal bonds, performance bonds or other
    obligations of a like nature incurred in the ordinary course of business;
    (vi) Liens to secure Indebtedness (including Capital Lease Obligations)
    permitted by clause (v) of the second paragraph of the covenant entitled
    "Incurrence of Indebtedness and Issuance of Preferred Stock" covering only
    the assets acquired with such Indebtedness -- ; (vii) Liens existing on
    the Issue Date; (viii) Liens for taxes, assessments or governmental
    charges or claims that are not yet delinquent or that are being contested
    in good faith by appropriate proceedings promptly instituted and
    diligently concluded, provided that any reserve or other appropriate
    provision as shall be required in conformity with GAAP shall have been
    made therefor; (ix) Liens incurred in the ordinary course of business of
    the Company or any Restricted Subsidiary of the Company with respect to
    obligations that do not exceed $5.0 million at any one time outstanding;
    (x) Liens on assets of Guarantors to secure Senior Debt of such Guarantors
    that was permitted by the Indenture to be incurred; (xi) Liens securing
    Permitted Refinancing Indebtedness, provided that any such Lien does not
    extend to or cover any property, shares or debt other than the property,
    shares or debt securing the Indebtedness so refunded, refinanced or
    extended; (xii) Liens incurred or deposits made to secure the performance
    of tenders, bids, leases, statutory obligations, surety and appeal bonds,
    government contracts, performance and return of money bonds and other
    obligations of a like nature, in each case incurred in the ordinary course
    of business (exclusive of obligations for the payment of borrowed money);
    (xiii) Liens upon specific items of inventory or other goods and proceeds
    of any Person securing such Person's obligations in respect of bankers'
    acceptances issued or created for the account of such Person to facilitate
    the purchase, shipment or storage of such inventory or other goods in the
    ordinary course of business; (xiv) Liens encumbering customary initial
    deposits and margin deposits, and other Liens incurred in the ordinary
    course of business that are within the general parameters customary in the
    industry, in each case securing Indebtedness under Hedging Obligations;
    and (xv) Liens encumbering deposits made in the ordinary course of
    business to secure nondelinquent obligations arising from statutory or
    regulatory, contractual or warranty requirements of the Company or its
    Subsidiaries for which a reserve or other appropriate provision, if any,
    as shall be required by GAAP shall have been made.

         "Permitted Refinancing Indebtedness" means any Indebtedness of the
    Company or any of its Subsidiaries issued in exchange for, or the net
    proceeds of which are used to extend, refinance, renew, replace, defease
    or refund other Indebtedness of the Company or any of its Restricted
<PAGE>
    Subsidiaries; provided that: (i) the principal amount (or accreted value,
    if applicable) of such Permitted Refinancing Indebtedness does not exceed
    the principal amount of (or accreted value, if applicable), plus accrued
    interest on, the Indebtedness so extended, refinanced, renewed, replaced,
    defeased or refunded (plus the amount of reasonable expenses and
    prepayment premiums incurred in connection therewith); (ii) such Permitted
    Refinancing Indebtedness has a final maturity date no earlier than the
    final maturity date of, and has a Weighted Average Life to Maturity equal
    to or greater than the Weighted Average Life to Maturity of, the
    Indebtedness being extended, refinanced, renewed, replaced, defeased or
    refunded; (iii) if the Indebtedness being extended, refinanced, renewed,
    replaced, defeased or refunded is subordinated in right of payment to the
    Exchange Notes, such Permitted Refinancing Indebtedness is subordinated in
    right of payment to the Exchange Notes on terms at least as favorable to
    the Holders of Exchange Notes as those contained in the documentation
    governing the Indebtedness being extended, refinanced, renewed, replaced,
    defeased or refunded; and (iv) such Indebtedness is incurred either by the
    Company or by the Restricted Subsidiary who is the obligor on the
    Indebtedness being extended, refinanced, renewed, replaced, defeased or
    refunded.

         "Permitted Securities" means, with respect to any Asset Sale, Voting
    Stock of a Person primarily engaged in one or more Similar Businesses;
    provided that after giving effect to the Asset Sale such Person shall
    become a Restricted Subsidiary and a Guarantor.

         "Representative" means the indenture trustee or other trustee, agent
    or representative for any Senior Debt.

         "Restricted Investment" means an Investment other than a Permitted
    Investment.

         "Restricted Subsidiary" means, with respect to any Person, each
    Subsidiary of such Person that is not an Unrestricted Subsidiary.

         "Senior Credit Facilities" means the credit agreement, dated as of
    the Issue Date among the Company and a syndicate of banks and other
    financial institutions led by Lehman Commercial Paper Inc., as syndication
    agent, and any related notes, collateral documents, letters of credit and
    guarantees, including any appendices, exhibits or schedules to any of the
    foregoing (as the same may be in effect from time to time), in each case,
    as such agreements may be amended, modified, supplemented or restated from
    time to time, or refunded, refinanced, restructured, replaced, renewed,
    repaid or extended from time to time (whether with the original agents and
    lenders or other agents and lenders or otherwise, and whether provided
    under the original credit agreement or other credit agreements or
    otherwise).

         "Senior Debt" means (i) all Indebtedness of the Company or any of
    its Restricted Subsidiaries outstanding under Credit Facilities and all
    Hedging Obligations with respect thereto, (ii) any other Indebtedness
    permitted to be incurred by the Company or any of its Restricted
    Subsidiaries under the terms of the Indenture, unless the instrument under
    which such Indebtedness is incurred expressly provides that it is on a
    parity with or subordinated in right of payment to the Exchange Notes and
    (iii) all Obligations with respect to the foregoing. Notwithstanding
<PAGE>
    anything to the contrary in the foregoing, Senior Debt will not include
    (i) any liability for federal, state, local or other taxes owed or owing
    by the Company, (ii) any Indebtedness of the Company to any of its
    Subsidiaries or other Affiliates, (iii) any trade payables or (iv) any
    Indebtedness that is incurred in violation of the Indenture.

         "Significant Subsidiary" means any Subsidiary that would be a
    "significant subsidiary" as defined in Article 1, Rule 1-02 of Regulation
    S-X, promulgated pursuant to the Act, as such Regulation is in effect on
    the date hereof.

         "Similar Business" means a business, a majority of whose revenues in
    the most recently ended calendar year were derived from (i) the sale of
    defense products, electronics, communications systems, aerospace products,
    avionics products and/or communications products, (ii) any services
    related thereto, (iii) any business or activity that is reasonably similar
    thereto or a reasonable extension, development or expansion thereof or
    ancillary thereto, and (iv) any combination of any of the foregoing.

         "Stated Maturity" means, with respect to any installment of interest
    or principal on any series of Indebtedness, the date on which such payment
    of interest or principal was scheduled to be paid in the original
    documentation governing such Indebtedness, and shall not include any
    contingent obligations to repay, redeem or repurchase any such interest or
    principal prior to the date originally scheduled for the payment thereof.

         "Subsidiary" means, with respect to any Person, (i) any corporation,
    association or other business entity of which more than 50% of the total
    voting power of shares of Capital Stock entitled (without regard to the
    occurrence of any contingency) to vote in the election of directors,
    managers or trustees thereof is at the time owned or controlled, directly
    or indirectly, by such Person or one or more of the other Subsidiaries of
    that Person (or a combination thereof) and (ii) any partnership (A) the
    sole general partner or the managing general partner of which is such
    Person or a Subsidiary of such Person or (B) the only general partners of
    which are such Person or of one or more Subsidiaries of such Person (or
    any combination thereof).

         "S&P" means Standard and Poor's Corporation.

         "Transaction Documents" means the Indenture, the Exchange Notes, the
    Purchase Agreement and the Registration Rights Agreement.

         "Unrestricted Subsidiary" means any Subsidiary that is designated by
    the Board of Directors as an Unrestricted Subsidiary pursuant to a Board
    Resolution, but only to the extent that such Subsidiary: (i) has no
    Indebtedness other than Non-Recourse Debt; (ii) is not party to any
    agreement, contract, arrangement or understanding with the Company or any
    Restricted Subsidiary of the Company unless the terms of any such
    agreement, contract, arrangement or understanding are no less favorable to
    the Company or such Restricted Subsidiary than those that might be
    obtained at the time from Persons who are not Affiliates of the Company;
    (iii) is a Person with respect to which neither the Company nor any of its
    Restricted Subsidiaries has any direct or indirect obligation (A) to
    subscribe for additional Equity Interests or (B) to maintain or preserve
    such Person's financial condition or to cause such Person to achieve any
<PAGE>
    specified levels of operating results; (iv) has not guaranteed or
    otherwise directly or indirectly provided credit support for any
    Indebtedness of the Company or any of its Restricted Subsidiaries; and
    (v) has at least one director on its board of directors that is not a
    director or executive officer of the Company or any of its Restricted
    Subsidiaries and has at least one executive officer that is not a director
    or executive officer of the Company or any of its Restricted Subsidiaries.
    Any such designation by the Board of Directors shall be evidenced to the
    Trustee by filing with the Trustee a certified copy of the Board
    Resolution giving effect to such designation and an Officers' Certificate
    certifying that such designation complied with the foregoing conditions
    and was permitted by the covenant described above under the caption
    "Certain Covenants -- Restricted Payments". If, at any time, any
    Unrestricted Subsidiary would fail to meet the foregoing requirements as
    an Unrestricted Subsidiary, it shall thereafter cease to be an
    Unrestricted Subsidiary for purposes of the Indenture and any Indebtedness
    of such Subsidiary shall be deemed to be incurred by a Restricted
    Subsidiary of the Company as of such date (and, if such Indebtedness is
    not permitted to be incurred as of such date under the covenant described
    under the caption "Incurrence of Indebtedness and Issuance of Preferred
    Stock", the Company shall be in default of such covenant). The Board of
    Directors of the Company may at any time designate any Unrestricted
    Subsidiary to be a Restricted Subsidiary; provided that such designation
    shall be deemed to be an incurrence of Indebtedness by a Restricted
    Subsidiary of the Company of any outstanding Indebtedness of such
    Unrestricted Subsidiary and such designation shall only be permitted if
    (i) such Indebtedness is permitted under the covenant described under the
    caption "Certain Covenants--Incurrence of Indebtedness and Issuance of
    Preferred Stock", calculated on a pro forma basis as if such designation
    had occurred at the beginning of the four-quarter reference period, and
    (ii) no Default or Event of Default would be in existence following such
    designation.

         "Weighted Average Life to Maturity" means, when applied to any
    Indebtedness at any date, the number of years obtained by dividing (i) the
    sum of the products obtained by multiplying (A) the amount of each then
    remaining installment, sinking fund, serial maturity or other required
    payments of principal, including payment at final maturity, in respect
    thereof, by (B) the number of years (calculated to the nearest
    one-twelfth) that will elapse between such date and the making of such
    payment, by (ii) the then outstanding principal amount of such
    Indebtedness.

         "Wholly Owned" means, when used with respect to any Subsidiary or
    Restricted Subsidiary of a Person, a Subsidiary (or Restricted Subsidiary,
    as appropriate) of such Person all of the outstanding Capital Stock or
    other ownership interests of which (other than directors' qualifying
    shares) shall at the time be owned by such Person or by one or more Wholly
    Owned Subsidiaries (or Wholly Owned Restricted Subsidiaries, as
    appropriate) of such Person and one or more Wholly Owned Subsidiaries (or
    Wholly Owned Restricted Subsidiaries, as appropriate) of such Person.
<PAGE>
                 CERTAIN UNITED STATES FEDERAL TAX CONSIDERATIONS

         The exchange of Old Notes for Exchange Notes should not constitute a
    recognition event for federal income tax purposes. Consequently, no gain
    or loss should be recognized by Holders upon receipt of the Exchange
    Notes. For purposes of determining gain or loss upon the subsequent sale
    or exchange of Exchange Notes, a Holder's basis in Exchange Notes should
    be the same as such Holder's basis in the Old Notes exchanged therefor.
    Holders should be considered to have held the Exchange Notes from the time
    of their original acquisition of the Old Notes. 

         In any event, persons considering the exchange of Old Notes for
    Exchange Notes should consult their own tax advisors concerning the United
    States federal income tax consequences in light of their particular
    situations as well as any consequences arising under the laws of any other
    taxing jurisdictions.

                               PLAN OF DISTRIBUTION

         Each broker-dealer that receives Exchange Notes for its own account
    pursuant to the Exchange Offer must acknowledge that it will deliver a
    prospectus in connection with any resale of such Exchange Notes. This
    Prospectus, as it may be amended or supplemented from time to time, may be
    used by a broker-dealer in connection with resales of Exchange Notes
    received in exchange for Old Notes where such Old Notes were acquired as a
    result of market-making activities or other trading activities. To the
    extent any such broker-dealer participates in the Exchange Offer and so
    notifies the Company, or causes the Company to be so notified in writing,
    the Company has agreed that a period of 180 days after the date of this
    Prospectus, it will make this Prospectus, as amended or supplemented,
    available to such broker-dealer for use in connection with any such
    resale, and will promptly send additional copies of this Prospectus and
    any amendment or supplement to this Prospectus to any broker-dealer that
    requests such documents in the Letter of Transmittal. 

         The Company will not receive any proceeds from any sale of Exchange
    Notes by broker-dealers. Exchange Notes received by broker-dealers for
    their own account pursuant to the Exchange Offer may be sold from time to
    time in one or more transactions in the over-the-counter market, in
    negotiated transactions, through the writing of options on the Exchange
    Notes or a combination of such methods of resale, at prevailing market
    prices at the time of resale, at prices related to such prevailing market
    prices or at negotiated prices. Any such resale may be made directly to
    purchasers or to or through brokers or dealers who may receive
    compensation in the form of commissions or concessions from any such
    broker-dealer or the purchasers or any such Exchange Notes. Any
    broker-dealer that resells Exchange Notes that were received by it for its
    own account pursuant to the Exchange Offer and any broker or dealer that
    participates in a distribution of such Exchange Notes may be deemed to be
    an "underwriter" within the meaning of the Securities Act, and any profit
    on any such resale of Exchange Notes and any commissions or concessions
    received by any such persons may be deemed to be underwriting compensation
    under the Securities Act. The Letter of Transmittal states that, by
    acknowledging that it will deliver and by delivering a prospectus, a
    broker-dealer will not be deemed to admit that it is an "underwriter"
    within the meaning of the Securities Act. 
<PAGE>
         The Company has agreed to pay all expenses incident to the Exchange
    Offer (other than commissions and concessions of any broker-dealers),
    subject to certain prescribed limitations, and will indemnify the holders
    of the Old Notes against certain liabilities, including certain
    liabilities that may arise under the Securities Act. 

         By its acceptance of the Exchange Offer, any broker-dealer that
    receives Exchange Notes pursuant to the Exchange Offer hereby agrees to
    notify the Company prior to using the Prospectus in connection with the
    sale or transfer of Exchange Notes, and acknowledges and agrees that, upon
    receipt of notice from the Company of the happening of any event which
    makes any statement in the Prospectus untrue in any material respect or
    which requires the making of any changes in the Prospectus in order to
    make the statements therein not misleading or which may impose upon the
    Company disclosure obligations that may have a material adverse effect on
    the Company (which notice the Company agrees to deliver promptly to such
    broker-dealer), such broker-dealer will suspend use of the Prospectus
    until the Company has notified such broker-dealer that delivery of the
    Prospectus may resume and has furnished copies of any amendment or
    supplement to the Prospectus to such broker-dealer.
<PAGE>
                                  LEGAL MATTERS

         Certain legal matters will be passed upon for the Company by Simpson
    Thacher & Bartlett (a partnership which includes professional
    corporations), New York, New York. 

                                     EXPERTS

         The combined financial statements of the Lockheed Martin Predecessor
    Businesses as of March 31, 1997 and for the three months then ended, as of
    December 31, 1996 and for the year then ended, the Loral Acquired
    Businesses for the three months ended March 31, 1996 and for the years
    ended December 31, 1995 and 1994 and the balance sheet of L-3 
    Communications Corporation as of April 29, 1997, included in this
    Prospectus, have been included herein in reliance on the report of
    Coopers & Lybrand L.L.P., independent auditors, given on the authority
    of that firm as experts in accounting and auditing. The report on the
    combined financial statements of the Lockheed Martin Predecessor
    Businesses for the year ended December 31, 1996 states that Coopers &
    Lybrand L.L.P.'s opinion, insofar as it relates to the financial
    statements of the Lockheed Martin Communications Systems Division
    included in such combined financial statements, is based solely on
    the report of other auditors.

         The combined financial statements of Lockheed Martin Communications
    Systems Division at December 31, 1996 (not presented separately herein)
    and 1995, and the combined results of its operations and its cash flows
    for the year ended December 31, 1996 (not presented separately herein),
    and the results of its operations and its cash flows for each of the two
    years in the period ended December 31, 1995, which is referred to and made
    a part of this Prospectus and Registration Statement, have been audited by
    Ernst & Young LLP, independent auditors, as set forth in their report
    appearing elsewhere herein, and are included in reliance upon such report
    given upon the authority of such firm as experts in accounting and
    auditing.
<PAGE>
                          INDEX TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

    L-3 COMMUNICATIONS CORPORATION

         Report of Coopers & Lybrand L.L.P.   . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  F-3

         Balance of Sheet of April 29, 1997 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  F-4

         Notes to Balance Sheet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  F-5

    Lockheed Martin Predecessor Businesses

    Combined Financial Statements as of March 31, 1997 and the three 
    months ended March 31, 1997 and 1996 (unaudited)  . . . . . . . . . .  F-8

         Report of Coopers & Lybrand L.L.P.   . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  F-9

         Balance sheet as of March 31, 1997 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  F-10

         Statements of Operations and Changes in Invested Equity for
         the three months ended March 31, 1997 and March 31, 1996 
         (Unaudited) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . F-11

         Statements of Cash Flows for the three months ended 
         March 31, 1997 and March 31, 1996 (Unaudited) . . . . . . . . . . F-12

         Notes to Combined Financial Statements . . . . . . . . . . . . .  F-13

     Combined Financial Statements as of December 31, 1996, 1995 and
     for the three years in the period ended December 31, 1996. . . . . .  F-24

         Report of Coopers & Lybrand L.L.P. on December 31, 1996 
         Combined Financial Statements  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  F-25

         Report of Ernst & Young LLP on the financial statements of 
         Lockheed Martin Communications Systems Division as of 
         December 31, 1996 and 1995 and for the three
         years ended December 31, 1996. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  F-26

         Balance Sheets as of December 31, 1996 and 1995  . . . . . . . .  F-27

         Statements of Operations and Changes in Invested Equity for
         years ended December 31, 1996, 1995 and 1994  . . . . . . . . .   F-28

         Statements of Cash Flows for years ended December 31, 
         1996, 1995 and 1994  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  F-29

         Notes to Combined Financial Statements   . . . . . . . . . . . .  F-30

    Loral Acquired Businesses

         Report of Coopers & Lybrand L.L.P.   . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  F-43

         Statements of Operations for three months ended 
         March 31, 1996 and the years ended December 31, 1995
         and 1994  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   F-44
<PAGE>
         Statements of Cash Flows for three months ended March 31, 1996 and 
         the years ended December 31, 1995 and 1994   . . . . . . . . . .  F-45

         Notes to Combined Financial Statements   . . . . . . . . . . . .  F-46
<PAGE>
                           REPORT OF INDEPENDENT AUDITORS

    To the Board of Directors of L-3 Communications Corporation

         We have audited the accompanying balance sheet of L-3 Communications
    Corporation (a Delaware company) as of April 29, 1997. This financial
    statement is the responsibility of L-3 Communications Corporation's 
    management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on this 
    financial statement based on our audit.

         We conducted our audit in accordance with generally accepted
    auditing standards. Those standards require that we plan and perform the
    audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the balance sheet is
    free of material misstatement. An audit includes examining, on a test
    basis, evidence supporting the amounts and disclosures in the balance
    sheet. An audit also includes assessing the accounting principles used and
    significant estimates made by management, as well as evaluating the
    overall financial statement presentation. We believe that our audit
    provides a reasonable basis for our opinion.

         In our opinion, the balance sheet referred to above presents fairly,
    in all material respects, the financial position of L-3 Communications
    Corporation as of April 29, 1997, in conformity with generally accepted
    accounting principles.



                                                     Coopers & Lybrand L.L.P.



    1301 Avenue of the Americas
    New York, New York 10019
    July 16, 1997
<PAGE>
                          L-3 COMMUNICATIONS CORPORATION

                                BALANCE SHEET

                                April 29, 1997

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
<S>                                                              <C>
    ASSETS:                                                       
                                                                  

      Cash                                                        $1.00
                                                                  -----

              Total Assets                                        $1.00
                                                                  =====


    LIABILITIES AND SHAREHOLDER'S EQUITY

    Shareholder's Equity

      Common Stock, $.01 par value 100 shares authorized 
      and outstanding                                             $1.00
                                                                  -----

              Total Shareholder's Equity                          $1.00
                                                                  =====
                                                                  
</TABLE>






                        See notes to balance sheet.
<PAGE>
                          L-3 COMMUNICATIONS CORPORATION
                              NOTES TO BALANCE SHEET


    1.   Formation of L-3 Communications Corporation

         On April 8, 1997, L-3 Communications Corporation (the "Company") was
    incorporated under the Delaware General Corporation Law
    as a wholly owned subsidiary of L-3 Communications Holdings Inc. for the
    purpose of effectuating the transactions described below.

    2.   Acquisition

         On January 31, 1997, Lockheed Martin Corporation ("Lockheed
    Martin"), Lehman Brothers Holdings Inc. ("Lehman"), Frank C. Lanza
    ("Lanza") and Robert V. LaPenta ("LaPenta") entered into a Memorandum of
    Understanding regarding the transfer of certain businesses of Lockheed
    Martin to a newly formed corporation ("Newco") to be owned by Lockheed
    Martin, Lehman, Lanza and LaPenta. The businesses included a Lockheed
    Martin's Wideband Systems Division, Communications Systems Division and
    Products Group, comprising eleven autonomous operations (collectively the
    "Lockheed Martin Predecessor Business" or the "Businesses"). Also included
    in the transaction is the acquisition of a semiconductor product line of
    another business and certain leasehold improvements in New York City.

         Closing of the transaction occurred on April 30, 1997. The total
    consideration paid to Lockheed Martin was $525 million, comprised of $480
    million of cash before an estimated $20 million reduction related to a
    purchase price adjustment, and $45 million of common equity being retained
    by Lockheed Martin. The Company is a wholly owned subsidiary of L-3 
    Communications Holdings, Inc. ("Holdings"), and Holdings is capitalized 
    with $125 million of common equity, with Lanza and LaPenta collectively 
    owning 15.0%, the Lehman Partnership owning 50.1% and Lockheed Martin 
    owning 34.9%. In connection with the Closing the Company has received 
    a $125 million capital contribution from Holdings and incurred debt of 
    $400 million.

    3.   Agreements

         In connection with the acquisition, the Company entered into a
    Transaction Agreement, senior credit facilities, and issued 10 3/8%
    Senior Subordinated Notes Due 2007.

         Pursuant to the Transaction Agreement, Holdings, the Company
    and Lockheed Martin have entered into a transition services agreement
    pursuant to which Lockheed Martin will provide to Holdings and its
    subsidiaries (and Holdings will provide to Lockheed Martin) certain
    corporate services of the types currently provided at costs consistent with
    past practices until December 31, 1997 (or, in the case of Communication
    Systems--Camden, for a period of up to 18 months after the Closing) and
    the parties also entered into supply agreements which reflect existing
    intercompany work transfer agreements or similar support arrangements upon
    prices and other terms consistent with the present arrangements. Holdings,
    the Company and Lockheed Martin have entered into certain subleases of
    real property and cross-licenses of intellectual property.
<PAGE>
         Pursuant to the Transaction Agreement the Company assumed certain 
    obligations relating to environmental liabilities and benefit plans.

         The 10-3/8% Senior Subordinated Notes are due in May 1, 2007 with 
    interest payable semi-annually beginning November 1, 1997. The Notes are 
    redeemable under certain circumstances.

         The Term Loans and Revolving Credit Facility have been provided by a
    syndicate of banks and financial institution and bear interest at the
    option of the Company at a rate related to the (i) Loan of Federal Funds 
    Rate, or the reference rate published by Bank of America NT&SA or 
    (ii) LIBOR.
<PAGE>
       The Revolving Credit Facility terminates on March 31, 2003. The Term
    Loans will be subject to the following Amortization schedule.


[CAPTION]
<TABLE>
                                             Tranche A Term Loan    Tranche B Term Loan    Tranche C Term Loan
                                             -------------------    -------------------    -------------------
<S>                                          <C>                    <C>                    <C>

Year 1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .      $ 4,000,000              $   500,000             $  500,000
Year 2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .        5,000,000                  500,000                500,000
Year 3 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .       15,000,000                  500,000                500,000
Year 4 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .       21,000,000                  500,000                500,000
Year 5 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .       27,000,000                  500,000                500,000
Year 6 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .       28,000,000                  500,000                500,000
Year 7 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .               --               20,000,000                500,000
Year 8 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .               --               22,000,000                500,000
Year 9 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .               --                       --             26,000,000

</TABLE>
<PAGE>
                      LOCKHEED MARTIN PREDECESSOR BUSINESSES

                          COMBINED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

                               as of March 31, 1997
        and for the three months ended March 31, 1997 and 1996 (Unaudited)
<PAGE>
                          Report of Independent Auditors



    To the Board of Directors of
    L-3 Communications Corporation

         We have audited the accompanying combined balance sheet of the
    Lockheed Martin Predecessor Businesses, as defined in Note 1 to the
    financial statements, (the "Businesses") as of March 31, 1997 and the
    related combined statements of operations and changes in invested equity
    and cash flows for the three months then ended. These financial statements
    are the responsibility of the Businesses' management. Our responsibility
    is to express an opinion on these financial statements based on our audit.

         We conducted our audit in accordance with generally accepted
    auditing standards. Those standards required that we plan and perform our
    audit in order to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial
    statements are free of material misstatement. An audit includes examining,
    on a test basis, evidence supporting the amounts and disclosures in the
    financial statements. An audit also includes assessing the accounting
    principles used and significant estimates made by management, as well as
    evaluating the overall financial statement presentation. We believe that
    our audit provides a reasonable basis for our opinion.

         In our opinion, the financial statements referred to above present
    fairly, in all material respects, the combined financial position of the
    Lockheed Martin Predecessor Businesses as of March 31, 1997 and their
    combined results of operations and cash flows for the three months then
    ended, in conformity with generally accepted accounting principles.



                                                  Coopers & Lybrand L.L.P.


    1301 Avenue of the Americas
    New York, New York  10019
    July 11, 1997
<PAGE>
                      LOCKHEED MARTIN PREDECESSOR BUSINESSES

                              COMBINED BALANCE SHEET
                                  (in thousands)

                                                            March 31,
                                                    ---------------------
                                                            1997
                                                    ---------------------

                                      ASSETS
    Current assets:
     Contracts in process   . . . . . . . . . . .        $215,548
     Other current assets   . . . . . . . . . . .           4,142
                                                          --------
       Total current assets   . . . . . . . . . .          219,690
                                                          --------

    Property, plant and equipment . . . . . . . .          120,423
     Less, accumulated depreciation and
     amortization   . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .           29,069
                                                          --------
                                                            91,354
                                                          --------

    Intangibles, primarily cost in excess
      of net assets acquired, net of
      amortization   . . . . . . . . . . . . . .           280,145
    Other assets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .            17,340
                                                          --------
                                                          $608,529
                                                          ========

                     LIABILITIES AND INVESTED EQUITY
    Current liabilities:
     Accounts payable, trade  . . . . . . . . .           $ 33,956
     Accrued employment costs   . . . . . . . .             26,688
     Billings and estimated earnings in excess
      of cost . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .             12,408
     Other current liabilities  . . . . . . . .             25,246
                                                          --------
       Total current liabilities  . . . . . . .             98,298
                                                          --------

    Other liabilities . . . . . . . . . . . . .             16,301
    Commitments and contingencies (Note 8)
    Invested equity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .          493,930
                                                          --------
                                                          $608,529
                                                          ========


                   See notes to combined financial statements.
<PAGE>
                          LOCKHEED MARTIN PREDECESSOR BUSINESSES
              COMBINED STATEMENTS OF OPERATIONS AND CHANGES IN INVESTED EQUITY
               For the Three Months Ended March 31, 1997 and 1996 (unaudited)
                                      (In thousands)


<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                           1997                      1996
                                                                                 -----------------------   -----------------------
                                                                                                                 (Unaudited)
<S>                                                                              <C>                       <C>

    Sales . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .         $158,873                   $ 41,153
    Cost of sales . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .          150,937                     39,477
                                                                                        --------                   --------
    Operating income  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .            7,936                      1,676
    Allocated interested expense  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .            8,441                      2,028
                                                                                        --------                   --------
    Loss before income taxes  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .             (505)                      (352)
    Income tax (benefit) expense  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .             (247)                       145
                                                                                        --------                   --------
    Net loss  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .             (258)                      (497)
    Invested equity-beginning of period . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .          473,609                    194,663
    Advances from (repayments to) Lockheed Martin . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .           20,579                     (9,751)
                                                                                        --------                   --------
    Invested equity-end of period . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .         $493,930                   $184,415
                                                                                        ========                   ========
</TABLE>



                   See notes to combined financial statements.
<PAGE>
                      LOCKHEED MARTIN PREDECESSOR BUSINESSES
                        COMBINED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS
          For the Three Months Ended March 31, 1997 and 1996 (unaudited)
                                  (In thousands)


<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                           1997                      1996
                                                                                 -----------------------   -----------------------
                                                                                                                 (Unaudited)
<S>                                                                              <C>                       <C>

    Operating activities:
    Net loss  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .            ($258)                     ($497)
    Depreciation and amortization . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .            7,184                      3,062
    Changes in operating assets and liabilities:
      Contracts in process  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .        (17,475)                     9,071
      Other current assets  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .           (481)                      (326)
      Other assets  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .           (159)                     1,086
      Accounts payable  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .           (207)                    (4,498)
      Accrued employment costs  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .           (625)                     2,180
      Customer advances and amounts in excess of costs incurred . . . . . . . . .         (1,891)                        60
        Other current liabilities . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .         (1,867)                      (684)
    Other liabilities . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .           (500)                       710
                                                                                         -------                     ------
    Net cash from (used in) operating activities  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .          (16,279)                    10,164
                                                                                         -------                     ------
    Investing activities:
    Capital expenditures  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .           (4,300)                      (413)
                                                                                         -------                     ------
    Financing activities:
    Advances from (repayments to) Lockheed Martin . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .           20,579                     (9,751) 
                                                                                          ------                     ------
    Net change in cash  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .               --                         --
                                                                                         =======                    =======
</TABLE>


                   See notes to combined financial statements.
<PAGE>
                      LOCKHEED MARTIN PREDECESSOR BUSINESSES
                      NOTES TO COMBINED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

                                  March 31, 1997
                              (Dollars in thousands)

    1.  Background and Description of Businesses

         On January 31, 1997, Lockheed Martin Corporation ("Lockheed
    Martin"), Lehman Brothers Holdings Inc. ("Lehman"), Frank C. Lanza
    ("Lanza") and Robert V. LaPenta ("LaPenta") entered into a Memorandum of
    Understanding regarding the transfer of certain businesses of Lockheed
    Martin to a newly formed corporation ("Newco") owned by Lockheed Martin,
    Lehman, Lanza and LaPenta. The businesses transferred include Lockheed
    Martin's Wideband Systems Division, Communications Systems Division and
    Products Group, comprising eleven autonomous operations (collectively the
    "Lockheed Martin Predecessor Businesses" or the "Businesses"). Also
    included in the transaction is the acquisition of a semiconductor product
    line of another business and certain leasehold improvements in New York
    City.

         Effective April 1, 1996, Lockheed Martin acquired substantially all
    the assets and liabilities of the defense businesses of Loral Corporation
    ("Loral"), including the Wideband Systems Division and the Products Group.
    The acquisition of the Wideband Systems Division and Products Group
    businesses (the "Acquired Businesses") has been accounted for as a
    purchase by Lockheed Martin Communications Systems Division ("Division").
    The acquisition has been reflected in these financial statements based on
    the purchase price allocated to those acquired businesses by Lockheed
    Martin. As such, the accompanying combined financial statements reflect
    the results of operations of the Division and the Acquired Businesses from
    the effective date of acquisition including the effects of an allocated
    portion of cost in excess of net assets acquired resulting from the
    acquisition. The assets and liabilities recorded in connection with the
    purchase price allocation were $400,993 and $113,190, respectively.

         Had the acquisition of Wideband Systems Division and the Products
    Group occurred on January 1, 1996, the unaudited pro forma sales and net
    income for the three months ended March 31, 1996 would have been $173,353
    and $1,529, respectively. The pro forma results, which are based on
    various assumptions, are not necessarily indicative of what would have
    occurred had the acquisition been consummated on January 1, 1996.

         The Businesses are suppliers of sophisticated secure communication
    systems and specialized communication products including secure, high data
    rate communication systems, commercial fixed wireless communication
    products, microwave components, avionic displays and recorders and
    instrument products. The Company's customers included the Department of
    Defense, selected U.S. government intelligence agencies, major
    aerospace/defense prime contractors and commercial customers. The
    Businesses operate primarily in one industry segment, electronic
    components and systems.

         Substantially all the Businesses' products are sold to agencies of
    the U.S. Government, primarily the Department of Defense, to foreign
    government agencies or to prime contractors or subcontractors thereof. All
<PAGE>
    domestic government contracts and subcontracts of the Businesses are
    subject to audit and various cost controls, and include standard
    provisions for termination for the convenience of the U.S. Government.
    Multi-year U.S. Government contracts and related orders are subject to
    cancellation if funds for contract performance for any subsequent year
    become unavailable. Foreign government contracts generally include
    comparable provisions relating to termination for the convenience of the
    government.

         The decline in the U.S. defense budget since the mid 1980s has
    resulted in program delays, cancellations and scope reduction for defense
    contracts in general. These events may or may not have an effect on the
    Businesses' programs; however, in the event that U.S. Government
    expenditures for products of the type manufactured by the Businesses are
    reduced, and not offset by greater commercial sales or other new programs
    or products, or acquisitions, there may be a reduction in the volume of
    contracts or subcontracts awarded to the Businesses.

    2.  Summary of Significant Accounting Policies

    Basis of Presentation and Use of Estimates

         The accompanying combined financial statements reflect the
    Businesses' assets, liabilities and operations included in Lockheed
    Martin's historical financial statements that were transferred to Newco.
    Intercompany accounts between Lockheed Martin and the Businesses have been
    included in invested equity. Significant inter-business transactions and
    balances have been eliminated. The assets and operations of the
    semiconductor product line and certain other facilities, which are not
    material to the combined financial statements, have been excluded from the
    combined financial statements.

         The preparation of financial statements in conformity with generally
    accepted accounting principles requires the Businesses' management to make
    estimates and assumptions that affect the reported amounts of assets and
    liabilities and disclosure of contingent assets and liabilities at the
    date of the financial statements and the reported amounts of revenue and
    expenses during the reporting period. The most significant of these
    estimates and assumptions relate to contract estimates of sales and costs,
    allocations from Lockheed Martin, recoverability of recorded amounts of
    fixed assets and cost in excess of net assets acquired, litigation and
    environmental obligations. Actual results could differ from these
    estimates.

    Sales and Earnings

         Sales and profits on cost reimbursable contracts are recognized as
    costs are incurred. Sales and estimated profits under long-term contracts
    are recognized under the percentage of completion method of accounting
    using the cost-to-cost method. Amounts representing contract change orders
    or claims are included in sales only when they can be reliably estimated
    and realization is probable. Sales under short-term production-type
    contracts are recorded as units are shipped; profits applicable to such
    shipments are recorded pro rata, based upon estimated total profit at
    completion of the contract. Amounts representing contract change orders or
    claims are included in sales only when they can be reliably estimated and
<PAGE>
    realization is probable. Losses on contracts are recognized when
    determined. Revisions in profit estimates are reflected in the period in
    which the facts which require the revision become known.

    Contracts In Process

         Costs accumulated under long-term contracts include direct costs, as
    well as manufacturing overhead, and for government contracts, general and
    administrative costs, independent research and development costs and bid
    and proposal costs. Contracts in process contain amounts relating to
    contracts and programs for which the related operating cycles are longer
    than one year. In accordance with industry practice, these amounts are
    included in current assets.

    Property, Plant and Equipment

         Property, plant and equipment are stated at cost. Depreciation is
    provided primarily using an accelerated method over the estimated useful
    lives (5 to 20 years) of the related assets. Leasehold improvements are
    amortized over the shorter of the lease term or the estimated useful life
    of the improvements.

    Intangibles

         Intangibles, primarily the excess of the cost of purchased
    businesses over the fair value of the net assets acquired, is being
    amortized using a straight-line method primarily over a 40-year period.
    Other intangibles are amortized over their estimated useful lives which
    range from 11-15 years. Amortization expense was $2,655 and $1,896
    (unaudited) for the three months ended March 31, 1997 and 1996,
    respectively. Accumulated amortization was $29,053 at March 31, 1997.

         Intangibles include costs allocated to the Businesses relating to
    the Request for Funding Authorization ("RFA"), consisting of over 20
    restructuring projects to reduce operating costs, initiated by General
    Electric ("GE") Aerospace in 1990 and to the REC Advance Agreement
    ("RAA"), a restructuring plan initiated after Lockheed Martin's
    acquisition of GE Aerospace. The RAA was initiated to close two regional
    electronic manufacturing centers. Restructure costs are reimbursable from
    the U.S. Government if savings can be demonstrated to exceed costs. The
    total cost of restructuring under the RFA and the RAA represented
    approximately 15% of the estimated savings to the U. S. Government and,
    therefore, a deferred asset has been recorded by Lockheed Martin. The
    deferred asset is being allocated to all the former GE Aerospace sites,
    including the Communications Systems Division, on a basis that includes
    manufacturing labor, overhead, and direct material less non-hardware
    subcontracts. As of March 31, 1997 and 1996, approximately $3,798 and
    $6,755, (unaudited) respectively of unamortized RFA and RAA costs are
    included on the Businesses' combined balance sheet in other current assets
    and other assets.

         The carrying values of intangible assets are reviewed if the facts
    and circumstances indicate potential impairment of their carrying value.
    If this review indicates that intangible assets are not recoverable, as
    determined based on the undiscounted cash flows of the entity acquired
<PAGE>
    over the remaining amortization period, the Division's carrying values
    related to the intangible assets are reduced by the estimated shortfall of
    cash flows.

    Research and Development and Similar Costs

         Research and development costs sponsored by the Businesses include
    research and development and bid and proposal effort related to government
    products and services. These costs are generally allocated among all
    contracts and programs in progress under U. S. Government contractual
    arrangements. Customer-sponsored research and development costs incurred
    pursuant to contracts are accounted for as direct contract costs.

    Financial Instruments

         At March 31, 1997, the carrying value of the Businesses' financial
    instruments, such as receivables, accounts payable and accrued
    liabilities, approximate fair value, based on the short-term maturities of
    these instruments.

    New Accounting Pronouncements

         Effective January 1, 1996, the Businesses adopted Statement of
    Financial Accounting Standards No. 121, "Accounting for the Impairment of
    Long-Lived Assets and Long-Lived Assets to Be Disposed Of" ("SFAS 121").
    SFAS 121 establishes the accounting standards for the impairment of
    long-lived assets, certain intangible assets and cost in excess of net
    assets acquired to be held and used for long-lived assets and certain
    intangible assets to be disposed of. The impact of adopting SFAS 121 was
    not material.

         Effective January 1, 1994, the Businesses adopted Statement of
    Financial Accounting Standards No. 112, "Employers' Accounting for
    Postretirement Benefits" ("SFAS 112"). SFAS 112 requires that the costs of
    benefits provided to employees after employment but before retirement be
    recognized on an accrual basis. The adoption of SFAS 112 did not have a
    material impact on the combined results of operations of the Businesses.

    Unaudited Financial Statements

         The financial statements for the three months ended March 31, 1996
    are unaudited but in the opinion of management include all adjustments
    (consisting of normal recurring accruals) considered necessary for a
    fair presentation.

    3.  Transactions with Lockheed Martin

         The Businesses rely on Lockheed Martin for certain services,
    including treasury, cash management, employee benefits, taxes, risk
    management, internal audit, financial reporting, contract administration
    and general corporate services. Although certain assets, liabilities and
    expenses related to these services have been allocated to the Businesses,
    the combined financial position, results of operations and cash flows
    presented in the accompanying combined financial statements would not be
    the same as would have occurred had the Businesses been independent
    entities. The following describes the related party transactions.
<PAGE>
    Sales of Products

         The Businesses sell products to Lockheed Martin and its affiliates,
    net sales of which were $21,171 and $6,425 (unaudited) for the three
    months ended March 31, 1997 and 1996, respectively. Included in Contracts
    in Process are receivables from Lockheed Martin and its affiliates of
    $12,392 at March 31, 1997.

    Allocation of Corporate Expenses

         The amount of allocated corporate expenses reflected in these
    combined financial statements has been estimated based primarily on an
    allocation methodology prescribed by government regulations pertaining to
    government contractors. Allocated costs to the Businesses were $5,208 and
    $759 (unaudited) for the three months ended March 31, 1997 and 1996,
    respectively.

    Pensions

         Certain of the Businesses participate in various Lockheed
    Martin-sponsored pension plans covering certain employees. Eligibility for
    participation in these plans varies, and benefits are generally based on
    members' compensation and years of service. Lockheed Martin's funding
    policy is generally to contribute in accordance with cost accounting
    standards that affect government contractors, subject to the Internal
    Revenue code and regulations. Since the aforementioned pension
    arrangements are part of certain Lockheed Martin defined benefit plans, no
    separate actuarial data is available for the portion allocable to the
    Businesses. Therefore, no liability or asset is reflected in the
    accompanying combined financial statements. The Businesses have been
    allocated pension costs based upon participant employee headcount. Pension
    expense included in the accompanying financial statements was $1,848 and
    $1,083 (unaudited) for the three months ended March 31, 1997 and 1996,
    respectively.

    Postretirement Health Care and Life Insurance Benefits

         In addition to participating in Lockheed Martin-sponsored pension
    plans, certain of the Businesses provide varying levels of health care and
    life insurance benefits for retired employees and dependents. Participants
    are eligible for these benefits when they retire from active service and
    meet the pension plan eligibility requirements. These benefits are funded
    primarily on a pay-as-you-go basis with the retiree generally paying a
    portion of the cost through contributions, deductibles and coinsurance
    provisions.

         Since the aforementioned postretirement benefits are part of certain
    Lockheed Martin postretirement arrangements, no separate actuarial data is
    available for the portion allocable to the Businesses. Accordingly, no
    liability is reflected in the accompanying financial statements. The
    Businesses have been allocated postretirement benefits cost based on
    participant employee headcount. Postretirement benefit costs included in
    the accompanying financial statements was $616 and $529 (unaudited) for
    the three months ended March 31, 1997 and 1996, respectively.
<PAGE>
    Employee Savings Plans

         Under various employee savings plans sponsored by Lockheed Martin,
    the Businesses match the contributions of participating employees up to a
    designated level. The extent of the match, vesting terms and the form of
    the matching contribution vary among the plans. Under these plans, the
    matching contributions, in cash, common stock or both, were $1,241 and
    $386 (unaudited) for the three months ended March 31, 1997 and 1996,
    respectively.

    Stock Options

         Certain employees of the Businesses participate in Lockheed Martin's
    stock option plans. All stock options granted have 10 year terms and vest
    over a two year service period. Exercise prices of options awarded in both
    years were equal to the market price of the stock on the date of grant.
    Pro Forma information regarding net earnings (loss) as required by SFAS
    No. 123 has been determined as if the Company had accounted for its
    employee stock options under the fair value method. The fair value for
    these options was estimated at the date of grant using a Black-
    Scholes option pricing model with the following weighted-average
    assumptions for 1996 and 1995, respectively: risk-free interest rates
    of 5.58% and 6.64%; divided yield of 1.70%; volatility factors related
    to the expected market price of Lockheed Martin's common stock of .186
    and .216; and weighted-average expected option life of five years. The
    weighted average fair values of options granted during 1997 was $17.24.

         For the purpose of pro forma disclosures, the options, estimated
    fair values are amortized to expense over the options' vesting periods.
    The Businesses' pro forma net loss for the three months ended March 31,
    1997 was $386.

    Interest Expense

         Interest expense has been allocated to the Businesses by applying
    Lockheed Martin's weighted average consolidated interest rate to the
    portion of the beginning of the period invested equity account deemed to
    be financed by consolidated debt, which has been determined based on
    Lockheed Martin's debt to equity ratio on such date. Management of the
    Businesses believes that this allocation methodology is reasonable.

    Interest expense was calculated using the following balances and interest
    rates:
<PAGE>
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>

                                               For the Three Months
                                                  Ended March 31,
                                          ----------------------------
                                              1997           1996
                                          ------------  --------------
                                                          (unaudited)
<S>                                      <C>            <C>

    Invested Equity . . . . . . . . . .    $ 473,609     $ 194,663

    Interest Rate . . . . . . . . . . .          7.1%          7.4%
</TABLE>



    Income Taxes

         The Businesses are included in the consolidated Federal income tax
    return and certain combined and separate state and local income tax
    returns of Lockheed Martin. However, for purposes of these financial
    statements, the provision for income taxes has been allocated to the
    Businesses based upon combined income before income taxes. Income taxes,
    current and deferred, are considered to have been paid or charged to
    Lockheed Martin and are recorded through the invested equity account with
    Lockheed Martin. The principal components of the deferred taxes are
    contract accounting methods, property, plant and equipment, goodwill
    amortization and timing of accruals and reserves.

    Statements of Cash Flows

         The Businesses participate in Lockheed Martin's cash management
    system, under which all cash is received and payments are made by Lockheed
    Martin. All transactions between the Businesses and Lockheed Martin have
    been accounted for as settled in cash at the time such transactions were
    recorded by the Businesses.

    4.  Contracts in Process

         Billings and accumulated costs and profits on contracts, principally
    with the U.S. Government, comprise the following:
<PAGE>
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>

                                                       March 31, 1997
                                                      ---------------
<S>                                                   <C>

    Billed contract receivables . . . . . . . . . .       35,664
    Other billed receivables, principally
      commercial and affiliates . . . . . . . . . .       42,693
    Unbilled contract receivables . . . . . . . . .       93,494
    Inventoried costs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .       70,904
                                                        --------
                                                         242,755
    Less, unliquidated progress payments  . . . . .       27,207
                                                        --------
                                                         215,548
                                                        ========
</TABLE>
 
        The U.S. Government has title to, or a security interest in,
    inventories to which progress payments are applied. Unbilled contract
    receivables represent accumulated costs and profits earned but not yet
    billed to customers at year-end. The Businesses believe that substantially
    all such amounts will be billed and collected within one year.

         The following data has been used in the determination of cost of
    sales:


                                                  For the Three Months Ended
                                                 ---------------------------
                                                     1997          1996
                                                 -----------   -------------
                                                                 (unaudited)

    General and administrative costs
      included in inventoried costs  . . . . .    $ 14,536         $   857
    General and administrative costs
      charged to inventory . . . . . . . . . .       8,680           1,529
    Independent research and development
      and bid and proposal costs charged
      to inventory  . . . . . . . . . . . . .       12,024            932


<PAGE>
    5.   Property, Plant and Equipment


<TABLE>
<CAPTION>

                                                                                                             March 31, 1997
                                                                                                            ----------------
<S>                                                                                                         <C>

    Land  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .              $   9,200
    Building and Improvements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                 27,000
    Machinery, equipment, furniture and fixtures  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                 75,711
    Leasehold improvements  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                  8,512
                                                                                                                 ---------
                                                                                                                 $ 120,423
                                                                                                                 =========
</TABLE>

         Depreciation and amortization expense was $4,529 and $1,166
    (unaudited) for the three months ended March 31, 1997 and 1996,
    respectively. Included within property, plant and equipment is
    approximately $15,000 of assets held for sale which approximates fair
    value.

    6.  Income Taxes

         The (benefit) provision for income taxes was calculated by applying
    statutory tax rates to the reported loss before income taxes after
    considering items that do not enter into the determination of taxable
    income and tax credits reflected in the consolidated provision of Lockheed
    Martin, which are related to the Businesses. For the three months ended
    March 31, 1997 and 1996, it is estimated that the (benefit) provision for
    deferred taxes represent $1,315 and $7 (unaudited), respectively.
    Substantially all the income of the Businesses are from domestic
    operations.

         The effective income tax rate differs from the statutory Federal
    income tax rate for the following reasons:

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                      March 31, 1997            March 31, 1996
                                                                                     -----------------         ----------------
                                                                                                                 (unaudited)
<S>                                                                                  <C>                       <C>

    Statutory Federal income tax rate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .            (35.0)%                 (34.0)%
    Amortization of cost in excess of net assets acquired . . . . . . . . . . .             (8.1)                   65.3
    Research and development and other tax credits  . . . . . . . . . . . . . .            (11.3)
    State and local income taxes, net of Federal income tax benefit
      and state and local income tax credits . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                     4.8                     6.3
    Foreign sales corporation tax benefits  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .             (8.4)
    Other, net  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .              9.1                     3.6
                                                                                           -----                   -----
    Effective income tax rate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .            (48.9%)                  41.2%
                                                                                           =====                   =====
</TABLE>
<PAGE>
    7.  Sales to Principal Customers

         The Businesses operate primarily in one industry segment, electronic
    components and systems. Sales to principal customers are as follows:


                                               March 31, 1997   March 31, 1996
                                               --------------   --------------
                                                                 (unaudited)

    U.S. Government Agencies  . . . . . .       $ 128,505          $41,153
    Foreign (principally foreign
      governments) . . . . . . . . . . . .         13,612
    Other (principally U.S. Commercial)  .         16,756
                                                ---------           -------
                                                $ 158,873           $41,153
                                                =========           =======



    8.  Commitments and Contingencies

         The Businesses lease certain facilities and equipment under
    agreements expiring at various dates through 2011. At March 31, 1997,
    future minimum payments for noncancellable operating leases with initial
    or remaining terms in excess of one year are $10,600 (nine months) for
    1997 and 1998, $10,400 for each of the years 1999 and 2000, $10,200 and
    2001, and $6,800 in total thereafter.

         Leases covering major items of real estate and equipment contain
    renewal and or purchase options which may be exercised by the Businesses.
    Rent expense, net of sublease income from other Lockheed Martin entities,
    was $2,553 and $1,150 (unaudited) for the three months ended March 31,
    1997 and 1996, respectively.

         Management is continually assessing the Businesses' obligations with
    respect to applicable environmental protection laws. While it is difficult
    to determine the timing and ultimate cost to be incurred by the Businesses
    in order to comply with these laws, based upon available internal and
    external assessments, with respect to those environmental loss
    contingencies of which management of the Businesses is aware, the
    Businesses believe that even without considering potential insurance
    recoveries, if any, there are no environmental loss contingencies that,
    individually or in the aggregate, would be material to the Businesses'
    results of operations. The Businesses accrue for these contingencies when
    it is probable that a liability has been incurred and the amount of the
    loss can be reasonably estimated.

         The Businesses are engaged in providing products and services under
    contracts with the U.S. Government and to a lesser degree, under foreign
    government contracts, some of which are funded by the U.S. Government. All
    such contracts are subject to extensive legal and regulatory requirements,
    and, from time to time, agencies of the U.S. Government investigate
    whether such contracts were and are being conducted in accordance with
    these requirements. Under government procurement regulations, an
<PAGE>
    indictment of the Businesses by a federal grand jury could result in the
    Businesses being suspended for a period of time from eligibility for
    awards of new government contracts. A conviction could result in debarment
    from contracting with the federal government for a specified term.

         The Businesses are periodically subject to litigation, claims or
    assessments and various contingent liabilities (including environmental
    matters) incidental to their business. With respect to those investigative
    actions, items of litigation, claims or assessments of which they are
    aware, management of the Businesses is of the opinion that the probability
    is remote that, after taking into account certain provisions that have
    been made with respect to these matters, the ultimate resolution of any
    such investigative actions, items of litigation, claims or assessments
    will have a material adverse effect on the combined financial position or
    results of operations of the Businesses.
<PAGE>
                        LOCKHEED MARTIN PREDECESSOR BUSINESS
                           COMBINED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS


                  As of December 31, 1996 and 1995 and for the three
                      years in the period ended December 31, 1996
<PAGE>
                          REPORT OF INDEPENDENT AUDITORS


    To the Board of Directors of
      Lockheed Martin Corporation:

         We have audited the accompanying combined balance sheet of the
    Lockheed Martin Predecessor Businesses, as defined in Note 1 to the
    financial statements, (the "Businesses") as of December 31, 1996 and the
    related combined statements of operations and changes in invested equity
    and cash flows for the year then ended. These financial statements are the
    responsibility of the Businesses' management. Our responsibility is to
    express an opinion on these financial statements based on our audit. We
    did not audit the financial statements of the Lockheed Martin
    Communications Systems Division, which statements reflect total assets and
    sales constituting 35 percent and 30 percent of the related combined
    totals. Those statements were audited by other auditors whose report has
    been furnished to us, and our opinion, insofar as it relates to the
    amounts included for the Communications Systems Division, is based solely
    on the report of the other auditors.

         We conducted our audit in accordance with generally accepted
    auditing standards. Those standards require that we plan and perform the
    audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial
    statements are free of material misstatement. An audit includes examining,
    on a test basis, evidence supporting the amounts and disclosures in the
    financial statements. An audit also includes assessing the accounting
    principles used and significant estimates made by management, as well as
    evaluating the overall financial statement presentation. We believe that
    our audit and the report of other auditors provide a reasonable basis for
    our opinion.

         In our opinion, based on our audit and the report of the other
    auditors, the financial statements referred to above present fairly, in
    all material respects, the combined financial position of the Lockheed
    Martin Predecessor Businesses as of December 31, 1996 and their combined
    results of operations and cash flows for the year then ended, in
    conformity with generally accepted accounting principles.


                                                  /s/ Coopers & Lybrand L.L.P.
     1301 Avenue of the Americas
     New York, New York 10019
     March 20, 1997
<PAGE>
                          REPORT OF INDEPENDENT AUDITORS


    Board of Directors
     Lockheed Martin Corporation:

         We have audited the combined balance sheets of Lockheed Martin
    Communications Systems Division, as defined in Note 1 to the financial
    statements, as of December 31, 1996 and 1995, and the related combined
    statements of operations and changes in invested equity, and cash flows
    for each of the three years in the period ended December 31, 1996. These
    financial statements are the responsibility of the Division's and Lockheed
    Martin Corporation's management. Our responsibility is to express an
    opinion on these financial statements based on our audits.

         We conducted our audits in accordance with generally accepted
    auditing standards. Those standards require that we plan and perform the
    audits to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial
    statements are free of material misstatement. An audit includes examining,
    on a test basis, evidence supporting the amounts and disclosures in the
    financial statements. An audit also includes assessing the accounting
    principles used and significant estimates made by management, as well as
    evaluating the overall financial statement presentation. We believe that
    our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinion.

         In our opinion, the combined financial statements referred to above
    present fairly, in all material respects, the combined financial position
    of Lockheed Martin Communications Systems Division at December 31, 1996
    (not presented separately herein) and 1995, and the combined results of
    its operations and its cash flows for the year ended December 31, 1996
    (not presented separately herein), and the results of its operations and
    its cash flows for each of the two years in the period ended December 31,
    1995, in conformity with generally accepted accounting principles.


                                                         /s/ Ernst & Young LLP
     Washington, D.C.
     March 7, 1997
<PAGE>
                      LOCKHEED MARTIN PREDECESSOR BUSINESSES

                             COMBINED BALANCE SHEETS
                                  (In thousands)


<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
  
                                                                                               Years Ended
                                                                                               December 31,
                                                                                    ---------------------------------- 
                                                                                         1996               1995
                                                                                    ---------------    ---------------
<S>                                                                                 <C>                <C>

                                       ASSETS
    Current assets:
      Contracts in process  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .               $ 198,073           $  42,457
      Other current assets  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                   3,661               3,100
                                                                                      ---------           ---------
          Total current assets  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .             201,734              45,557
                                                                                      ---------           ---------
    Property, plant and equipment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                 116,566              31,657
      Less, accumulated depreciation and amortization . . . . . . . . .                  24,983              15,018
                                                                                      ---------           ---------
                                                                                         91,583              16,639
                                                                                      ---------           ---------
    Intangibles, primarily cost in excess of net assets acquired, net
      of amortization  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                282,674             157,560
    Other assets  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                  17,307               8,753
                                                                                      ---------           ---------
                                                                                      $ 593,298           $ 228,509
                                                                                      =========           =========

                          LIABILITIES AND INVESTED EQUITY

    Current liabilities:
      Accounts payable, trade  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .              $  34,163           $   9,583
      Accrued employment costs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                 27,313               6,534
      Customer advances and amounts in excess of costs incurred  . . . .                 14,299               1,363
      Other current liabilities  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                 27,113               6,983
                                                                                      ---------            --------
        Total current liabilities   . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .               102,888              24,463
                                                                                      ---------            --------

    Other liabilities . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .          16,801               9,383
    Commitments and contingencies (Note 8)
    Invested equity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .         473,609             194,663
                                                                                      ---------            --------
                                                                                      $ 593,298           $ 228,509
                                                                                      =========           =========
</TABLE>



                   See notes to combined financial statements.
<PAGE>
                      LOCKHEED MARTIN PREDECESSOR BUSINESSES

         COMBINED STATEMENTS OF OPERATIONS AND CHANGES IN INVESTED EQUITY
                                  (In thousands)


<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                        Years Ended December 31,
                                                                            -------------------------------------------------
                                                                                1996               1995               1994
                                                                            -------------      -----------          ---------
<S>                                                                         <C>                <C>                  <C>
 
   Sales . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .             $ 543,081          $ 166,781           $ 218,845
   Cost of sales . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .               499,390            162,132             210,466
                                                                             ---------          ---------           ---------
   Operating income  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                43,691              4,649               8,379
   Allocated interest expense  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                24,197              4,475               5,450
                                                                             ---------          ---------           ---------
   Earnings before income taxes  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                19,494                174               2,929
   Income tax expense  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                 7,798              1,186               2,293
                                                                             ---------          ---------           ---------
   Net earnings (loss) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                11,696             (1,012)                636
   Invested equity--beginning of year  . . . . . . . . . . . . .               194,663            199,506             216,943
   Advances from (repayments to) Lockheed Martin . . . . . . . .               267,250             (3,831)            (18,073)
                                                                             ---------          ---------           ---------

   Invested equity -- end of year  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .             $ 473,609          $ 194,663           $ 199,506
                                                                             =========          =========          ==========
</TABLE>




                   See notes to combined financial statements.
<PAGE>
                      LOCKHEED MARTIN PREDECESSOR BUSINESSES

                        COMBINED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS
                                  (In thousands)


<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                        Years Ended December 31,
                                                                            -------------------------------------------------
                                                                                 1996             1995              1994
                                                                            --------------     -----------      -------------
<S>                                                                         <C>                <C>              <C>

    Operating activities:
    Net earnings (loss) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .            $  11,696          $(1,012)          $   636
    Depreciation and amortization . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .               25,039           11,578            11,467
    Loss (gain) on disposition of property, plant and equipment .                  265               26            (1,078)
    Changes in operating assets and liabilities
      Contracts in process   . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                      26,103           (3,267)           14,002
      Other current assets   . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                         489              788             1,502
      Other assets   . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                      (5,246)           1,245             2,044
      Accounts payable   . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                       3,198             (648)           (3,099)
      Accrued employment costs . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                       2,282             (611)             (528)
      Customer advances and amounts in excess of costs
        incurred  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                    (11,586)           (2,041)             917
      Other current liabilities  . . . . . . . . . . . . .                       4,086             4,004           (3,304)
      Other liabilities  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                     (25,327)             (699)            (751)
                                                                             ---------          --------           ------
    Net cash from operating activities  . . . . . . . . . . . . .               30,999             9,363           21,808
                                                                             ---------          --------           ------

    Investing activities:
    Acquisition of business . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .             (287,803)               --               --
    Capital expenditures  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .              (13,528)           (5,532)          (3,735)
    Disposition of property, plant and equipment  . . . . . . . .                3,082                --               --
                                                                             ---------          --------           ------
    Net cash used in investing activities . . . . . . . . . . . .             (298,249)           (5,532)          (3,735)
                                                                             ---------          --------           ------

    Financing activities:
    Advances from (repayments to) Lockheed Martin . . . . . . . .              267,250            (3,831)         (18,073)
                                                                             ---------          --------           ------

    Net change in cash  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                   --                --               --
                                                                             =========          ========           ======
</TABLE>




                   See notes to combined financial statements.
<PAGE>
                      LOCKHEED MARTIN PREDECESSOR BUSINESSES
                      NOTES TO COMBINED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
                                December 31, 1996
                              (Dollars in thousands)


    1.  Background and Description of Businesses

         On January 31, 1997, Lockheed Martin Corporation ("Lockheed
    Martin"), Lehman Brothers Holdings Inc. ("Lehman"), Frank C. Lanza
    ("Lanza") and Robert V. LaPenta ("LaPenta") entered into a Memorandum of
    Understanding regarding the transfer of certain businesses of Lockheed
    Martin to a newly formed corporation ("Newco") to be owned by Lockheed
    Martin, Lehman, Lanza and LaPenta. The businesses proposed to be
    transferred include Lockheed Martin's Wideband Systems Division,
    Communications Systems Division and Products Group, comprising eleven
    autonomous operations (collectively the "Lockheed Martin Predecessor
    Businesses" or the "Businesses"). Also included in the transaction is the
    acquisition of a semiconductor product line of another business and
    certain leasehold improvements in New York City.

         Effective April 1, 1996, Lockheed Martin acquired substantially all
    the assets and liabilities of the defense businesses of Loral Corporation
    (Loral), including the Wideband Systems Division and the Products Group.
    The acquisition of the Wideband Systems Division and Products Group
    businesses (the "Acquired Businesses") has been accounted for as a
    purchase by Lockheed Martin Communications Systems Division ("Division").
    The acquisition has been reflected in these financial statements based on
    the purchase price allocated to those acquired businesses by Lockheed
    Martin. As such, the accompanying combined financial statements reflect
    the results of operations of the Division and the Acquired Businesses from
    the effective date of acquisition including the effects of an allocated
    portion of cost in excess of net assets acquired resulting from the
    acquisition. The assets and liabilities recorded in connection with the
    purchase price allocation were $400,993 and $113,190, respectively.

         Had the acquisition of Wideband Systems Division and the Products
    Group occurred on January 1, 1995, the unaudited pro forma sales and net
    income for the years ending December 31, 1996 and 1995 would have been
    $675,281 and $12,638, and $691,136 and $4,790, respectively. The pro forma
    results, which are based on various assumptions, are not necessarily
    indicative of what would have occurred had the acquisition been
    consummated on January 1, 1995.

         The Businesses are suppliers of sophisticated secure communication
    systems and specialized communication products including secure, high data
    rate communication systems, commercial fixed wireless communication
    products, microwave components, avionic displays and recorders and
    instrument products. The Company's customers included the Department of
    Defense, selected U.S. government intelligence agencies, major
    aerospace/defense prime contractors and commercial customers. The
    Businesses operate primarily in one industry segment, electronic
    components and systems.

         Substantially all the Businesses' products are sold to agencies of
    the U.S. Government, primarily the Department of Defense, to foreign
<PAGE>
                     LOCKHEED MARTIN PREDECESSOR BUSINESSES
              NOTES TO COMBINED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS - (continued)
                           (Dollars in thousands)

    government agencies or to prime contractors or subcontractors thereof. All
    domestic government contracts and subcontracts of the Businesses are
    subject to audit and various cost controls, and include standard
    provisions for termination for the convenience of the U.S. Government.
    Multi-year U.S. Government contracts and related orders are subject to
    cancellation if funds for contract performance for any subsequent year
    become unavailable. Foreign government contracts generally include
    comparable provisions relating to termination for the convenience of the
    government.

         The decline in the U.S. defense budget since the mid 1980s has
    resulted in program delays, cancellations and scope reduction for defense
    contracts in general. These events may or may not have an effect on the
    Businesses' programs; however, in the event that U.S. Government
    expenditures for products of the type manufactured by the Businesses are
    reduced, and not offset by greater commercial sales or other new programs
    or products, or acquisitions, there may be a reduction in the volume of
    contracts or subcontracts awarded to the Businesses.

    2.  Summary of Significant Accounting Policies

    Basis of Presentation and Use of Estimates

         The accompanying combined financial statements reflect the
    Businesses' assets, liabilities and operations included in Lockheed
    Martin's historical financial statements that will be transferred to
    Newco. Intercompany accounts between Lockheed Martin and the Businesses
    have been included in invested equity. Significant inter-business
    transactions and balances have been eliminated. The assets and operations
    of the semiconductor product line and certain other facilities, which are
    not material to the combined financial statements, have been excluded from
    the combined financial statements.

         The preparation of financial statements in conformity with generally
    accepted accounting principles requires the Businesses' management to make
    estimates and assumptions that affect the reported amounts of assets and
    liabilities and disclosure of contingent assets and liabilities at the
    date of the financial statements and the reported amounts of revenue and
    expenses during the reporting period. The most significant of these
    estimates and assumptions relate to contract estimates of sales and costs,
    allocations from Lockheed Martin, recoverability of recorded amounts of
    fixed assets and cost in excess of net assets acquired, litigation and
    environmental obligations. Actual results could differ from these
    estimates.

    Sales and Earnings

         Sales and profits on cost reimbursable contracts are recognized as
    costs are incurred. Sales and estimated profits under long-term contracts
    are recognized under the percentage of completion method of accounting
    using the cost-to-cost method. Amounts representing contract change orders
    or claims are included in sales only when they can be reliably estimated
    and realization is probable. Sales under short-term production-type
    contracts are recorded as units are shipped; profits applicable to such
    shipments are recorded pro rata, based upon estimated total profit at
    completion of the contract. Amounts representing contract change orders or
<PAGE>
                     LOCKHEED MARTIN PREDECESSOR BUSINESSES
              NOTES TO COMBINED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS - (continued)
                             (Dollars in thousands)

    claims are included in sales only when they can be reliably estimated and
    realization is probable. Losses on contracts are recognized when
    determined. Revisions in profit estimates are reflected in the period in
    which the facts which require the revision become known.

    Contracts In Process

         Costs accumulated under long-term contracts include direct costs, as
    well as manufacturing overhead, and for government contracts, general and
    administrative costs, independent research and development costs and bid
    and proposal costs. Contracts in process contain amounts relating to
    contracts and programs for which the related operating cycles are longer
    that one year. In accordance with industry practice, these amounts are
    included in current assets.

    Property, Plant and Equipment

         Property, plant and equipment are stated at cost. Depreciation is
    provided primarily using an accelerated method over the estimated useful
    lives (5 to 20 years) of the related assets. Leasehold improvements are
    amortized over the shorter of the lease term or the estimated useful life
    of the improvements.

    Intangibles

         Intangibles, primarily the excess of the cost of purchased
    businesses over the fair value of the net assets acquired, is being
    amortized using a straight-line method primarily over a 40-year period.
    Other intangibles are amortized over their estimated useful lives which
    range from 11-15 years. Amortization expense was $10,115, $6,086 and
    $6,086 for 1996, 1995 and 1994, respectively. Accumulated amortization was
    $26,524 and $16,738 at December 31, 1996 and 1995, respectively.

         Intangibles include costs allocated to the Businesses relating to
    the Request for Funding Authorization ("RFA"), consisting of over 20
    restructuring projects to reduce operating costs, initiated by General
    Electric ("GE") Aerospace in 1990 and to the REC Advance Agreement
    ("RAA"), a restructuring plan initiated after Lockheed Martin's
    acquisition of GE Aerospace. The RAA was initiated to close two regional
    electronic manufacturing centers. Restructure costs are reimbursable from
    the U.S. Government if savings can be demonstrated to exceed costs. The
    total cost of restructuring under the RFA and the RAA represented
    approximately 15% of the estimated savings to the U.S. Government and,
    therefore, a deferred asset has been recorded by Lockheed Martin. The
    deferred asset is being allocated to all the former GE Aerospace sites,
    including the Communications Systems Division, on a basis that includes
    manufacturing labor, overhead, and direct material less non-hardware
    subcontracts. As of December 31, 1996 and 1995, approximately $4,400 and
    $7,500, respectively of unamortized RFA and RAA costs are incurred on the
    Businesses' combined balance sheet in other current assets and other
    assets.
<PAGE>
                     LOCKHEED MARTIN PREDECESSOR BUSINESSES
              NOTES TO COMBINED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS - (continued)
                            (Dollars in thousands)

         The carrying values of intangible assets are reviewed if the facts
    and circumstances indicate potential impairment of their carrying value.
    If this review indicates that intangible assets are not recoverable, as
    determined based on the undiscounted cash flows of the entity acquired
    over the remaining amortization period, the Division's carrying values
    related to the intangible assets are reduced by the estimated shortfall of
    cash flows.

    Research and Development and Similar Costs

         Research and development costs sponsored by the Businesses include
    research and development and bid and proposal effort related to government
    products and services. These costs generally are allocated among all
    contracts and programs in progress under U.S. Government contractual
    arrangements. Customer-sponsored research and development costs incurred
    pursuant to contracts are accounted for as direct contract costs.

    Financial Instruments

         At December 31, 1996, the carrying value of the Businesses'
    financial instruments, such as receivables, accounts payable and accrued
    liabilities, approximate fair value, based on the short-term maturities of
    these instruments.

    New Accounting Pronouncements

         Effective January 1, 1996, the Businesses adopted Statement of
    Financial Accounting Standards No. 121, "Accounting for the Impairment of
    Long-Lived Assets and Long-Lived Assets to Be Disposed Of" ("SFAS 121").
    SFAS 121 establishes the accounting standards for the impairment of
    long-lived assets, certain intangible assets and cost in excess of net
    assets acquired to be held and used for long-lived assets and certain
    intangible assets to be disposed of. The impact of adopting SFAS 121 was
    not material.

         Effective January 1, 1994, the Businesses adopted Statement of
    Financial Accounting Standards No. 112, "Employers' Accounting for
    Postretirement Benefits" ("SFAS 112"). SFAS 112 requires that the costs of
    benefits provided to employees after employment but before retirement be
    recognized on an accrual basis. The adoption of SFAS 112 did not have a
    material impact on the combined results of operations of the Businesses.

    3.  Transactions with Lockheed Martin

         The Businesses rely on Lockheed Martin for certain services,
    including treasury, cash management, employee benefits, taxes, risk
    management, internal audit, financial reporting, contract administration
    and general corporate services. Although certain assets, liabilities and
    expenses related to these services have been allocated to the Businesses,
    the combined financial position, results of operations and cash flows
    presented in the accompanying combined financial statements would not be
    the same as would have occurred had the Businesses been independent
    entities. The following describes the related party transactions.
<PAGE>
                     LOCKHEED MARTIN PREDECESSOR BUSINESSES
              NOTES TO COMBINED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS - (continued)
                           (Dollars in thousands)

    Sales of Products

         The Businesses sell products to Lockheed Martin and its affiliates,
    net sales for which were $70,658, $25,874, and $9,983 in 1996, 1995 and
    1994, respectively. Included in Contracts in Process are receivables from
    Lockheed Martin and its affiliates of $10,924 and $30 at December 31, 1996
    and 1995, respectively.

    Allocation of Corporate Expenses

         The amount of allocated corporate expenses reflected in these
    combined financial statements has been estimated based primarily on an
    allocation methodology prescribed by government regulations pertaining to
    government contractors. Allocated costs to the Businesses were $10,057,
    $2,964 and $4,141 in 1996, 1995 and 1994, respectively.

    Pensions

         Certain of the Businesses participate in various Lockheed
    Martin-sponsored pension plans covering certain employees. Eligibility for
    participation in these plans varies, and benefits are generally based on
    members' compensation and years of service. Lockheed Martin's funding
    policy is generally to contribute in accordance with cost accounting
    standards that affect government contractors, subject to the Internal
    Revenue code and regulations. Since the aforementioned pension
    arrangements are part of certain Lockheed Martin defined benefit plans, no
    separate actuarial data is available for the portion allocable to the
    Businesses. Therefore, no liability or asset is reflected in the
    accompanying combined financial statements. The Businesses have been
    allocated pension costs based upon participant employee headcount. Net
    pension expense included in the accompanying financial statements was
    $7,027, $4,134 and $3,675 in 1996, 1995 and 1994, respectively.

    Postretirement Health Care and Life Insurance Benefits

         In addition to participating in Lockheed Martin-sponsored pension
    plans, certain of the Businesses provide varying levels of health care and
    life insurance benefits for retired employees and dependents. Participants
    are eligible for these benefits when they retire from active service and
    meet the pension plan eligibility requirements. These benefits are funded
    primarily on a pay-as-you-go basis with the retiree generally paying a
    portion of the cost through contributions, deductibles and coinsurance
    provisions. Since the aforementioned postretirement benefits are part of
    certain Lockheed Martin postretirement arrangements, no separate actuarial
    data is available for the portion allocable to the Businesses.
    Accordingly, no liability is reflected in the accompanying financial
    statements. The Businesses have been allocated postretirement benefits
    cost based on participant employee headcount. Postretirement benefit costs
    included in the accompanying financial statements were $2,787, $2,124 and
    $1,694 in 1996, 1995 and 1994, respectively.
<PAGE>
                     LOCKHEED MARTIN PREDECESSOR BUSINESSES
              NOTES TO COMBINED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS - (continued)
                            (Dollars in thousands)


    Employee Savings Plan

         Under various employee savings plans sponsored by Lockheed Martin,
    the Businesses match the contributions of participating employees up to a
    designated level. The extent of the match, vesting terms and the form of
    the matching contribution vary among the plans. Under these plans, the
    matching contributions, in cash, common stock or both, for 1996, 1995 and
    1994 were $3,940, $1,478 and $1,842, respectively.

    Stock Options

         During 1996 and 1995, certain employees of the Businesses participated 
    in Lockheed Martin's stock option plans. All stock options granted in 
    1996 and 1995 have 10 year terms andvest over a two year service 
    period. Exercise prices of options awarded in both years were equal 
    to the market price of the stock on the date of grant. Pro forma 
    information regarding net earnings (loss) as required 
    by SFAS No. 123 has been determined as if the Company had accounted for its 
    employee stock options under the fair value method. The fair value for 
    these options was estimated at the date of grant using a Black-Scholes 
    option pricing model with the following weighted-average assumptions for 
    1996 and 1995, respectively:  risk-free interest rates of 5.58% and 6.64%; 
    dividend yield of 1.70%; volatility factors related to the expected market 
    price of the Lockheed Martin's common stock of .186 and .216; and 
    weighted-average expected option life of five years. The weighted average 
    fair values of options granted during 1996 and 1995 were $17.24 and $16.09, 
    respectively.

         For the purposes of pro forma disclosures, the options' estimated
    fair values are amortized to expense over the options' vesting periods.
    The Businesses' pro forma net earnings (loss) for 1996 and 1995 were 
    $11,531 and $(1,040), respectively.

    Interest Expense

         Interest expense has been allocated to the Businesses by applying
    Lockheed Martin's weighted average consolidated interest rate to the
    portion of the beginning of the period invested equity account deemed to
    be financed by consolidated debt, which has been determined based on
    Lockheed Martin's debt to equity ratio on such date, except that the
    acquisition of the defense business of Loral Corporation ("Loral") has
    been assumed to be fully financed by debt.

         Interest expense was calculated using the following balances and
    interest rates:
<PAGE>
                     LOCKHEED MARTIN PREDECESSOR BUSINESSES
              NOTES TO COMBINED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS - (continued)
                         (Dollars in thousands)

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>

                                                                                        Years Ended December 31,
                                                                            -----------------------------------------------
                                                                               1996             1995               1994
                                                                            ---------        -----------        -----------
<S>                                                                         <C>              <C>                <C>

    Invested Equity:
       Communications Systems Division  . . . . . . . . . .               $ 194,663           $ 199,506          $ 216,943
       Wideband Systems Division and Products Group . . . .               $ 287,803                  --                 --
    Interest Rate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .              7.20%               7.40%              7.23%

</TABLE>


    Income Taxes

         The Businesses are included in the consolidated Federal income tax
    return and certain combined and separate state and local income tax
    returns of Lockheed Martin. However, for purposes of these financial
    statements, the provision for income taxes has been allocated to the
    Businesses based upon reported combined income before income taxes. Income
    taxes, current and deferred, are considered to have been paid or charged
    to Lockheed Martin and are recorded through the invested equity account
    with Lockheed Martin. The principal components of the deferred taxes are
    contract accounting methods, property, plant and equipment, goodwill
    amortization and timing of actuals.

    Statements of Cash Flows

         The Businesses participate in Lockheed Martin's cash management
    system, under which all cash is received and payments are made by Lockheed
    Martin. All transactions between the Businesses and Lockheed Martin have
    been accounted for as settled in cash at the time such transactions were
    recorded by the Businesses.

    4.  Contracts in Process

         Billings and accumulated costs and profits on contracts, principally
    with the U.S. Government, comprise the following:
<PAGE>
                     LOCKHEED MARTIN PREDECESSOR BUSINESSES
              NOTES TO COMBINED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS - (continued)
                           (Dollars in thousands)

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>

                                                                                                    Years Ended
                                                                                                    December 31,
                                                                                           -------------------------------  
                                                                                               1996               1995
                                                                                           ----------           ----------      
<S>                                                                                        <C>                  <C>

    Billed contract receivables . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .            $  40,299              $10,237
    Other billed receivables, principally commercial  . . . . . . . . . . . . .               41,154                  --
    Unbilled contract receivables . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .               91,053               23,643
    Inventoried costs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .               61,380               10,830
                                                                                            --------               ------
                                                                                             233,886               44,710
    Less, unliquidated progress payments  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .              (35,813)              (2,253)
                                                                                            --------               ------
                                                                                           $ 198,073              $42,457
                                                                                           =========              =======
</TABLE>


         The U.S. Government has title to, or a security interest in,
    inventories to which progress payments are applied. Unbilled contract
    receivables represent accumulated costs and profits earned but not yet
    billed to customers at year-end. The Businesses believe that substantially
    all such amounts will be billed and collected within one year.

         The following data has been used in the determination of cost of
    sales:

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>

                                                                                        Years Ended December 31,
                                                                            -----------------------------------------------
                                                                                1996             1995              1994
                                                                            -----------       -----------       -----------
<S>                                                                         <C>               <C>               <C>

    General and administrative costs included in
      inventoried costs  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .            $ 14,700           $ 1,156           $   493
    General and administrative costs charged to inventory  . . .            $ 25,400           $ 3,967           $ 3,640
    Independent research and development and bid and
      proposal costs incurred  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .            $ 36,500           $ 9,800           $10,640

</TABLE>
<PAGE>
                      LOCKHEED MARTIN PREDECESSOR BUSINESSES
                      NOTES TO COMBINED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS - (continued)
                                  (Dollars in thousands)


    5.  Property, Plant and Equipment


                                                 December 31,
                                           ----------------------
                                              1996         1995
                                          ---------    ----------

    Land  . . . . . . . . . . . . . .    $   9,200           --
    Buildings and Improvements  . . .       27,000           --
    Machinery, equipment, furniture
      and fixtures  . . . . . . . . .       73,137      $29,216
    Leasehold improvements  . . . . .        7,229        2,441
                                          --------      -------
                                         $ 116,566      $31,657
                                         =========      =======


         Depreciation and amortization expense in 1996, 1995 and 1994 was
    $14,924, $5,492 and $5,381, respectively.

    6.  Income Taxes

         The provision for income taxes was calculated by applying statutory
    tax rates to the reported pretax income after considering items that do
    not enter into the determination of taxable income and tax credits
    reflected in the consolidated provision of Lockheed Martin, which are
    related to the Businesses. For the years ended December 31, 1996, 1995 and
    1994, it is estimated that the provision for deferred taxes represent
    ($2,143), $3,994 and $1,252, respectively. Substantially all the income of
    the Businesses are from domestic operations.
<PAGE>
                     LOCKHEED MARTIN PREDECESSOR BUSINESSES
              NOTES TO COMBINED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS - (continued)
                            (Dollars in thousands)


         The effective income tax rate differs from the statutory Federal
    income tax rate for the following reasons:

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>

                                                                                        Years Ended December 31,
                                                                            -----------------------------------------------
                                                                               1996              1995              1994
                                                                            ----------        ----------        -----------   
<S>                                                                         <C>               <C>               <C>

    Statutory Federal income tax rate . . . . . . . . . . . . . .               35%               34%               34%
    Amortization of cost in excess of net assets acquired . . . .                2               529                31
    Research and development and other tax credits  . . . . . . .               (2)               --                --
    State and local income taxes, net of Federal income
      tax benefit and state and local income tax
      credits  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                       6               101                12
    Foreign sales corporation tax benefit . . . . . . . . . . . .               (1)               --                --
    Other, net                                                                  --                17                 1
                                                                           -------           -------           -------
    Effective income tax rate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .               40%              681%               78%
                                                                          ========          ========          ========
</TABLE>
<PAGE>
                     LOCKHEED MARTIN PREDECESSOR BUSINESSES
              NOTES TO COMBINED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS - (continued)
                            (Dollars in thousands)


    7.  Sales to Principal Customers

         The Business operate primarily in one industry segment, communication
    systems and products. Sales to principal customers are as follows:


<TABLE>
<CAPTION>

                                                                                        Years Ended December 31,
                                                                            -----------------------------------------------
                                                                               1996              1995              1994
                                                                            ----------        ----------        -----------   
<S>                                                                         <C>               <C>               <C>


    U.S. Government Agencies  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .           $425,033          $161,617          $216,084
    Foreign (principally foreign governments) . . . . . . . . . .             33,475             4,945             1,623
    Other (principally commercial)  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .             84,573               219             1,138
                                                                             -------           -------           -------
                                                                            $543,081          $166,781          $218,845
                                                                            ========          ========          ========
</TABLE>


    8.  Commitments and Contingencies

         The Businesses lease certain facilities and equipment under agreements
    expiring at various dates through 2011. At December 31, 1996, future
    minimum payments for noncancellable operating leases with initial or
    remaining terms in excess of one year are $11,400 for each of the years
    1997 through 2001, and $12,300 in total thereafter.

         Leases covering major items of real estate and equipment contain
    renewal and/or purchase options which may be exercised by the Businesses.
    Rent expense, net of sublease income from other Lockheed Martin entities,
    was $8,495, $4,772 and $5,597 in 1996, 1995 and 1994, respectively.

         Management is continually assessing the Businesses' obligations
    with respect to applicable environmental protection laws. While it is
    difficult to determine the timing and ultimate cost to be incurred by
    the Businesses in order to comply with these laws, based upon available
    internal and external assessments, with respect to those environmental
    loss contingencies of which management of the Businesses is aware, the
    Businesses believe that even without considering potential insurance
    recoveries, if any, there are no environmental loss contingencies that,
    individually or in the aggregate, would be material to the Businesses'
    results of operations. The Businesses accrue for these contingencies when
    it is probable that a liability has been incurred and the amount of the
    loss can be reasonably estimated.
<PAGE>
                     LOCKHEED MARTIN PREDECESSOR BUSINESSES
              NOTES TO COMBINED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS--(continued)
                            (Dollars in thousands)


         The Businesses are engaged in providing products and services under
    contracts with the U.S. Government and to a lesser degree under foreign
    government contracts, some of which are funded by the U.S. Government.
    All such contracts are subject to extensive legal and regulatory
    requirements, and, from time to time, agencies of the U.S. Government
    investigate whether such contracts were and are being conducted in
    accordance with these requirements. Under government procurement
    regulations, an indictment of the Businesses by a federal grand jury
    could result in the Businesses being suspended for a period of time
    from eligibility for awards of new government contracts. A conviction
    could result in debarment from contracting with the federal government
    for a specified term.

         The Businesses are periodically subject to litigation, claims or
    assessments and various contingent liabilities (including environmental
    matters) incidental to its business. With respect to those investigative
    actions, items of litigation, claims or assessments of which they are
    aware, management of the Businesses is of the opinion that the probability
    is remote that, after taking into account certain provisions that have
    been made with respect to these matters, the ultimate resolution of any
    such investigative actions, items of litigation, claims or assessments
    will have a material adverse effect on the financial position or results
    of operations of the Businesses.
<PAGE>
                        REPORT OF INDEPENDENT AUDITORS


Board of Directors of
 Lockheed Martin Corporation:

   We have audited the accompanying combined statements of operations and
cash flows for the Loral Acquired Businesses as defined in Note 1, (the
"Businesses") for the three months ended March 31, 1996 and the years ended
December 31, 1995 and 1994. These financial statements are the responsibility
of the Businesses' management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on
these financial statements based on our audits.

   We conducted our audits in accordance with generally accepted auditing
standards. Those standards require that we plan and perform the audits to
obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free
of material misstatement. An audit includes examining, on a test basis,
evidence supporting the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements.
An audit also includes assessing  the accounting principles used  and
significant estimates made by management, as well as evaluating the overall
financial statement presentation. We believe that our audits provide a
reasonable basis for our opinion.

   In our opinion, the financial statements referred to above present
fairly, in all material respects, the combined results of the operations and
cash flows of the Businesses for the three months ended March 31, 1996 and
the years ended December 31, 1995 and 1994, in conformity with generally
accepted accounting principles.


                                          /s/ Coopers & Lybrand L.L.P.
 1301 Avenue of the Americas
 New York, New York 10019
 March 20, 1997
<PAGE>
                           LORAL ACQUIRED BUSINESSES

                       COMBINED STATEMENTS OF OPERATIONS
                                (In thousands)

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>

                                                                          Three                   Years Ended December 31,
                                                                       Months Ended      -----------------------------------------
                                                                      March 31, 1996             1995                  1994
                                                                  -------------------    -------------------   -------------------
<S>                                                               <C>                    <C>                   <C>

Sales . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .          $132,200              $448,165              $283,129
Cost and expenses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .           124,426               424,899               273,181
                                                                        ---------              --------              --------
Operating income  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .             7,774                23,266                 9,948
Allocated interest expense  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .             4,365                20,799                 8,375
                                                                        ---------              --------              --------
Income before income taxes  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .             3,409                 2,467                 1,573
Income taxes  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .             1,292                   854                   560
                                                                        ---------              --------              --------
Net income  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .          $  2,117              $  1,613              $  1,013
                                                                        =========              ========              ========
</TABLE>


                  See notes to combined financial statements.
<PAGE>
                           LORAL ACQUIRED BUSINESSES

                       COMBINED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS
                                (In thousands)

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>

                                                                          Three                   Years Ended December 31,
                                                                       Months Ended      -----------------------------------------
                                                                      March 31, 1996             1995                  1994
                                                                  -------------------    -------------------   --------------------
<S>                                                               <C>                    <C>                   <C>

Operating Activities:
Net Income  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .          $  2,117             $   1,613              $ 1,013
Depreciation and amortization . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .             5,011                20,625               15,952
Changes in operating assets and liabilities
    Contracts in process  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .           (11,382)                7,327                4,499
    Other current assets  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .            (3,436)                  890                 (156)
    Other assets  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .             2,437                 6,736               (3,633)
    Accounts payable and accrued liabilities  . . . . . . . . .             4,525                (4,533)              (3,944)
    Other current liabilities . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .             3,348                 4,428               (3,150)
    Other liabilities . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .              (452)                  117                 (415)
                                                                        ---------             ---------              -------
Net cash from operating activities  . . . . . . . . . . . . . .             2,168                37,203               10,166
                                                                        ---------             ---------              -------

Investing activities:
Acquisition of business . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                --              (214,927)                  --
Capital expenditures  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .            (3,962)              (12,683)              (7,390)
Disposition of property, plant and equipment  . . . . . . . . .               187                 4,342                  144
                                                                        ---------             ---------              -------
                                                                           (3,775)             (223,268)              (7,246)
                                                                        ---------             ---------              -------

Financing activities:
Advances from (repayments to) Loral . . . . . . . . . . . . . .             1,607               186,065               (2,920)
                                                                        ---------             ----------             -------
Net change in cash  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                --                    --                   --
                                                                        =========             =========              =======
</TABLE>


                  See notes to combined financial statements.
<PAGE>
                           LORAL ACQUIRED BUSINESSES

                    NOTES TO COMBINED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
                            (Dollars in thousands)


1.  Background and Description of Business

     On January 31, 1997, Lockheed Martin Corporation ("Lockheed Martin"),
Lehman Brothers Holdings Inc. ("Lehman"), Frank C. Lanza ("Lanza") and Robert
V. LaPenta ("LaPenta") entered into a Memorandum of Understanding ("MOU")
regarding the transfer of certain businesses of Lockheed Martin to a newly
formed corporation ("Newco") to be owned by Lockheed Martin, Lehman, Lanza
and LaPenta. The businesses proposed to be transferred (the "Loral Acquired
Businesses" or "Businesses") include Lockheed Martin's Wideband Systems
Division and the Products Group, comprised of ten autonomous operations, all
of which were acquired by Lockheed Martin effective April 1, 1996 as part of
the acquisition by Lockheed Martin of the defense electronics business of
Loral Corporation ("Loral"). Also included in the transaction is the
acquisition of a semiconductor product line of another business and certain
leasehold improvements in New York City.

     The Businesses are leading suppliers of sophisticated secure
communication systems, microwave communication components, avionic and
instrumentation products and other products and services to major aerospace
and defense contractors as well as the U.S. Government. The Businesses
operate primarily in one industry segment, communication systems and
products.

     Substantially all the Business' products are sold to agencies of the
United States Government, primarily the Department of Defense, to foreign
government agencies or to prime contractors or subcontractors thereof. All
domestic government contracts and subcontracts of the Businesses are subject
to audit, various cost controls and include standard provisions for
termination for the convenience of the government. Multi-year government
contracts and related orders are subject to cancellation if funds for
contract performance for any subsequent year become unavailable. Foreign
government contracts generally include comparable provisions relating to
termination for the convenience of the government.

     The decline in the U.S. defense budget since the mid 1980s has resulted
in program delays, cancellations and scope reductions for defense contractors
in general. These events may or may not have an effect on the Businesses'
programs; however, in the event that expenditures for products of the type
manufactured by the Businesses are reduced, and not offset by greater foreign
sales or other new programs or products, or acquisitions, there may be a
reduction  in the volume of contracts or subcontracts awarded to the
Businesses.

     The Businesses' operations, as presented herein, include allocations and
estimates of certain expenses of Loral based upon estimates of services
performed by Loral that management of the Businesses believe are reasonable.
Such services include treasury, cash management, employee benefits, taxes,
risk management, internal audit and general corporate services. Accordingly,
the results of operations and cash flows as presented herein may not be the
same as would have occurred had the Businesses been independent entities.
<PAGE>
                           LORAL ACQUIRED BUSINESSES

              NOTES TO COMBINED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS--(Continued)
                            (Dollars in thousands)



2.  Basis of Presentation

Basis of Combination

     The accompanying combined financial statements reflect the Businesses'
assets, liabilities and operations included in Loral Corporation's historical
financial statements that will be transferred to Newco. All significant
intercompany transactions and amounts have been eliminated. The combined
financial statements do not include the operations of telecommunications
switch product line which will not be transferred and was exited in 1995.
Also, the assets and operations of the semiconductor product line and certain
other facilities which are not material to the Businesses have been excluded
from the financial statements.

Allocation of Corporate Expenses

     The amount of corporate office expenses reflected in these financial
statements has been estimated based primarily on the allocation methodology
prescribed by government regulations pertaining to government contractors,
which management of the Businesses believes to be a reasonable allocation
method.

Income Taxes

     The Businesses were included in the consolidated Federal income tax
return and certain combined and separate state and local income tax returns
of Loral. However, for the purposes of these financial statements, the
provision for income taxes was allocated based upon reported income before
income taxes. Such provision was recorded through the advances from
(repayments to) Loral account.

Interest Expense

     Interest expense has been allocated to the Businesses by applying
Loral's weighted average consolidated interest rate to the portion of the
beginning of the period invested equity account deemed to be financed by
consolidated debt, which amount has been determined based on the Loral's debt
to equity ratio on such date, except that the acquisition of Wideband Systems
has been assumed to be fully financed by debt.

Statements of Cash Flows

     The Businesses participated in Loral's cash management system, under
which all cash was received and payments made by Loral. All transactions
between the Businesses and Loral have been accounted for as settled in cash
on the date such transactions were recorded by the Businesses.
<PAGE>
                           LORAL ACQUIRED BUSINESSES

              NOTES TO COMBINED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS--(Continued)
                            (Dollars in thousands)

3.  Summary of Significant Accounting Policies

Contracts In Process

     Sales on long-term production-type contracts are recorded as units are
shipped; profits applicable to such shipments are recorded pro rata, based
upon estimated total profit at completion of the contract. Sales and profits
on cost reimbursable contracts are recognized as costs are incurred. Sales
and estimated profits under other long-term contracts are recognized under
the percentage of completion method of accounting using the cost-to-cost
method. Amounts representing contract change orders or claims are included in
sales only when they can be reliably estimated and realization is probable.
Incentive fees and award fees enter into the determination of contract
profits when they can be reliably estimated.

     Costs accumulated under long-term contracts include direct costs as well
as manufacturing, overhead, and for government contracts, general and
administrative, independent research and development and bid and proposal
costs. Losses on contracts are recognized when determined. Revisions in
profit estimates are reflected in the period in which the facts which require
the revision become known.

Depreciation and Amortization

     Depreciation is provided primarily on the straight-line method over the
estimated useful lives of the related assets. Leasehold improvements are
amortized over the shorter of the lease term or the estimated useful life of
the improvements. The excess of the cost of purchased businesses over the
fair value of the net assets acquired is being amortized using a straight-
line method generally over a 40-year period.

     The carrying amount of cost in excess of net assets acquired is
evaluated on a recurring basis. Current and future profitability as well as
current and future undiscounted cash flows, excluding financing costs, of the
underlying businesses are primary indicators of recoverability. There were no
adjustments to the carrying amount of cost in excess of net assets acquired
resulting from these evaluations during the periods presented.

Use of Estimates

     The preparation of financial statements in conformity with generally
accepted accounting principles requires the Businesses' management to make
estimates and assumptions that affect the reported amounts of assets and
liabilities and disclosure of contingent assets and liabilities at the date
of the financial statements and the reported amounts of revenue and expenses
during the reporting period. The most significant of these estimates and
assumptions relate to contract estimates of sales and costs, cost allocations
from Loral, including interest and income taxes, recoverability of recorded
amounts of fixed assets and cost in excess of net assets acquired, litigation
and environmental obligations. Actual results could differ from these
estimates.
<PAGE>
                           LORAL ACQUIRED BUSINESSES

              NOTES TO COMBINED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS--(Continued)
                            (Dollars in thousands)

New Accounting Pronouncements

     Effective January 1, 1996, the Businesses adopted Statement of Financial
Accounting Standards No. 121, "Accounting for the Impairment of Long-Lived
Assets to Be Disposed Of" ("SFAS 121"). SFAS 121 establishes the accounting
standards for the impairment of long-lived assets, certain intangible assets
and cost in excess of net assets and certain intangible assets to be disposed
of. The impact of adopting SFAS 121 was not material.

     Effective January 1, 1994, the Businesses adopted Statement of Financial
Accounting Standards No. 112, "Employers' Accounting for Postemployment
Benefits" ("SFAS 112"). SFAS 112 requires that the costs of benefits provided
to employees after employment but before retirement be recognized on an
accrual basis. The adoption of SFAS 112 did not have a material impact on the
results of operations of the Businesses.

4.  Acquisitions

     Effective May 1, 1995, Loral acquired substantially all the assets and
liabilities of the Defense Systems operations of Unisys Corporation, which
included the Wideband Systems Division. The acquisition has been accounted
for as a purchase. As such, the accompanying combined financial statements
reflect the results of operations of the Wideband Systems Division from the
effective date of acquisition, including the amortization of an allocated
portion of cost in excess of net assets acquired resulting from the
acquisition. Such allocation was based on the sales and profitability of the
Wideband Systems Divisions relative to the aggregate sales and profitability
of the defense systems operations acquired by Loral. The assets and
liabilities recorded in connection with the purchase price allocation were
$240,525 and $25,598, respectively.

     Had the acquisition of the Wideband Systems Division occurred on January
1, 1994, the unaudited pro forma sales and net income (loss) for the years
ending December 31, 1995 and 1994 would have been $524,355 and $700, and
$504,780 and ($963), respectively. The results, which are based on various
assumptions, are not necessarily indicative of what would have occurred had
the acquisition been consummated as of January 1, 1994.
<PAGE>
                           LORAL ACQUIRED BUSINESSES

              NOTES TO COMBINED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS--(Continued)
                            (Dollars in thousands)

5. Operating Expenses

     The following expenses have been included in the statements of
operations:

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>

                                                                          Three                   Years Ended December 31,
                                                                       Months Ended      -----------------------------------------
                                                                      March 31, 1996             1995                  1994
                                                                  -------------------    -------------------   -------------------
<S>                                                               <C>                    <C>                   <C>

General and administrative expenses . . . . . . . . . . . . . .          $23,558               $90,757               $74,205
Independent research and development, and bid and proposal
    costs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .          $ 5,587               $21,370               $19,491

</TABLE>


6.  Income Taxes

     The provision for income taxes was calculated by applying Loral's
statutory tax rates to the reported pre-tax book income after considering
items that do not enter into the determination of taxable income and tax
credits reflected in the consolidated provision which are related to the
Businesses. It is estimated that deferred income taxes represent
approximately $714,000, $2,857,000 and $4,060,000 of the provisions for
income taxes reflected in these financial statements for the three months
ended March 31, 1996 and the years ended December 31, 1995 and 1994. The
principal components of deferred income taxes are contract accounting
methods, property plant and equipment, goodwill amortization, and timing of
accruals. Substantially all of the Businesses' income is from domestic
operations.
<PAGE>
                           LORAL ACQUIRED BUSINESSES

              NOTES TO COMBINED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS--(Continued)
                            (Dollars in thousands)

     The  following is a reconciliation of the statutory rate to the effective
tax rates reflected in the financial statements:

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>

                                                                                       Years Ended December 31,
                                                                  ---------------------------------------------------------------
                                                                           1996                  1995                  1994
                                                                  -------------------    -------------------   -------------------
<S>                                                               <C>                    <C>                   <C>

Statutory Federal income tax rate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .            35.0%                 35.0%                 35.0%
Research and development and other tax credits  . . . . . . . .              --                 (18.6)                (43.4)
State and local income taxes, net of Federal income tax
    benefit and state and local income tax credits  . . . . . .             3.9                   (.3)                (15.5)
Foreign sales corporation tax benefit . . . . . . . . . . . . .            (2.2)                 (3.0)                (13.6)
Amortization of goodwill  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .             6.3                  35.1                  55.0
Other, net  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .            (5.1)                (13.6)                 18.1
                                                                          -----                  ----                  ----
Effective income tax rate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .            37.9%                 34.6%                 35.6%
                                                                          =====                  ====                  ====
</TABLE>


7.  Interest Expense

     Interest expense was calculated using the following balances and
interest rates:

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>

                                                                          Three                   Years Ended December 31,
                                                                       Months Ended      -----------------------------------------
                                                                      March 31, 1996             1995                  1994
                                                                  -------------------    -------------------   -------------------
<S>                                                               <C>                    <C>                   <C>

Invested Equity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .          $453,062              $265,384              $267,291
Interest Rate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .              7.40%                 7.87%                 6.56%
Wideband Systems Allocated Purchase Price . . . . . . . . . . .                --              $214,927                    --
Interest Rate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                --                  7.40%                   --

</TABLE>
<PAGE>
                           LORAL ACQUIRED BUSINESSES

              NOTES TO COMBINED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS--(Continued)
                            (Dollars in thousands)

8.  Commitments and Contingencies

     The Businesses lease certain facilities and equipment under agreements
expiring at various dates through 2011. Leases covering major items of real
estate and equipment contain renewal and/or purchase options which may be
exercised by the Businesses. Rent expense for the three months ended March
31, 1996 was $1,063. Rent expense for the years ended December 31, 1995 and
1994 was $4,276 and $4,027, respectively.

     Management is continually assessing its obligations with respect to
applicable environmental protection laws. While it is difficult to determine
the timing and ultimate cost to be incurred by the Businesses in order to
comply with  these laws, based  upon available internal and external
assessments, the Businesses believe that even without considering potential
insurance recoveries, if any, there are no environmental loss contingencies
that, individually or in the aggregate, would be material to the Businesses'
operations. The Businesses accrue for these contingencies when it is probable
that a liability has been incurred and the amount of the loss can be
reasonably estimated. The Businesses believe that it has adequately accrued
for future expenditures in connection with environmental matters and that
such expenditures will not have a material adverse effect on its financial
position or results of operations.

     There are a number of lawsuits or claims pending against the Businesses
and incidental to its business. However, in the opinion of management, the
ultimate liability on these matters, if any, will not have a material adverse
effect on the financial position or results of operations of the Businesses.
<PAGE>
                           LORAL ACQUIRED BUSINESSES

              NOTES TO COMBINED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS--(Continued)
                            (Dollars in thousands)


9.  Pensions and Other Employee Benefits

Pensions

     The Businesses participate in various Loral-sponsored pension plans both
contributory and non-contributory covering certain employees. Eligibility for
participation in these plans varies, and benefits are generally based on
members' compensation and years of service. Loral's funding policy was
generally to contribute in accordance with cost accounting standards that
affect government contractors, subject to the Internal Revenue code and
regulations thereon. Since the aforementioned pension arrangements were part
of certain Loral defined benefit or defined contribution plans, no separate
actuarial data was available for the Businesses. The Businesses have been
allocated their share of pension costs based upon participation employee
headcount. Net pension expense, which approximates the amount funded,
included in the accompanying financial statements was $1,234, $4,391 and
$3,150 for the three months ended March 31, 1996 and the years ended December
31, 1995 and 1994, respectively.

Postretirement Health Care and Life Insurance Benefits

     In addition to participating in Loral-sponsored pension plans, the
Businesses provide certain health care and life insurance benefits for
retired employees and dependents at certain locations. Participants are
eligible for these benefits when they retire from active service and meet the
pension plan eligibility requirements. These benefits are funded primarily on
a pay-as-you-go basis with the retiree generally paying a portion of the cost
through contributions, deductibles and coinsurance provisions. Since the
aforementioned postretirement benefits were part of certain Loral
postretirement arrangements, no separate actuarial data is available for the
Businesses. The Businesses have been allocated postretirement benefit costs
based upon participant employee headcount. Postretirement benefit costs
included in the accompanying financial statements were $402, $1,646 and
$1,682 for the three months ended March 31, 1996 and the years ended December
31, 1995 and 1994, respectively.

Employee Savings Plans

     Under various employee savings plans sponsored by Loral, the Businesses
matched the contributions of participating employees up to a designated
level. The extent of the match, vesting terms and the form of the matching
contribution vary among the plans. Under these plans, the matching
contributions, in cash, common stock or both, for the three months ended
March 31, 1996 and the years ended December 31, 1995 and 1994 were $634,
$1,879 and $1,844, respectively.
<PAGE>
                           LORAL ACQUIRED BUSINESSES

              NOTES TO COMBINED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS--(Continued)
                            (Dollars in thousands)


10.  Sales to Principal Customers

     The Businesses operate primarily in one industry segment, electronic
components and systems. Sales to principal customers are as follows:

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>

                                                                                                        Years Ended
                                                                          Three                         December 31,
                                                                       Months Ended      -----------------------------------------
                                                                      March 31, 1996             1995                  1994
                                                                  -------------------    -------------------   -------------------
<S>                                                               <C>                    <C>                   <C>

 U.S. Government Agencies   . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .          $ 94,993              $328,476              $160,068
 Foreign (principally foreign governments)  . . . . . . . . . .            16,838                62,549                65,883
 Other (principally commercial)   . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .            20,369                57,140                57,178
                                                                        ---------              --------              --------
                                                                         $132,200              $448,165              $283,129
                                                                        =========              ========              ========
</TABLE>
<PAGE>
                           LORAL ACQUIRED BUSINESSES

              NOTES TO COMBINED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS--(Continued)
                            (Dollars in thousands)

Foreign sales comprise the following:

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>

                                                                                                        Years Ended
                                                                          Three                         December 31,
                                                                       Months Ended      -----------------------------------------
                                                                      March 31, 1996             1995                  1994
                                                                  -------------------    -------------------   -------------------
<S>                                                               <C>                    <C>                   <C>

Export sales
    Asia  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .          $ 4,056               $19,248               $30,790
    Middle East . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .            3,648                 4,147                 6,035
    Europe  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .            6,275                26,283                18,368
    Other . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .            2,859                12,871                10,690
                                                                        --------               -------               ------- 
    Total foreign sales . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .          $16,838               $62,549               $65,883
                                                                        ========               =======               ======= 

</TABLE>


11.  Related Party Transactions

    The Businesses had a number of transactions with Loral and its affiliates.
Management believes that the arrangements are as favorable to the Businesses
as could be obtained from unaffiliated parties. The following describe the
related party transactions.

    Loral allocated certain operational, administrative, legal and other
services to the Businesses. Costs allocated to the Businesses were $1,827,
$6,535 and $5,123 for the three months ended March 31, 1996 and the years
ended December 31, 1995 and 1994, respectively. The Businesses sold products
to Loral and its affiliates. Net sales to Loral were $14,840 for the three
months ended March 31, 1996 and were $54,600 and $28,542 in 1995 and 1994,
respectively. Net sales to Space Systems/Loral were $2,471 for the three
months ended March 31, 1996 and were $4,596 and $1,678 in 1995 and 1994,
respectively. Net sales to K&F Industries were $1,173 for the three months
ended  March 31, 1996 and were $2,415 and $3,962 in 1995 and 1994,
respectively.
<PAGE>
    No person has been authorized to give any information or to make any
    representations other than those contained in this Prospectus, and, if
    given or made, such information or representations must not be relied upon
    as having been authorized. This Prospectus does not constitute an offer
    to sell or the solicitation of an offer to buy any securities other than
    the securities to which it relates or any offer to sell or the solicitation
    of an offer to buy such securities in any circumstances in which such offer
    or solicitation is unlawful. Neither the delivery of this Prospectus nor
    any sale made hereunder shall, under any circumstances, create any
    implication that there has been no change in the affairs of the Company
    since the date hereof or that the information contained herein is correct
    as of any time subsequent to its date.

                         _________________________


                            Table of Contents

                                                       Page

   Available Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   2
   Prospectus Summary  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   3
   Risk Factors  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  15
   Use of Proceeds . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  24
   Capitalization  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  24
   Unaudited Pro Forma Condensed Consolidated Financial
   Statements  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  25
   Notes to Unaudited Pro Forma Condensed Consolidated
     Financial Statements  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  27
   Business  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  39
   The Transaction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  54
   Management  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  56
   Ownership of Capital Stock  . . . . . . . . . . . . .  60
   Description of Senior Credit Facilities   . . . . . .  60
   The Exchange Offer  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  62
   Description of the Exchange Notes . . . . . . . . . .  71
   Certain United States Federal Tax Considerations  . .  97
   Plan of Distribution  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  97
   Legal Matters   . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  98
   Experts   . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  98
   Index to Financial Statements . . . . . . . . . . . . F-1


    Until        , 1997 (90 days after commencement of this offering), all
    dealers effecting transactions in the exchange notes, whether or not
    participating in the exchange offer, may be required to deliver a
    prospectus.
<PAGE>
                           Preliminary Prospectus



                               $225,000,000






                      L-3 Communications Corporation




                             [LOGO OMITTED]




        Offer to Exchange $225,000,000 of its 10 3/8% Series B Senior
           Subordinated Notes due 2007, which have been registered
             under the Securities Act, for $225,000,000 of its
               outstanding 10 3/8% Senior Subordinated Notes
                               due 2007
<PAGE>
                  [ALTERNATE COVER FOR MARKET-MAKING PROSPECTUS]


    PROSPECTUS
    [LOGO OMITTED] 


                          L-3 Communications Corporation

               10 3/8% Series B Senior Subordinated Notes due 2007,
                              __________________

    The 10 3/8% Series B Senior Subordinated Notes due 2007 (the "Exchange
    Notes") of L-3 Communications Corporation (the "Company" or "L-3") were
    issued in exchange for the 10 3/8% Senior Subordinated Notes due 2007 (the
    "Old Notes" and together with the Exchange Notes, the "Notes") by the
    Company.

    Interest on the Exchange Notes will be payable semi-annually on May 1 and
    November 1 of each year, commencing November 1, 1997. The Exchange Notes
    will be redeemable at the option of the Company, in whole or in part, at
    any time on or after May 1, 2002, at the redemption prices set forth
    herein, plus accrued and unpaid interest to the date of redemption. In
    addition, prior to May 1, 2000, the Company may redeem up to 35% of the
    aggregate principal amount of Exchange Notes at the redemption price set
    forth herein plus accrued and unpaid interest through the redemption date
    with the net cash proceeds of one or more Equity Offerings (as defined).
    The Exchange Notes will not be subject to any mandatory sinking fund. In
    the event of a Change of Control (as defined), each holder of Exchange
    Notes will have the right, at the holder's option, to require the Company
    to purchase such holder's Exchange Notes at a purchase price equal to 101%
    of the principal amount thereof, plus accrued and unpaid interest to the
    date of purchase. See "Description of the Exchange Notes".

    The Exchange Notes will be general unsecured obligations of the Company,
    subordinate in right of payment to all existing and future Senior Debt (as
    defined) of the Company. As of March 31, 1997, after giving pro forma
    effect to the Offering of the Old Notes, application of the net proceeds
    therefrom and borrowings under the Senior Credit Facilities (as defined),
    the Company would have had approximately $400.0 million of indebtedness
    outstanding, of which $175.0 million would have been Senior Debt
    (excluding letters of credit). See "Capitalization". On the date of
    issuance of the Exchange Notes, the Company will not have any
    subsidiaries; however, the Indenture (as defined) will permit the Company
    to create subsidiaries in the future.

    For a discussion of certain factors that should be considered in
    connection with an investment in the Exchange Notes, see "Risk Factors"
    beginning on page 13.

    THE SECURITIES HAVE NOT BEEN APPROVED OR DISAPPROVED BY THE SECURITIES AND
    EXCHANGE COMMISSION OR ANY STATE SECURITIES COMMISSION NOR HAS THE
<PAGE>
    COMMISSION OR ANY STATE SECURITIES COMMISSION PASSED UPON THE ACCURACY OR
    ADEQUACY OF THIS PROSPECTUS. ANY REPRESENTATION TO THE CONTRARY IS A
    CRIMINAL OFFENSE.

    This Prospectus has been prepared for and is to be used by Lehman Brothers
    Inc. in connection with offers and sales in market-making transactions of
    the Exchange Notes. The Company will not receive any of the proceeds of
    such sales. Lehman Brothers Inc. may act as a principal or agent in such
    transactions. The Exchange Notes may be offered in negotiated transactions
    or otherwise.
                            _________________________

                               LEHMAN BROTHERS INC.
                            _________________________

                 The date of this Prospectus is __________, 1997
<PAGE>
                 [ALTERNATE SECTION FOR MARKET-MAKING PROSPECTUS]

                              AVAILABLE INFORMATION

         The Company has filed with the Commission a Registration Statement
    on Form S-4 (together with all amendments, exhibits, schedules and
    supplements thereto, the "Registration Statement") under the Securities
    Act with respect to the Exchange Notes being offered hereby. This
    Prospectus, which forms a part of the Registration Statement, does not
    contain all of the information set forth in the Registration Statement.
    For further information with respect to the Company and the Exchange
    Notes, reference is made to the Registration Statement. Statements
    contained in this Prospectus as to the contents of any contract or other
    document are not necessarily complete, and, where such contract or other
    document is an exhibit to the Registration Statement, each such statement
    is qualified in all respects by the provisions in such exhibit, to which
    reference is hereby made. As a result of the offering of the Exchange
    Notes, the Company will become subject to the informational requirements
    of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended (the "Exchange Act"),
    and, in accordance therewith, will file reports and other information with
    the Commission. The Registration Statement, such reports and other
    information can be inspected and copied at the Public Reference Section of
    the Commission located at Room 1024, Judiciary Plaza, 450 Fifth Street,
    N.W., Washington D.C. 20549 and at regional public reference facilities
    maintained by the Commission located at Citicorp Center, 500 West Madison
    Street, Suite 1400, Chicago, Illinois 60661 and Seven World Trade Center,
    Suite 1300, New York, New York 10048. Copies of such material, including
    copies of all or any portion of the Registration Statement, can be
    obtained from the Public Reference Section of the Commission at prescribed
    rates. Such material may also be accessed electronically by means of the
    Commission's home page on the Internet (http://www.sec.gov). 

         So long as the Company is subject to the periodic reporting
    requirements of the Exchange Act, it is required to furnish the
    information required to be filed with the Commission to the Trustee and
    the holders of the Old Notes and the Exchange Notes. The Company has
    agreed that, even if it is not required under the Exchange Act to furnish
    such information to the Commission, it will nonetheless continue to
    furnish information that would be required to be furnished by the Company
    by Section 13 of the Exchange Act to the Trustee and the holders of the
    Old Notes or Exchange Notes as if it were subject to such periodic
    reporting requirements.
<PAGE>
                  [ALTERNATE PAGE FOR MARKET-MAKING PROSPECTUS]


    TRADING MARKET FOR THE EXCHANGE NOTES

         There is no existing trading market for the Exchange Notes, and
    there can be no assurance regarding the future development of a market for
    the Exchange Notes or the ability of the Holders of the Exchange Notes to
    sell their Exchange Notes or the price at which such Holders may be able
    to sell their Exchange Notes. If such market were to develop, the Exchange
    Notes could trade at prices that may be higher or lower than their initial
    offering price depending on many factors, including prevailing interest
    rates, the Company's operating results and the market for similar
    securities. Although it is not obligated to do so, Lehman Brothers Inc.
    intends to make a market in the Exchange Notes. Any such market-making
    activity may be discontinued at any time, for any reason, without notice
    at the sole discretion of Lehman Brothers Inc. No assurance can be given
    as to the liquidity of or the trading market for the Exchange Notes.

         Lehman Brothers Inc. may be deemed to be an affiliate of the Company
    and, as such, may be required to deliver a prospectus in connection with
    its market-making activities in the Exchange Notes. Pursuant to the
    Registration Rights Agreement, the Company agreed to file and maintain a
    registration statement that would allow Lehman Brothers Inc. to engage in
    market-making transactions in the Exchange Notes. Subject to certain
    exceptions set forth in the Registration Rights Agreement, the
    registration statement will remain effective for as long as Lehman
    Brothers Inc. may be required to deliver a prospectus in connection with
    market-making transactions in the Exchange Notes. The Company has agreed
    to bear substantially all the costs and expenses related to such
    registration statement.
<PAGE>
                  [ALTERNATE PAGE FOR MARKET-MAKING PROSPECTUS]


                                 USE OF PROCEEDS

         This Prospectus is delivered in connection with the sale of the
    Exchange Notes by Lehman Brothers Inc. in market-making transactions. The
    Company will not receive any of the proceeds from such transactions.
<PAGE>
                  [ALTERNATE PAGE FOR MARKET-MAKING PROSPECTUS]


    PLAN OF DISTRIBUTION

         This Prospectus is to be used by Lehman Brothers Inc. in connection
    with offers and sales of the Exchange Notes in market-making transactions
    effected from time to time. Lehman Brothers Inc. may act as a principal or
    agent in such transactions, including as agent for the counterparty when
    acting as principal or as agent for both counterparties, and may receive
    compensation in the form of discounts and commissions, including from both
    counterparties when it acts as agent for both. Such sales will be made at
    prevailing market prices at the time of sale, at prices related thereto or
    at negotiated prices.

         Affiliates of Lehman Brothers Inc. currently own 50.1% of the Parent
    Common Stock. See "Ownership of Capital Stock". Lehman Brothers Inc. has
    informed the Company that it does not intend to confirm sales of the
    Exchange Notes to any accounts over which it exercises discretionary
    authority without the prior specific written approval of such transactions
    by the customer.

         The Company has been advised by Lehman Brothers Inc. that, subject
    to applicable laws and regulations, Lehman Brothers Inc. currently intends
    to make a market in the Exchange Notes following completion of the
    Exchange Offer. However, Lehman Brothers Inc. is not obligated to do so
    and any such market-making may be interrupted or discontinued at any time
    without notice. In addition, such market-making activity will be subject
    to the limits imposed by the Securities Act and the Exchange Act. There
    can be no assurance that an active trading market will develop or be
    sustained. See "Risk Factors--Trading Market for the Exchange Notes."

         Lehman Brothers Inc. has provided investment banking services to the
    Company in the past and may provide such services and financial advisory
    services to the Company in the future. Lehman Brothers Inc. acted as
    purchasers in connection with the initial sale of the Notes and received
    an underwriting discount of approximately $     million in connection
    therewith. See "Certain Transactions."

         Lehman Brothers Inc. and the Company have entered into a
    registration rights agreement with respect to the use by Lehman Brothers
    Inc. of this Prospectus. Pursuant to such agreement, the Company agreed to
    bear all registration expenses incurred under such agreement, and the
    Company agreed to indemnify Lehman Brothers Inc. against certain
    liabilities, including liabilities under the Securities Act.
<PAGE>
               [ALTERNATE BACK COVER FOR MARKET-MAKING PROSPECTUS]


    No person has been authorized to give any information or to make any
    representations other than those contained in this Prospectus, and, if
    given or made, such information or representations must not be relied
    relied upon as having been authorized. This Prospectus does not
    constitute an offer to sell or the solicitation of an offer to buy any
    securities other than the securities to which it relates or any offer
    to sell or the solicitation of an offer to buy such securities in any
    circumstances in which such offer or solicitation is unlawful. Neither
    the delivery of this Prospectus nor any sale made hereunder shall,
    under any circumstances, create any implication that there has been no
    change in the affairs of the Company since the date hereof or that the
    information contained herein is correct as of any time subsequent to
    its date.

                        -----------------------

                           Table of Contents

                                                           Page

    Available Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   2
    Prospectus Summary  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   3
    Risk Factors  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  15
    Use of Proceeds . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  24 
    Capitalization  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  24
    Unaudited Pro Forma Condensed Consolidated Financial
      Statements  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  25
    Notes to Unaudited Pro Forma Condensed Consolidated
      Financial Statements  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  27
    Business  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  39
    The Transaction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  54
    Management  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  56
    Ownership of Capital Stock  . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  60
    Description of Senior Credit Facilities . . . . . . . .  60
    The Exchange Offer  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  62
    Description of the Exchange Notes . . . . . . . . . . .  71
    Certain United States Federal Tax Considerations  . . .  97
    Plan of Distribution  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  97
    Legal Matters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  98
    Experts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  98
    Index to Financial Statements . . . . . . . . . . . . . F-1

<PAGE>
                               Prospectus






                     L-3 Communications Corporation






                           [LOGO OMITTED]





         10 3/8% Series B Senior Subordinated Notes due 2007




                         LEHMAN BROTHERS INC.
<PAGE>
                                     PART II
                      INFORMATION NOT REQUIRED IN PROSPECTUS

    Item 20. Indemnification of Directors and Officers.

         Section 145 of the Delaware General Corporation Law (the "DGCL")
    provides for, among other things: 

              a.   permissive indemnification for expenses (including
         attorneys' fees), judgments, fines and amounts paid in settlement
         actually and reasonably incurred by designated persons, including
         directors and officers of a corporation, in the event such persons
         are parties to litigation other than stockholder derivative actions
         if certain conditions are met; 

              b.   permissive indemnification for expenses (including
         attorneys' fees) actually and reasonably incurred by designated
         persons, including directors and officers of a corporation, in the
         event such persons are parties to stockholder derivative actions if
         certain conditions are met; 

              c.   mandatory indemnification for expenses (including
         attorneys' fees) actually and reasonably incurred by designated
         persons, including directors and officers of a corporation, in the
         event such persons are successful on the merits or otherwise in
         defense of litigation covered by a. and b. above; and 

              d.   that the indemnification provided for by Section 145 is
         not deemed exclusive of any other rights which may be provided under
         any by-law, agreement, stockholder or disinterested director vote,
         or otherwise. 

         In addition to the indemnification provisions of the DGCL described
    above, the Registrant's certificate of incorporation (the "Certificate of
    Incorporation") authorizes indemnification of the Registrant's officers
    and directors, subject to a case-by-case determination that they acted in
    good faith and in a manner they reasonably believed to be in or not
    opposed to the best interests of the Company, and in the case of any
    criminal proceeding, they had no reasonable cause to believe their conduct
    was unlawful. In the event that a Change in Control (as defined in the
    Certificate of Incorporation) shall have occurred, the proposed indemnitee
    director or officer may require that the determination of whether he met
    the standard of conduct be made by special legal counsel selected by him.
    In addition, whereas the DGCL would require court-ordered indemnification,
    if any, in cases in which a person has been adjudged to be liable to the
    Registrant, the Certificate of Incorporation also permits indemnification
    in such cases if and to the extent that the reviewing party determines
    that such indemnity is fair and reasonable under the circumstances. 

         The Certificate of Incorporation requires the advancement of
    expenses to an officer or director (without a determination as to his
    conduct) in advance of the final disposition of a proceeding if such
    person furnishes a written affirmation of his good faith belief that he
    has met the applicable standard of conduct and furnishes a written
    undertaking to repay any advances if it is ultimately determined that he
    is not entitled to indemnification. In connection with proceedings by or
<PAGE>
    in the right of the Registrant, the Certificate of Incorporation provides
    that indemnification shall include not only reasonable expenses, but also
    penalties, fines and amounts paid in settlement. Unless ordered by a
    court, such indemnification shall not include judgments. Under the
    Certificate of Incorporation, no officer or director is entitled to
    indemnification or advancement of expenses with respect to a proceeding
    brought by him against the Registrant other than a proceeding seeking or
    defending such officer's or director's right to indemnification or
    advancement of expenses. Finally, the Certificate of Incorporation
    provides that the Company may, subject to authorization on a case by case
    basis, indemnify and advance expenses to employees or agents to the same
    extent as a director or to a lesser extent (or greater, as permitted by
    law) as determined by the Board of Directors. 

         The Certificate of Incorporation purports to confer upon officers
    and directors contractual rights to indemnification and advancement of
    expenses as provided therein. In addition, as permitted by the DGCL, the
    Registrant has entered into indemnity agreements with its directors and
    selected officers that provide contract rights substantially identical to
    the rights to indemnification and advancement of expenses set forth in the
    Certificate of Incorporation, as described above. 

         The Certificate of Incorporation limits the personal liability of
    directors to the Registrant or its stockholders for monetary damages for
    breach of the duty as a director, other than liability as a director (i)
    for breach of duty of loyalty to the Registrant or its stockholders, (ii)
    for acts or omissions not in good faith or which involve intentional
    misconduct or a knowing violation of law, (iii) under Section 174 of the
    DGCL (certain illegal distributions), or (iv) for any transaction for
    which the director derived an improper personal benefit. 

         The Registrant maintains officers' and directors' insurance covering
    certain liabilities that may be incurred by officers and directors in the
    performance of their duties. 

    Item 21.  Exhibits and Financial Statement Schedules.


    Exhibit No.                                     Description of Exhibit
    ------------                                    ----------------------

    <F1> 3.1   Certificate of Incorporation
    <F1> 3.2   By-Laws of L-3 Communications Corporation
    <F1> 4.1   Indenture dated as of April 30, 1997 between L-3 
                 Communications Corporation and The Bank of 
                 New York, as Trustee.
    <F1> 4.2   Form of 10 3/8% Senior Subordinated Note due 2007.
    <F1> 4.3   Form of 10 3/8% Series B Senior Subordinated Note due 2007.
           5   Opinion of Simpson Thacher & Bartlett.
    <F1>10.1   Credit Agreement, dated as of April 30, 1997, among L-3 
                 Communications Corporation and lenders named therein.
    <F1>10.2   Registration Rights Agreement, dated as of April 30, 1997, 
                 among L-3 Communications Corporation, Lehman Brothers Inc. 
                 and BancAmerica Securities, Inc.
<PAGE>
    <F1>10.3   Purchase Agreement, dated as of April 25, 1997, among L-3 
                 Communications Corporation, Lehman Brothers Inc. and 
                 BancAmerica Securities, Inc..
    <F1>10.4   Stockholders' Agreement between L-3 Communications Corporation 
                 and the stockholders parties thereto.
    <F1>12.1   Computation of Ratio of Earnings to Fixed Charges
    <F1>23.1   Consent of Simpson Thacher & Bartlett (included as part of its 
                 opinion filed as Exhibit 5 hereto).
    <F1>23.2   Consent of Coopers & Lybrand L.L.P., independent 
                 certified public accountants.
    <F1>23.3   Consent of Ernst & Young LLP, independent certified public 
                 accountants.
    <F1>24     Powers of Attorney (included on page II-5).
    <F1>25     Form T-1 Statement of Eligibility under the Trust Indenture 
                 Act of 1939 of The Bank of New York, as Trustee.
    <F1>99.1   Form of Letter of Transmittal.
    <F1>99.2   Form of Notice of Guaranteed Delivery.

____________________

<F1>  To be filed by amendment.


    Item 22.  Undertakings.

         The undersigned Registrant hereby undertakes: 

         (1)  To file, during any period in which offers or sales are being
    made, a post-effective amendment to this registration statement: 

                     (i)     To include any prospectus required by Section
         10(a)(3) of the Securities Act of 1933; 

                    (ii)     To reflect in the prospectus any facts or events
         arising after the effective date of the registration statement (or
         the most recent post-effective amendment thereto, which,
         individually or in the aggregate, represent a fundamental change in
         the information set forth in the registration statement; 

                   (iii)     To include any material information with respect
         to the plan of distribution not previously disclosed in the
         registration statement or any material change to such information in
         the registration statement.

         (2)  That, for the purpose of determining any liability under the
    Securities Act of 1933, each such post-effective amendment shall be deemed
    to be a new registration statement relating to the securities offered
    therein, and the offering of such securities at that time shall be deemed
    to be the initial bona fide offering thereof. 

         (3) To remove from registration by means of a post-effective
    amendment any of the securities being registered which remain unsold at
    the termination of the offering. 

         The undersigned Registrant hereby undertakes as follows: that prior
    to any public reoffering of the securities registered hereunder through
<PAGE>
    use of a prospectus which is a part of this registration statement, by any
    person or party who is deemed to be an underwriter within the meaning of
    Rule 145(c), the issuer undertakes that such reoffering prospectus will
    contain the information called for by the applicable registration form
    with respect to reofferings by persons who may be deemed to be
    underwriters, in addition to the information called for by the other Items
    of the applicable form. 

         The Registrant undertakes that every prospectus (i) that is filed
    pursuant to the immediately preceding undertaking or (ii) that purports to
    meet the requirements of section 10(a)(3) of the Act and is used in
    connection with an offering of securities subject to Rule 415, will be
    filed as a part of an amendment to the registration statement and will not
    be used until such amendment is effective, and that, for purposes of
    determining any liability under the Securities Act of 1933, each such
    post-effective amendment shall be deemed to be a new registration
    statement relating to the securities offered therein, and the offering of
    such securities at that time shall be deemed to be the initial bona fide
    offering thereof. 

         Insofar as indemnification for liabilities arising under the
    Securities Act of 1933 may be permitted to directors, officers and
    controlling persons of the Registrant pursuant to the foregoing
    provisions, or otherwise, the Registrant has been advised that in the
    opinion of the Securities and Exchange Commission such indemnification is
    against public policy as expressed in the Act and is, therefore,
    unenforceable. In the event that a claim for indemnification against such
    liabilities (other than the payment by the Registrant of expenses incurred
    or paid by a director, officer or controlling person of the Registrant in
    the successful defense of any action, suit or proceeding) is asserted by
    such director, officer or controlling person in connection with the
    securities being registered, the Registrant will, unless in the opinion of
    its counsel the matter has been settled by controlling precedent, submit
    to a court of appropriate jurisdiction the question whether such
    indemnification by it is against public policy as expressed in the Act and
    will be governed by the final adjudication of such issue. 

         The undersigned Registrant hereby undertakes to supply by means of a
    post-effective amendment all information concerning a transaction, and the
    company being acquired involved therein, that was not the subject of and
    included in the registration statement when it became effective.
<PAGE>
                                    SIGNATURES

         Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act, the Registrant
    has duly caused the Registration Statement or amendments thereto to be
    signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized, on    
         , 1997.

                                      L-3 COMMUNICATIONS CORPORATION


                                      By:                   *
                                           ------------------------------------
                                           Chief Executive Officer and Chairman 
                                             of the Board of Directors

         Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act, the Registration
    Statement has been signed on the    day of      , 1997 by the following
    persons in the capacities indicated: 

           Signature                         Title
           ---------                         ------


             *                   Chairman, Chief Executive Officer 
- -------------------------        Director (Principal Executive Officer)
       Frank C. Lanza            
                                 

             *                    President, Chief Financial Officer 
- -------------------------         (Principal Financial Officer) and Director
      Robert V. LaPenta

 /s/ Michael T. Strianese         Vice President -- Finance and Controller 
- -------------------------         (Principal Accounting Officer)
    Michael T. Strianese

           *                       Director 
- -------------------------
   Steven J. Berger

           *                       Director 
- -------------------------
   David J. Brand

           *                       Director
- -------------------------
   Thomas A. Corcoran

           *                       Director
- -------------------------
   Alberto M. Finali

           *                       Director 
- -------------------------
    Eliot M. Fried

<PAGE>
           *                       Director
- -------------------------
    Robert B. Millard

           *                       Director
- -------------------------
   Frank H. Menaker, Jr.

           *                       Director
- -------------------------
   John E. Montague

           *                       Director
- -------------------------
  Alan H. Washkowitz


*By: /s/ Michael T. Strianese        
- -----------------------------
         Attorney-In-Fact
<PAGE>
                                POWER OF ATTORNEY

              We, the undersigned directors and officers of L-3
    Communications Corporation, do hereby constitute and appoint Michael T.
    Strianese and David J. Brand, or either of them, our true and lawful
    attorneys and agents, to do any and all acts and things in our name and on
    our behalf in our capacities as directs and officers and to execute any
    and all instruments for us and in our names in the capacities indicated
    below, which said attorneys and agents, or either of them, may deem
    necessary or advisable to enable said Corporation to comply with the
    Securities Act of 1933 and any rules, regulations and requirements of the
    Securities and Exchange Commission, in connection with this Registration
    Statement, including specifically, but without limitation, power and
    authority to sign for us or any of us in our names in the capacities
    indicated below, any and all amendments (including post-effective
    amendments) hereto and we do hereby ratify and confirm all that said
    attorneys and agents, or either of them, shall do or cause to be done by
    virtue hereof.

              Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933,
    this Registration Statement has been signed on the     day of      1997 by
    the following persons in the capacities indicated:

           Signature                         Title
           ---------                         ------


   /s/ Frank C. Lanza            Chief Executive Officer and Chairman of 
- -------------------------        the Board of Directors (Principal Executive 
       Frank C. Lanza            Officer)
                                 

  /s/ Robert V. LaPenta           President/Chief Financial Officer 
- -------------------------         (Principal Financial Officer) and Director
      Robert V. LaPenta

 /s/ Michael T. Strianese         Vice President and Controller 
- -------------------------         
     Michael T. Strianese

 /s/ Steven J. Berger               Director 
- -------------------------
     Steven J. Berger

/s/  David J. Brand                 Director 
- -------------------------
     David J. Brand

/s/  Eliot M. Fried                 Director
- -------------------------
     Eliot M. Fried

/s/  Robert B. Millard              Director
- -------------------------
     Robert B. Millard

<PAGE>
/s/  Frank H. Menaker, Jr.          Director
- -------------------------
     Frank H. Menaker, Jr.

/s/  John E. Montague               Director
- -------------------------
     John E. Montague

/s/  Alan H. Washkowitz             Director
- -------------------------
     Alan H. Washkowitz

/s/  Thomas A. Corcoran             Director 
- -------------------------
     Thomas A. Corcoran

/s/  Alberto M. Finali              Director
- -------------------------
    Alberto M. Finali



                                                              Exhibit 5

                                                      July 18, 1997



L-3 Communications Corporation 
600 Third Avenue
New York, New York  10016

Ladies and Gentlemen:

              We have acted as special counsel for L-3 Communications

Corporation, a Delaware corporation (the "Company"), in connection with the

Registration Statement on Form S-4 (the "Registration Statement") filed by

the Company with the Securities and Exchange Commission (the "Commission")

under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended (the "Securities Act"), relating

to the issuance by the Company of $225,000,000 aggregate principal amount of

its 10-3/8% Series B Senior Subordinated Notes due 2007 (the "Exchange

Notes").  The Exchange Notes are to be offered by the Company in exchange for

(the "Exchange") $225,000,000 aggregate principal amount of its outstanding

10-3/8% Senior Subordinated Notes due 2007 (the "Notes").  The Notes have

been, and the Exchange Notes will be, issued under an Indenture dated as of

April 30, 1997 (the "Indenture") between the Company and The Bank of New

York, as Trustee (the "Trustee").

              We have examined the Registration Statement and the Indenture

which has been filed with the Commission as an Exhibit to the Registration

Statement.  In addition, we have examined, and have relied as to matters of

fact upon, the originals or copies, certified or otherwise identified to our

satisfaction, of such corporate records, agreements, documents and other

instruments and such certificates or comparable documents of public officials

and of officers and representatives of the Company, and have made such other
<PAGE>
and further investigations, as we have deemed relevant and necessary as a

basis for the opinion hereinafter set forth.

              In such examination, we have assumed the genuineness of all

signatures, the legal capacity of natural persons, the authenticity of all

documents submitted to us as originals and the conformity to original

documents of all documents submitted to us as certified or photostatic

copies, and the authenticity of the originals of such latter documents.

              Based upon the foregoing, and subject to the qualifications and

limitations stated herein, assuming the Indenture has been duly authorized

and validly executed and delivered by the parties thereto, when (i) the

Indenture has been duly qualified under the Trust Indenture Act of 1939, as

amended (the "Trust Indenture Act"), (ii) the Board of Directors of the

Company, a duly constituted and acting committee thereof or duly authorized

officers thereof has taken all necessary corporate action to approve the

issuance and terms of the Exchange Notes, the terms of the Exchange and

related matters, and (iii) the Exchange Notes have been duly executed,

authenticated, issued and delivered in accordance with the provisions of the

Indenture upon the Exchange, we are of the opinion that the Exchange Notes

will constitute valid and legally binding obligations of the Company,

enforceable against the Company in accordance with their terms.

              Our opinion set forth in the preceding sentence is subject to

the effects of bankruptcy, insolvency, fraudulent conveyance, reorganization,

moratorium and other similar laws relating to or affecting creditors' rights

generally, general equitable principles (whether considered in a proceeding

in equity or at law) and an implied covenant of good faith and fair dealing.

              We are members of the Bar of the State of New York and we do

not express any opinion herein concerning any law other than the law of the

State of New York and the federal law of the United States.
<PAGE>
              We hereby consent to the use of this opinion as an Exhibit to

the Registration Statement and to the reference to our firm under the caption

"Legal Matters" in the Prospectus included therein.

                                      Very truly yours,


                                      /s/SIMPSON THACHER & BARTLETT
                                      SIMPSON THACHER & BARTLETT



                                                                    EXHIBIT 12


                             Lockheed Martin Predecessor Businesses
                           Computation of Ratio of Earnings to Fixed Charges
                                 (in thousands, except for ratio data)

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>

                                             For the three months
                                                Ended March 31,                           Years Ended December 31,
                           ----------------------------------  ----------------------------------------------------
                                        Proforma                            Proforma
                                          1997        1997        1996        1996        1996         1995         1994
                                       ----------  ----------  ----------  ----------  -----------  -----------  -----------     
                                                                                       
<S>                                  <C>         <C>          <C>         <C>          <C>          <C>         <C>

Earnings:                                                                                    
 Income before income taxes   . . .     ($900)      ($505)      ($352)       $15,400      $19,494     $  174       $ 2,929
 Add:
  Interest expense  . . . . . . . .    10,200       8,441       2,028         40,600       24,197      4,475         5,450
  Interest component of rent
   expense  . . . . . . . . . . . .       851         851         383          2,832        2,832      1,591         1,866
                                      -------      ------      ------        -------       -------    ------       -------
 Earnings   . . . . . . . . . . . .   $10,151      $8,787      $2,059        $58,832       $46,523    $6,240       $10,245
                                      =======      ======      ======        =======       =======    ======       =======

Fixed Charges:
  Interest expense  . . . . . . . .   $10,200      $8,441      $2,028        $40,600       $24,197    $4,475       $ 5,450
  Interest component of rent
   expense  . . . . . . . . . . . .       851         851         383          2,832         2,832     1,591         1,866
                                      -------      ------      ------        -------        -------   ------       -------
 Fixed charges  . . . . . . . . . .   $11,051      $9,292      $2,411        $43,432       $27,029    $6,066       $ 7,316
                                      =======      ======      ======        =======       =======    ======       =======

Ratio of earnings to fixed charges        N/A         N/A         N/A           1.35x         1.72x     1.03x        1.40x
                                          ===         ===         ===          =====         =====     =====         =====
</TABLE>



                                                             EXHIBIT 23.2



                      Consent of Independent Accountants



          We consent to the inclusion in this registration statement on Form
S-4 of our report dated July 11, 1997 on our audit of the combined financial
statements of the Lockheed Martin Predecessor Businesses as of March 31, 1997
and for the three months then ended, our report dated July 16, 1997 on our
audit of the balance sheet of L-3 Communications Corporation (a Delaware
company) as of April 29, 1997, our report dated March 20, 1997 on our audit of
the combined financial statements of the Lockheed Martin Predecessor
Businesses as of December 31, 1996 and for the year then ended, and our
report also dated March 20, 1997 on our audits of the Loral Acquired
Businesses for the three months ended March 31, 1996 and for the years ended
December 31, 1995 and 1994.  The report dated March 20, 1997 on the combined
financial statements of the Lockheed Martin Predecessor Businesses as of and
for the year ended December 31, 1996 states that Coopers & Lybrand L.L.P.'s
opinion, insofar as it relates to the financial statements of the Lockheed
Martin Communications Systems Division as of December 31, 1996 included in
such combined financial statements, is based solely on the report of other
auditors.  We also consent to the reference to our Firm under the caption
"Experts".


                               Coopers & Lybrand L.L.P.

New York, New York
July 17, 1997



                                                                  Exhibit 23.3



                        CONSENT OF INDEPENDENT AUDITORS



We consent to the reference to our firm under the caption "Experts" in the
Registration Statement on Form S-4 and related Prospectus of L-3
Communications Corporation for the registration of $225,000,000 of its Series
B Senior Subordinated Notes due 2007.

We also consent to the inclusion therein of our report dated March 7, 1997
with respect to the combined financial statements of Lockheed Martin
Communications Systems Division at December 31, 1996 (not presented
separately herein) and 1995, and the combined results of its operations and
its cash flows for the year ended December 31, 1996 (not presented separately
herein), and the results of its operations and its cash flows for each of the
two years in the period ended December 31, 1995, included therein.

                                         /s/ Ernst & Young LLP

Washington, D.C.
July 16, 1997




© 2022 IncJournal is not affiliated with or endorsed by the U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission